Official Software
Get notified when we add a new BeijingOther Model Manual
Summary of Content
Alfa 159 cop. LUM GB:Alfa 159 cop. LUM GB 7-04-2010 11:19 Pagina 1 ENGLISH OWNER HANDBOOK ALFA 159 Alfa Services 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:47 Pagina 1 Dear Customer, thank you for choosing Alfa Romeo. Your Alfa 159 has been designed to guarantee the safety, comfort and driving pleasure typical of Alfa Romeo. This booklet will help you to get to know the characteristics and operation of your car. The following pages contain all the indications necessary for you to be able to maintain the high standards of performance, quality, safety and respect for the environment which characterize this Alfa 159. The enclosed Warranty Booklet also contains the regulations, the warranty certificate and a guide to the services offered by Alfa Romeo. Services which are essential and precious because, when you purchase an Alfa Romeo you are not only acquiring a car, but the tranquillity that comes from knowing that an efficient, willing and widespread organization is at your service for any assistance problems you may have. Have a good trip. This booklet describes all the versions of the Alfa 159, so you should only consider the information concerning the trim level, engine and version purchased by you. 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:47 Pagina 2 MUST BE READ! REFUELLING K Petrol engines: only refuel with unleaded petrol with octane rating (RON) not less than 95. Diesel engines: only refuel with diesel fuel conforming to the European specification EN590. The use of other products or mixtures may irreparably damage the engine with invalidation of the warranty due to the damage caused. ENGINE STARTING Petrol engines: ensure that the handbrake is up, fully press the clutch pedal, without pressing the accelerator, put the gear lever neutral, fit the electronic key into the ignition device to stop limit, briefly press the START/STOP button. Diesel engines: ensure that the handbrake is up, fully press the clutch pedal, without pressing the accelerator, put the gear lever neutral, fit the electronic key down into the ignition device until it stops. The instrument panel warning light m will turn on, wait for the warning light m to turn off. The hotter the engine is, the quicker this will happen, briefly press the START/STOP button as soon as the warning light m turns on. PARKING ON FLAMMABLE MATERIAL  While working, the catalyst develops a very high temperature. Do not park the car over grass, dry leaves, pine needles or any other inflammable materials: risk of fire. RESPECTING THE ENVIRONMENT A system for continuously monitoring emission system components to ensure greater environmental protection is fitted in your car. 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:47 Pagina 3 ELECTRICAL ACCESSORIES 쇵 If, after buying the car, you decide to add electrical accessories (that will gradually drain the battery), contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. They can calculate the overall electrical requirement and check that the car’s electric system can support the required load. CODE CARD (for versions/markets, where provided) Keep the code card in a safe place, not in the car. SCHEDULED SERVICING Correct maintenance of the car is essential for ensuring it stays in tip-top condition and safeguards its safety features, its environmental friendliness and low running costs for a long time to come. THE OWNER’S MANUAL CONTAINS… …information, tips and important warnings regarding the safe, correct driving of your car, and its maintenance. Pay particular attention to the symbols " (personal safety) # (environmental protection) â (car well-being). 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:47 Pagina 4 Any queries concerning servicing should be forwarded to the showroom from which the car was purchased, the subsidiary company or to our branch offices or any point of the Alfa Romeo Network. Warranty Booklet The Warranty Booklet is delivered together with every new car and contains the regulations tied to the services given by Alfa Romeo Services and to the warranty conditions. Correctly carrying out the scheduled services specified by the manufacturer is the best way to maintain the performance, safety characteristics and low running costs of your car. It is also necessary to maintain warranty cover. “Service” guide This contains the Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. The services can be recognized by the presence of the Alfa Romeo badge and logo. The Alfa Romeo organization in Italy can be found in the telephone book under the letter “A” Alfa Romeo. Not all the models described in this booklet are available in all countries. Only some of the fittings described in this booklet are fitted as standard to the car. The list of available accessories should be requested from the Alfa Romeo Dealers. 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:47 Pagina 5 THE SYMBOLS USED IN THIS BOOKLET The symbols illustrated in these pages show the subjects which should, in particular, be closely studied. PERSONAL SAFETY PROTECTING THE ENVIRONMENT Warning: partially or fully ignoring these rules may lead to serious injury. This indicates the correct procedures to be followed to prevent the car from damaging the environment. CAR SAFETY Warning: partially or fully ignoring these rules may lead to serious damage being caused to the car which, in some circumstances, may cause forfeiture of the warranty cover. The texts, illustrations and specifications given in this booklet refer to the car at the time of going to press. As part of our ongoing striving to improve our products, Alfa Romeo may introduce technical changes during production, therefore the specifications and fittings may be altered without prior notice. For details on this subject, please apply to the manufacturer's sales network. 8-04-2009 10:48 Pagina 6 7 INSTRUMENT PANEL ......................................... 8 SYMBOLS ....................................................... 9 ALFA ROMEO CODE SYSTEM ............................... 9 ELECTRONIC KEY .............................................. 11 ALARM ........................................................... 17 IGNITION DEVICE............................................... 19 INSTRUMENTS.................................................. 21 MULTIFUNCTION DISPLAY ................................... 25 RECONFIGURABLE MULTIFUNCTION DISPLAY.......... 30 SEATS ............................................................ 45 HEAD RESTRAINTS............................................. 48 STEERING WHEEL ............................................. 49 REARVIEW MIRRORS ......................................... 50 CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM ............................... 53 MANUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM ................... 55 AUTOMATIC TWO-/THREE-ZONE CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM ............................... 58 ADDITIONAL HEATER ......................................... 69 EXTERNAL LIGHTS ............................................. 70 CRUISE CONTROL ............................................. CEILING LIGHTS ................................................ CONTROLS ....................................................... INTERIOR FITTINGS............................................ SUNROOF ........................................................ DOORS ........................................................... POWER WINDOWS ........................................... BOOT .............................................................. BONNET .......................................................... ROOF RACK/SKI RACK ...................................... HEADLIGHTS..................................................... ABS SYSTEM ................................................... VDC SYSTEM ................................................... EOBD SYSTEM ................................................. SOUND SYSTEM PRESETTING.............................. ACCESSORIES PURCHASED BY THE OWNER .......... INSTALLATION OF ELECTRIC/ELECTRONIC DEVICES .. PARKING SENSORS ........................................... TYRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (T.P.M.S.) ........................................................ AT THE FILLING STATION .................................... WINDOW WASHING ......................................... 73 PROTECTING THE ENVIRONMENT ........................ 127 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD .................................................... CORRECT USE OF THE CAR DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 6 76 78 81 83 93 96 99 101 105 106 106 108 110 115 116 116 117 118 122 125 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:48 Pagina 7 A0E0056m 1. Adjustable swivel side air vents - 2. Front side window demisting/defrosting vents - 3. External lights control lever - 4. Instrument panel - 5. Driver’s air bag and horn - 6. Windscreen wiper control lever - 7. Upper central vent - 8. Adjustable swivel centre air vents - 9. Fuel level gauge/engine coolant temperature gauge/engine oil temperature gauge (petrol versions) or turbocharger pressure gauge (diesel versions) - 10. Passenger’s air bag - 11. Passenger’s knees air bag (for versions/markets, where provided) - 12. Glove box - 13. Sound system (for versions/markets, where provided) - 14. Heating/ventilation/climate controls - 15. Engine START/STOP button - 16. Ignition device - 17. Driver’s knees air bag 18. Sound system controls on the steering wheel (where provided) - 19. Cruise Control lever (for versions/markets, where provided) - 20. Bonnet opening lever - 21. Dashboard fusebox lid - 22. Switches for external lights, trip meter reset and headlamp aiming device. INDEX fig. 1 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS DASHBOARD 7 8-04-2009 10:48 Pagina 8 INSTRUMENT PANEL A. Speedometer (speed indicator) B. Warning lights - C. Rev counter D. Multifunction display h c m Warning lights on diesel versions only On diesel versions the rev counter end scale value is at 6000 rpm. fig. 2 - Versions with multifunction display A0E0312m fig. 3 - Versions with reconfigurable multifunction display A0E0422m INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 8 A. Speedometer (speed indicator) B. Warning lights - C. Rev counter D. Reconfigurable multifunction display c m Warning lights on diesel versions only On diesel versions the rev counter end scale value is at 6000 rpm. 8-04-2009 10:48 Pagina 9 A. Speedometer (speed indicator) B. Warning lights - C. Rev counter D. Multifunction display A0E0870m fig. 3/b - 1750 TURBO BENZINA versions with reconfigurable multifunction display A0E0871m TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY fig. 3/a - 1750 TURBO BENZINA versions with multifunction display WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 001-045 Alfa 159 GB INDEX A. Speedometer (speed indicator) B. Warning lights - C. Rev counter D. Reconfigurable multifunction display 9 8-04-2009 10:48 Pagina 10 ALFA ROMEO CODE SYSTEM SYMBOLS Special coloured labels have been attached near or actually on some of the components of your car. These labels bear symbols that remind you of the precautions to be taken as regards that particular component. To further protect you car from theft, it has been fitted with an engine immobilising system. This system is automatically activated when the electronic key is removed. The plate summarising the symbols used fig. 4 can be found under the bonnet. INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 10 fig. 4 A0E0138m An electronic device, in fact, is fitted in each electronic key grip. The device transmits a radio-frequency signal when the engine is started through a special aerial built into the ignition switch on the dashboard. The modulated signal, which changes each time the engine is started, is the “password”, by means of which the control unit recognises the electronic key and enables to start the engine. The code is sent only if the Alfa Romeo CODE system control unit has recognised the code transmitted from the electronic key. If the code has not been recognised correctly, the warning light Y turns on (on certain versions a dedicated message is displayed) (see section “Warning lights and messages”). In this case, the electronic key should be removed from the ignition device and then refitted; if the lock continues, possibly try again with the other keys provided with the car. If it is still not possible to start the car contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services SAFETY DEVICES If the warning light Y turns on this means that the system is running a selftest (for example for a voltage drop). The electronic components inside the key may be damaged if the key is submitted to sharp knocks. If the warning light Y stays on, contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. IMPORTANT Every electronic key has its own code, which must be memorised by the system control unit. To memorise new keys, up to a maximum of eight, apply solely to Alfa Romeo Authorized Services taking with you all the keys in your possession, the CODE card, a personal identity document and the car’s possession documents. The codes of the keys not provided during the new memorising procedure are erased from the memory. This is to ensure that any lost or stolen keys can no longer be used to start the car. If 2 seconds after fitting the electronic key into the ignition switch, the warning light Y comes on again flashing (on certain versions a dedicated message is displayed), this means that the code of the keys has not been memorised, thus the car is not protected by the Alfa Romeo CODE system against attempted theft. In this case, contact an Alfa Romeo Authorized Service to have the key codes memorised. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR Each time the electronic key is fitted into the ignition switch, the Alfa Romeo CODE system control unit sends a recognition code to the engine control unit to deactivate the inhibitor. Warning light Y coming on when driving WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES OPERATION DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 11 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:48 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 11 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 12 8-04-2009 10:48 Pagina 12 ELECTRONIC KEY CODE CARD (for versions/markets, where provided) The CODE card fig. 5 delivered with the keys, contains the mechanical code A and the electronic one B. The code numbers on the CODE card must be kept in a safe place, not in the car. If the car changes owner, the new owner must be given the electronic key and the CODE card. fig. 5 A0E0023m ELECTRONIC KEY fig. 6 The car is delivered with two copies of the key with remote control. The electronic key operates the ignition switch. Button Á shall be used for central locking of doors, tailgate and fuel cap with alarm activation (for versions/markets, where provided). fig. 6 A0E0021m Button Ë shall be used for central opening of doors and fuel cap with alarm deactivation (for versions/markets, where provided). Button ` shall be used to open the tailgate. When unlocking the doors by pressing button Ë, if by 2.5 minutes no door or the boot is opened, the system will automatically lock the car again. Pagina 13 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS The electronic key fig. 7 is fitted with a metal insert A, that can be extracted by pressing button B. ❒ windows opening/closing; ❒ switch (for versions/markets, where provided) for deactivating the passenger’s air bag and knees air bag (for versions/markets, where provided); ❒ safe-lock device (for versions/markets, where provided); A0E0022m fig. 7 IMPORTANT Never expose the electronic key to direct sunlight: risk of damages. IMPORTANT Remote control frequency may be disturbed by radio transmissions outside the car (e.g. mobile phones, hams, etc…). In this event remote control may be failing. ❒ emergency unlocking of electronic key from ignition switch. WARNING Never leave the electronic key unattended to prevent anyone, especially children, from holding it and pressing button B-fig. 7 inadvertently. fig. 8 A0E0021m Replacing the battery of the electronic key If when pressing button Ë, Á, or `, control given is refused or failing, the battery should be replaced with an equivalent one that can be purchased at common stores. To be sure that the battery is to be replaced, try again to press buttons Ë, Á, or ` with another electronic key. When closing the tailgate again, protection sensors are restored and direction indicators will flash once. WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR ❒ central door locking/unlocking through the driver's door lock (with run-down car battery only the driver's door will open); SAFETY DEVICES The metal insert operates the following: IN AN EMERGENCY 10:48 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 13 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:48 Pagina 14 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS SAFE LOCK DEVICE (for versions/markets, where provided) INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES This safety system inhibits the operation of the car door handles. 14 fig. 9 A0E0035m To change the battery fig. 9 proceed as follows: ❒ take out the metal insert A by pressing button B; ❒ remove the snap-fitted case Bfig. 10 (red) by levering with the metal insert A of the electronic key in the point shown in the figure; ❒ remove the battery D-fig. 9 from the case taking note of the bias (in the figure the positive pole is facing downwards); ❒ put the new battery into the case with the correct bias; ❒ put the case down into its seat and refit the metal insert. fig. 10 A0E0242m IMPORTANT Never touch the electric contacts of the key and prevent fluid or dust infiltration inside it. Used batteries are harmful to the environment. They should be disposed of as specified by law in the special containers provided, or take them to Alfa Romeo Authorized Services which will deal with their disposal. The safe lock device represents top protection against break in attempts. Activate it each time you park the car. WARNING Once the safe lock device has been actuated, doors cannot be opened from inside the car in any way whatsoever. For this reason, make sure there are no persons left inside the car. WARNING If the key battery is flat, the safe lock device can only be deactivated by unlocking the doors by turning the metal insert of the key into the driver’s door lock or by fitting the key into the ignition device. fig. 11 A0E0021m Device activation The device is automatically activated on every door in the following cases: ❒ turning twice the metal insert of the electronic key into the driver door to locking position; ❒ pressing twice the electronic key button Á. Should one of the doors be not perfectly closed, the safe lock device is not activated, thus preventing that a person getting into the car from the open door remains blocked inside the passenger’s compartment when he/she closes the door. Device deactivation The device is deactivated automatically on every door in the following cases: ❒ when unlocking the doors; ❒ when unlocking only the driver’s door (where possible); ❒ when fitting the electronic key into the ignition switch. SAFETY DEVICES If the car battery is down, the safe lock device can be activated only using the metal insert of the electronic key on the driver’s door revolving plug: in this case the safe lock device is active on front passenger’s door and rear doors. WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR Device activation is signalled by three flashes of the led on the driver’s door panel and, only if activated by pressing the electronic key button Á, of direction indicators. WARNING DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 15 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:48 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 15 WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR IN AN EMERGENCY INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 16 8-04-2009 10:48 Pagina 16 The main functions that can be activated with the electronic key or with the emergency metals insert are the following: Doors, tailgate and fuel cap unlocking Doors, tailgate and fuel cap locking Window Window Safe lock and sunroof and sunroof (for versions/ opening closing markets, (for versions/ (for versions/ where markets, markets, provided) where where provided) provided) Electronic key Brief press on button Ë (*) Brief press on button Á Prolonged pressing (over 2 seconds) on button Ë Emergency metal insert Electronic key rotation clockwise (*) Electronic key rotation counter-clockwise Electronic key rotation for over 2 seconds clockwise Direction indicators flashing 2 flashings 1 flashing 2 flashings Led on driver’s door Deterrence led off Turning on fixed for 3 seconds, followed by deterrence led flashing SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 001-045 Alfa 159 GB – Double pressing (within 1 second) on button Á Electronic key Double electronic rotation key rotation within 1 for over second 2 seconds counter-clockwise counter-clockwise 1 flashing Deterrence led off Turning on fixed for about 3 seconds, followed by deterrence led flashing Tailgate opening Brief press on button ` – 3 flashings 2 flashings Double flashing, followed by deterrence led flashing – (*) On certain versions it is possible to set the option “Unlocking front door only” through the “Setup Menu” (see paragraph “Reconfigurable multifunction display” in this section). In this case pressing button Á and turning the metal insert of the electronic key counter-clockwise will unlock the driver’s door only. To unlock all the doors, press twice button Ë within 1 second or turn twice the metal insert of the electronic key counter-clockwise. IMPORTANT Window and sunroof opening operations are a consequence of a door unlocking control. Window and sunroof closing operations are a consequence of a door locking control. Pagina 17 WHEN THE ALARM IS TRIGGERED The alarm comes into action in the following cases: ❒ unlawful opening of doors, bonnet and boot (perimetral protection); ❒ attempt to start the engine with unauthorised electronic key; ❒ battery cable cutting; ❒ presence of moving bodies in the passenger’s compartment (volumetric protection); ❒ abnormal raising/sloping of the car (for versions/markets where applicable); Volumetric and anti-raising protections can be cut off by operating the front ceiling light controls(see paragraph “Volumetric protection/Anti-raising sensor” on the following pages). A maximum number of sound/sight cycles is however envisaged. Once the alarm cycle is over, the system will restore its normal operation. IMPORTANT Central door unlocking by the emergency electronic key will not deactivate the alarm, therefore with alarm on the siren will activate when opening one of the doors or the boot. To deactivate the siren see paragraph “How to deactivate the alarm”. IMPORTANT The engine immobiliser function is guaranteed by the Alfa Romeo CODE system, which is automatically activated when the electronic key is removed from the ignition device. DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS SAFETY DEVICES (for versions/markets, where provided) Depending on the markets, the triggering of the alarm will activate the siren and the hazard warning lights (for about 26 seconds). The methods of operation and the number of cycles may vary depending on the versions/markets. fig. 12 A0E0025m HOW TO ACTIVATE THE ALARM With the doors, bonnet and boot shut and electronic key removed from ignition switch, point the electronic key in the direction of the car, then press and release the button Á. With the exception of certain markets, the system sounds a “beep” and the doors are locked. Engagement of the alarm is preceded by a self-diagnostic test characterised by a different flashing of the round led located around the door lock/unlock button (see fig. 12): if a fault is detected the system sounds a further warning “beep”. WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR ALARM IN AN EMERGENCY 10:48 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 17 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 18 8-04-2009 10:48 Pagina 18 Surveillance When the system has been turned on, the led A-fig. 12 will flash to indicate that the system is in the surveillance mode. The led will flash continuously while the system is under surveillance. IMPORTANT Operation of the alarm is adapted at the origin to the regulations of the different countries. Self-diagnosis and monitoring of doors/bonnet/boot If, after the alarm has been activated, a second acoustic signal is heard, turn the system off by pressing button Ë, check for proper locking of doors, bonnet and boot, then turn the system on again by pressing button Á. Otherwise if a door or bonnet/boot lid is not correctly closed it will not be controlled by the system. If the control signal is repeated when the doors and bonnet/boot are closed properly this means that the self-diagnosis function has detected a system operating fault, in which case it is necessary to contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. HOW TO DEACTIVATE THE ALARM Press button Ë. The system will react as follows (with the exception of certain markets): ❒ two brief flashes of the direction indicators; ❒ two brief “beeps”; ❒ door unlocking. The alarm can be deactivated by fitting the electronic key into the ignition switch. IMPORTANT On certain versions any attempt to break in detected by the system will be indicated by a warning message on the instrument panel display when fitting the electronic key into the ignition switch. fig. 13 A0E0480m VOLUMETRIC PROTECTION/ ANTI-RAISING SENSORS To make sure that the protection sensors are working properly, check that windows and sunroof (for versions/markets, where provided) are shut. This function can be cut out (for example if you leave animals on the car) by pressing button A-fig. 13 on the front ceiling light within 1 minute after instrument panel turning off. When this function is off the button led will turn on. Volumetric protection/antiraising sensors cut out shall be repeated at each instrument panel turning off. To deactivate the alarm system completely (for instance during prolonged inactivity of the car) simply lock the car by rotating the metal insert (provided inside the electronic key) into the driver’s door lock. The ignition device is located on the dashboard and it consists of the following: MINISTERIAL HOMOLOGATION In keeping with the laws in force in each country on the subject of radio frequency, for markets in which the transmitter needs to be marked the certification number is given on the component. For certain versions/markets, the code may also be marked on the transmitter and/or on the receiver. SAFETY DEVICES IGNITION DEVICE ❒ electronic key reading device Afig. 14 (set near the steering wheel); ❒ button START/STOP (set under the electronic key reading device). IMPORTANT To prevent running down the battery do not leave the electronic key into the ignition device when the engine is off. WARNING If the ignition device is tampered with (for example during an attempted break-in) have it checked over by Alfa Romeo Authorized Services before travelling again. A0E0219m fig. 14 WARNING When leaving the car always remove the electronic key from the ignition device to prevent any passenger in the car from inadvertently activating the controls. Remember to engage the handbrake and if the car is facing uphill, first gear and if the car is facing downhill, reverse. Never leave children unattended in the car. WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR HOW TO CUT OFF THE ALARM SYSTEM DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 19 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:48 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 19 8-04-2009 10:48 Pagina 20 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 001-045 Alfa 159 GB INDEX TURNING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL OFF Proceed as follows: With engine off and clutch and brake pedals released, press button START/ STOP or remove the electronic key from the ignition device. ❒ fit the electronic key into the ignition device; SAFETY DEVICES WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR IN AN EMERGENCY TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 20 TURNING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL ON fig. 15 A0E0028m ENGINE STARTING See paragraph “Engine starting” in section “Correct use of the car”. START/STOP BUTTON fig. 15 Button START/STOP, set on the dashboard, controls car electric systems and engine starting/stopping. Button START/STOP is fitted with knurled ring and led. When the led and the instrument panel are on, the engine can be started. ❒ if the electronic key is fitted yet, press button START/STOP without pressing the clutch or brake pedal. To safeguard the battery, when leaving the car with the instrument panel on, electric and electronic devices will be deactivated after approx. 1 hour. IMPORTANT Fit completely the electronic key into the ignition device until it locks into place. IMPORTANT Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services if the instrument panel fails to turn on. IMPORTANT If when fitting the electronic key into the ignition device, the warning light Y on the instrument panel comes on (on certain versions together with a message on the display), check whether the electronic key is the proper one and then try to refit it into the ignition device. If the problem persists contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. A few seconds after the instrument panel display will turn off gradually. IMPORTANT Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services if the instrument panel fails to turn off. The steering column lock will engage 5 seconds after removing the electronic key from the ignition device and if the following conditions are present: ❒ engine off; ❒ instrument panel off with car at a standstill; ❒ electronic key removed from ignition device. Disengaging The steering column lock will disengage after fitting the electronic key into the ignition device. IMPORTANT Switching the engine off when the car is running will not engage the steering column lock till next switching off with car stopped. In this event warning light > (where provided) on the instrument panel will come on (or as an alternative, on certain versions, a symbol and a message are displayed). IMPORTANT Steering column lock failure is indicated by the instrument panel warning light > (where provid- INSTRUMENTS IMPORTANT If after trying to turn on the instrument panel and/or to start the engine, the instrument panel warning light > (where provided) (or as an alternative, on certain versions the message "Vehicle protection system not available" is displayed), repeat the operation moving the steering wheel in order to release the steering lock. The displayed warning message will not impair steering lock operation. Rev counter shows engine rpm. The red zone at the scale bottom indicates that the engine is running at excessive rpm dangerous for mechanical components. Do not drive with the pointer in this area. WARNING It is absolutely forbidden to carry out whatever after-market operation involving steering system or steering column modifications (e.g.: installation of anti-theft device) that could badly affect performance and safety, cause the lapse of warranty and also result in non-compliance of the car with homologation requirements. REV. COUNTER IMPORTANT The electronic injection control system gradually shuts off the flow of fuel when the engine is “overrevving” (rev counter pointer in the red area) resulting in a gradual loss of engine power, in order to bring engine rpm below to the safety limit. The rev counter may, when the engine is idling, indicate gradual or sudden increase of engine revs as the case may be; such behaviour is normal and must not be interpreted as a faulty condition as it occurs during normal operation, for instance when climate control or electric fan are switched on. In particular, slow revs variation helps keep the battery charged. SAFETY DEVICES Engaging ed) (or as an alternative, on certain versions, a symbol and a message are displayed). In this event contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR STEERING COLUMN LOCK DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 21 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:48 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 21 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:48 Pagina 22 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE GAUGE fig. 18 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES This shows the temperature of the engine coolant fluid and begins working when the fluid temperature exceeds approx. 50°C. 22 fig. 17 A0E00177m FUEL GAUGE fig. 17 This shows the amount of fuel left in the fuel tank. 0 - tank empty. 1 - tank full (see the indications given in paragraph “At the filling station"). The warning light on the fuel level gauge turns on when about 10 litres fuel are left in the tank. On certain versions. the display will show a warning message when the cruising range is less than 50 km (or 31 mi). If warning light K starts flashing when travelling contact immediately Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. fig. 18 A0E0178m IMPORTANT The pointer can reach the red area also for a sum of unfavourable conditions, i.e.: slow speed, uphill, fully laden or towing a trailer with hot outside temperature. IMPORTANT Refuelling shall always be performed with engine off. Failing to observe this precaution could cause the gauge to provide wrong indications. Should this occur, to restore proper indication just have next refuelling with the engine off. Otherwise contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. The pointer should normally be towards the middle of the scale. If the pointer reaches the red sector, reduce your demand on the engine. The turning on of the warning light u (on certain versions together with a message on the display) indicates that the coolant fluid temperature is too high; in this case, stop the engine and contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services . IMPORTANT The pointer can reach the red area also for a sum of unfavourable conditions, i.e.: slow speed, uphill, fully laden or towing a trailer with hot outside temperature. Pagina 23 A0E0179m ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE GAUGE (petrol versions excluded 1750 TURBO BENZINA) fig. 19 This shows the temperature of the engine oil and begins working when the oil temperature exceeds approx. 70°C. If the pointer reaches the red sector, reduce your demand on the engine. SAFETY DEVICES fig. 20 A0E0180m TURBOCHARGER PRESSURE GAUGE (1750 TURBO BENZINA and diesel versions) fig. 20 This shows the turbocharger pressure value. WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR fig. 19 IMPORTANT The pointer can reach the red area also for a sum of unfavourable conditions, i.e.: slow speed, uphill, fully laden or towing a trailer with hot outside temperature. DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS The turning on of the warning light ` when travelling (on certain versions together with a message on the display) indicates that the oil temperature is too high; in this case, stop the engine and contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. IN AN EMERGENCY 10:48 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 23 8-04-2009 10:48 Pagina 24 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 24 fig. 21 A0E0072m TRIP METER RESET fig. 21 To reset the trip meter, keep button A pressed for a few seconds. MANUAL INSTRUMENT PANEL LIGHT DIMMER AUTOMATIC INSTRUMENT PANEL LIGHT DIMMER With this function it is possible to adjust on 8 levels the light intensity of the indications given on the instrument panel display, sound system display (for versions/markets, where provided), climate control system display, radionavigation system display (for versions/markets, where provided), and instrument panel gauges (fuel level gauge, engine oil temperature gauge (petrol versions) or supercharger pressure gauge (diesel versions) and engine coolant temperature gauge). To give max. visibility and comfort under whatever driving conditions (e.g.: lights on in daylight, tunnels, etc…), the speedometer is fitted with a sensor for adjusting automatically, after fitting the electronic key into the ignition device and pressing button START/ STOP, the light intensity of the indications given on the instrument panel display, sound system display (for versions/markets, where provided), climate control system display, radionavigation system display (for versions/markets, where provided), and instrument panel gauges (fuel level gauge, engine oil temperature gauge (petrol versions) or supercharger pressure gauge (diesel versions) and engine coolant temperature gauge). To increase light intensity press briefly button + on the left-hand stalk, to reduce it press button –: the display will show an indication and a figure corresponding to the current light intensity level. This screen will be displayed for a few seconds and then it will go off. ❒ Scheduled servicing (symbol õ D-fig. 22). (for versions/markets, where provided) ❒ Instrument panel light dimmer. The “Multifunction display” shows all the useful information necessary when driving, more particularly: fig. 22 A0E0060m ❒ Clock A-fig. 22; IN AN EMERGENCY ❒ External temperature B; Fitting the electronic key into the ignition device will display the total km (or mi), press button A-fig. 23 for trip meter (or mi). ❒ Speed limit exceeded. ❒ Engine oil level. INFORMATION ON STANDARD SCREEN ❒ Total km (or mi) or trip meter C (when total kilometres (or miles) are indicated the display will also show the wording TOT). ❒ Symbol of possible presence of ice on the road (symbol √ E-fig. 22). SAFETY DEVICES INFORMATION ABOUT CAR CONDITIONS (at event) MULTIFUNCTION DISPLAY DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 25 WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR 10:48 fig. 23 A0E0072m To reset the trip meter (or mi), press for long button A-fig. 23 during displaying. TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 25 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 26 8-04-2009 10:48 Pagina 26 “SETUP MENU” Speed limit (SPEED BEEP) There is also a “Setup Menu” enabling to perform the adjustments and/or settings described on the following pages by pressing button MENU and +/– (see fig. 24). The Setup can be activated by pressing briefly button MENU. With this function it is possible to set the car speed limit (km/h or mph) which, if exceeded, automatically sounds a buzzer and displays a specific message (see section “Warning lights and messages”) to alert the driver. Once the warning cycle is over the display will resume the standard screen. The warning message will disappear only after the car speed slows 5 km/h (5 mph) below the set speed limit or after pressing briefly the MENU button. This procedure is carried out just once after exceeding the speed limit and it can be repeated only if the car speed slows at least 5 km/h (5 mph) below the set speed limit and then it increases until exceeding the speed limit again. With the car stopped, the following settings are enabled: ❒ Speed limit on/off and speed limit value. ❒ Clock. ❒ Failure/warning buzzer volume. ❒ “Distance” unit. With the car running, only the following setting is enabled: ❒ Speed limit on/off and speed limit value setting. fig. 24 A0E0074m CONTROL BUTTONS (set on left stalk) fig. 24 MENU Short push on button: to confirm the required option and/or to go to next screen; Long push on button: to confirm the required option and to go back to standard screen; +/– to scroll up/down the “Setup Menu” options or to increase/decrease the value displayed on the screen. When the standard screen is displayed buttons +/– activate instrument panel light dimming. This function enables to adjust the clock. To adjust the clock proceed as follows: ❒ press button MENU until selecting TIME REG; ❒ press again button MENU: TIME and clock will flash; ❒ press buttons +/– to adjust time. Clock is always displayed in 24h mode (24 hours). Failure/warning buzzer volume (BUZZ) With this function the volume of the buzzer accompanying any failure/warning indications can be adjusted according to 4 levels. The buzzer can be adjusted and excluded. Proceed as follows: ❒ press button MENU until selecting BUZZ: the display will show BUZZ and a figure corresponding to the buzzer volume level; ❒ press again button MENU: the figure will flash; ❒ press buttons +/– to adjust the buzzer volume. To mute the buzzer set the volume level to “0” using buttons +/–. SAFETY DEVICES Clock (TIME REG) WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR To set the speed limit, proceed as follows: ❒ press button MENU until selecting SPEED BEEP: the display will show SPEED BEEP and setting condition (ON = speed limit on/ OFF= speed limit off); ❒ press again button MENU: ON (or OFF) will flash; ❒ press buttons +/– to select ON or OFF; ❒ selecting ON will make the last speed limit set flashing on the display; ❒ press buttons +/– to adjust the value. IMPORTANT The possible setting is between 30 and 250 km/h (or between 20 and 150 mph) depending on the unit set previously (see paragraph “Units” described later). Every press (pulse) of the button +/– increases or decreases the value by 5 units. Keeping the button +/– pressed obtains automatic fast increase or decrease. When you are near the required setting complete adjustment with single presses. DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 27 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:48 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 27 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 28 8-04-2009 10:48 Pagina 28 Distance unit (UNIT) With this function it is possible to set the required distance unit (km or mi). To set the distance unit, proceed as follows: ❒ press button MENU until selecting UNIT: the display will show UNIT and “km” or “mi”; ❒ press again button MENU: “km” (or “mi”) will flash; ❒ press buttons +/– to set the required distance unit. Scheduled servicing IMPORTANT The Service schedule includes car maintenance every 35,000 km (or 21,000 mi); this is shown automatically, with the electronic key into the ignition device starting from 2,000 km (or 1,240 mi) from this deadline and it will be displayed in km or miles according to the unit set. When a scheduled service interval (“coupon”) is near to come, fitting the electronic key into the ignition device will display a message followed by the number of km/mi to go before car servicing. Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services to carry out any service operation provided by the Service schedule or by the Annual inspection plan, and to reset the display. ENGINE OIL LEVEL INDICATION Fitting the electronic key into the ignition device, the display will show for a few seconds the engine oil level. At this stage, to clear this indication and to go to next screen, press button MENU. Low oil level will be indicated by a dedicated warning message on the display. IMPORTANT Check the proper engine oil level on the dipstick (see paragraph “Checking levels” in section “Car maintenance”). IMPORTANT Proper engine oil level shall be checked with the car on level ground. IMPORTANT To read the correct oil level after fitting the electronic key, wait for about 2 seconds before starting the engine. IMPORTANT Engine oil level could increase after a long stop. This function enables to turn on/off (ON/OFF) the lights of the rev counter and instruments. This function can be activated (only with electronic key fitted into ignition device, external lights on, and speedometer built-in sensor in poor outside light setting), by pressing for long button –. When this function is on, the display will show “NIGHT PAN ON”. Once on, the NIGHT PAN function can be deactivated as follows: ❒ by long press on button + (also with external lights off); ❒ removing the electronic key from the ignition device. When this function is off the display shows “NIGHT PAN OFF”. Messages “NIGHT PAN ON” or “NIGHT PAN OFF” stay on the display for a few seconds, then they will go off. To stop displaying before time, briefly press button MENU. SAFETY DEVICES After the engine oil level, the display will show for a few seconds a message indicating the procedure to follow to start the engine (PRESS PEDAL AND START: press brake or clutch pedal and then press button START/STOP to start the engine). ILLUMINATION OF REV COUNTER/INSTRUMENTS (NIGHT PAN) WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR MESSAGES DISPLAYED AT STARTING DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 29 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:48 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 29 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 30 8-04-2009 10:48 Pagina 30 INFORMATION ABOUT CAR CONDITIONS (at event) RECONFIGURABLE MULTIFUNCTION DISPLAY ❒ Scheduled servicing; ❒ Trip computer; (for versions/markets, where provided) The “Reconfigurable multifunction display” shows all the useful information necessary when driving, more particularly: INFORMATION ON STANDARD SCREEN ❒ Clock A-fig. 24/a; ❒ External temperature B; ❒ Date C; ❒ Partial km (or mi) covered D; ❒ Total km (or mi) covered E; ❒ Indications on car conditions F (e.g.: doors open, or possible ice on road, etc. ...). ❒ Instrument panel light dimmer; ❒ Engine oil level; fig. 24/a A0E0015m The date C in the middle of the display will stay on until another display info is activated (e.g. “Light dimmer”) or other information on car conditions. With key removed (when opening when of the front doors) the display will turn on and show for a few seconds the time, covered km (or miles) and outside temperature. IMPORTANT When opening one of the front doors, the display will show for a few seconds the time, the km covered and the external temperature. MENU ❒ briefly press button MENU to select the main menu option to set; ❒ operate buttons + or – (by single press) to select the new setting; ❒ briefly press button MENU to store new setting and go back to the previously selected option of the main menu. Short push on button: to confirm the required option and/or to go to next screen; Long push on button: to confirm the required option and/or to go to previous screen; +/– to scroll up/down the “Setup Menu” options or to increase/decrease the value displayed on the screen. When the standard screen is displayed buttons +/– activate instrument panel light dimming. fig. 25 A0E0074m “SETUP MENU” There is also a “Setup Menu” enabling to perform the adjustments and/or settings described on the following pages by pressing button MENU and +/– (see fig. 25).The Setup can be activated by pressing briefly button MENU. The menu comprises a series of functions arranged in a “circular fashion” fig. 26. SAFETY DEVICES Selecting an option of the main menu without submenu: WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR CONTROL BUTTONS DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 31 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:48 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 31 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 32 8-04-2009 10:48 Pagina 32 Selecting an option of the main menu with submenu: ❒ briefly press button MENU to display the first submenu option; ❒ operate buttons + or – (by single press) to scroll all submenu options; ❒ briefly press button MENU to select the displayed submenu option and to enter the corresponding setup menu; ❒ operate buttons + or – (by single press) to select the new setting of this submenu option; ❒ briefly press button MENU to store the new setting and go back to the previously selected submenu option. Selecting “Date” and “Clock”: ❒ briefly press button MENU to select the first value to change (e.g. hours/ minutes or year/month/day); ❒ operate buttons + or – (by single press) to select the new setting; ❒ briefly press button MENU to store the new setting and to go to the next setup menu option, if this is the last one you will go back to the previously selected option of the main menu. ENGINE OIL LEVEL INDICATION Fitting the electronic key into the ignition device, the display will show for a few seconds the engine oil level. At this stage, to clear this indication and to go to next screen, press button MENU. Low oil level will be indicated by a dedicated warning message on the display. IMPORTANT Check the proper engine oil level on the dipstick (see paragraph “Checking levels” in section “Car maintenance”). IMPORTANT Proper engine oil level shall be checked with the car on level ground. IMPORTANT To read the correct oil level after fitting the electronic key, wait for about 2 seconds before starting the engine. IMPORTANT Engine oil level could increase after a long stop. Pagina 33 SPEED LIMIT LIGHT SENS. RESET TRIP B CLOCK SERVICE IN AN EMERGENCY QUIT SETUP WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR Briefly press button MENU to access navigation from the standard screen. To surf the menu press buttons + or –. For safety reasons, when the car is running, it is possible to access only the reduced menu (for setting “Speed limit”). When the car is stationary access to the whole menu is enabled. With the Radionavigation system it is only possible to adjust/set the following functions: “Speed Limit”, “Light sensor sensitivity ” (for versions/markets, where provided) and “S.B.R. buzzer reactivation” (for versions/markets, where provided). The other functions are shown on the Radionavigation system display, that shall be use to adjust/set them as required. DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 10:48 SAFETY DEVICES 8-04-2009 MODE 12/24 KEYS VOL. BEEP VOL. TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE DATE AUDIO RPT. INDEP. BOOT LANGUAGE UNITS DOOR LOCK UNLOCK FDA A0E0218g INDEX 001-045 Alfa 159 GB fig. 26 33 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 34 8-04-2009 10:48 Pagina 34 Speed limit With this function it is possible to set the car speed limit (km/h or mph) which, if exceeded, automatically sounds a buzzer and displays a special message (see section “Warning lights and messages”) to alert the driver. To set the speed limit, proceed as follows: IMPORTANT The possible setting is between 30 and 250 km/h (or between 20 and 150 mph) depending on the unit set previously (see paragraph “Units” described later). Every press (pulse) of the button +/– increases or decreases the value by 5 units. Keeping the button +/– pressed obtains automatic fast increase or decrease. When you are near the required setting complete adjustment with single presses. Automatic headlight daylight sensor (Light Sens.) (for versions/markets, where provided) With this function it is possible to adjust the light sensor sensitivity according to 3 levels. To adjust the volume proceed as follows: To abort the setting: ❒ briefly press button MENU : the previously set level will flash on the display; ❒ press button +: the display will show ON; ❒ briefly press button MENU: the display will show ON; ❒ press button + or – to select the required volume; ❒ briefly press button MENU then, use buttons +/– to set the required speed (during setting the value will flash). ❒ press button –: the display will show OFF; ❒ briefly press button MENU to go back to the menu screen or press the button for long to go back to the standard screen. ❒ briefly press button MENU: the display will show OFF; ❒ briefly press button MENU to go back to the menu screen or press the button for long to go back to the standard screen. ❒ briefly press button MENU to go back to the menu screen or press the button for long to go back to the standard screen. Reset Trip B This function enables to select Trip B reset mode (Automatic or Manual). For further information see paragraph “Trip computer”. Proceed as follows: ❒ briefly press button MENU: “hours” will show on the display; ❒ press button + or – to select the required volume; ❒ briefly press button MENU: “minutes” will flash on the display; ❒ press button + or – to adjust; ❒ briefly press button MENU to go back to the menu screen or press the button for long to go back to the standard screen. Clock mode (Mode 12/24) This function is used to set the clock in the 12h or 24h mode. To adjust proceed as follows: ❒ briefly press button MENU: 12h or 24h (according to previous setting) will show on the display; ❒ press button + or – to select the required language; ❒ briefly press button MENU to go back to the menu screen or press the button for long to go back to the standard screen. SAFETY DEVICES This function enables to set the clock. IMPORTANT Every press (pulse) on the button +/– increases/decreases by one unit. Keeping button +/– pressed obtains fast increase/decrease. When you are near the required setting complete adjustment with single presses. WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR Setting the clock (Clock) DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 35 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:48 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 35 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:48 Pagina 36 Setting the date (Date) This function enables to update the date (year - month - day). INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES Proceed as follows: 36 ❒ briefly press button MENU: “year” will flash on the display; Audio Info Repetition (Audio Rpt.) (for versions/markets, where provided) This function enables to display sound system information. ❒ press button + or – to select the required volume; ❒ Radio: selected radio station frequency or RDS message, automatic tuning activation or AutoSTore; ❒ briefly press button MENU: “month” will flash on the display; ❒ Audio CD, MP3 CD: selected track number; ❒ press button + or – to select the required volume; ❒ CD Changer: CD number and track number; ❒ briefly press button MENU: “day” will flash on the display; ❒ press button + or – to adjust; IMPORTANT Every press (pulse) on the button +/– increases/decreases by one unit. Keeping button +/– pressed obtains fast increase/decrease. When you are near the required setting complete adjustment with single presses. ❒ briefly press button MENU to go back to the menu screen or press the button for long to go back to the standard screen. To activate/deactivate (ON/OFF) info displaying proceed as follows: ❒ briefly press button MENU: the display will show ON or OFF (according to previous setting); ❒ press button + or – to select the required source; ❒ briefly press button MENU to go back to the menu screen or press the button for long to go back to the standard screen. According to the audio source selected, below the time will be displayed the symbol of the current source. Automatic central door locking (Door lock) With this function it is possible to unlock the boot independently from doors. With this function it is possible to unlock only the driver’s door by pressing the electronic key button Ë. When activated (ON), this function locks automatically the doors when the car speed exceeds 20 km/h. With this function active (ON), it is however possible to unlock the other doors by pressing the door unlock button on central console. To activate/deactivate (ON/OFF) this function proceed as follows: When the function is enabled, the trunk opens by pressing ` on the electronic key, or by acting on the lever located under the left back seat (refer to “Boot” paragraph in this chapter). To activate independent boot function (ON) or deactivate it (OFF), proceed as follows: ❒ briefly press button MENU : ON or OFF (according to previous setting) will flash on the display; ❒ press button + or – to select the required language; ❒ briefly press button MENU to go back to the menu screen or press the button for long to go back to the standard screen. To activate/deactivate (ON/OFF) this function proceed as follows: ❒ briefly press button MENU: ON or OFF (according to previous setting) will flash on the display; ❒ press button + or – to select the required language; ❒ briefly press button MENU to go back to the menu screen or press the button for long to go back to the standard screen. ❒ briefly press button MENU: ON or OFF (according to previous setting) will flash on the display; ❒ press button + or – to select the required language; ❒ briefly press button MENU to go back to the menu screen or press the button for long to go back to the standard screen. Function activation is indicated by the circular led around the button q. SAFETY DEVICES Driver’s door unlocking (Unlock Fda) WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR Independent boot unlocking (Indep. Boot) DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 37 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:48 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 37 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 38 8-04-2009 10:48 Pagina 38 Units Consumption Temperature With this function it is possible to set the units for distance covered (km or mi), fuel consumption (l/100 km, km/l or mpg) and temperature (°C or °F). If the distance unit set is km (see previous paragraph) the display will enable to set the fuel consumption unit (l/100 km, km/l or mpg). This function enables to set the temperature unit (°C or °F). Distance If the distance unit set is “mi” (see previous paragraph) fuel consumption will be displayed “mpg”. ❒ briefly press button MENU: °C or °F (according to previous setting) will show on the display; In this case the option “Cons.Unit” of the “Setup Menu” can be selected but it is locked on “mpg”. ❒ press button + or – to select the required language; To set the required unit proceed as follows: ❒ briefly press button MENU: “km” or “mi” (according to previous setting) will show on the display; ❒ press button + or – to select the required language; ❒ briefly press button MENU to go back to the menu screen or press the button for long to go back to the standard screen. To set the required unit proceed as follows: ❒ briefly press button MENU: “km/l” or “l/100 km” (according to previous setting) will show on the display; ❒ press button + or – to select the required language; ❒ briefly press button MENU to go back to the menu screen or press the button for long to go back to the standard screen. To set the required unit proceed as follows: ❒ briefly press button MENU to go back to the menu screen or press the button for long to go back to the standard screen. Adjusting the button volume (Keys Vol.) Display messages can be shown in the following languages: Italian, English, German, Portuguese, Spanish, French, Dutch and Brazilian. With this function the volume of the buzzer accompanying any failure/warning indication can be adjusted according to 8 levels. With this function the volume of the roger-beep accompanying the activation of certain buttons can be adjusted according to 8 levels. To set the required language proceed as follows: To adjust the volume proceed as follows: To adjust the volume proceed as follows: ❒ briefly press button MENU, the previously set “level” will show on the display; ❒ briefly press button MENU, the previously set “level” will show on the display; ❒ press button + or – to select the required volume; ❒ press button + or – to select the required volume; ❒ briefly press button MENU to go back to the menu screen or press the button for long to go back to the standard screen. ❒ briefly press button MENU to go back to the menu screen or press the button for long to go back to the standard screen. ❒ briefly press button MENU , the previously set “language” will show on the display; ❒ press button + or – to select the required language; ❒ briefly press button MENU to go back to the menu screen or press the button for long to go back to the standard screen. SAFETY DEVICES Adjusting the failure/warning buzzer volume (Beep Vol.) WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR Selecting the language (Language) DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 39 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:48 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 39 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 40 8-04-2009 10:48 Pagina 40 Scheduled Servicing (Service) Through this function it is possible to display information connected to proper car servicing. Proceed as follows: ❒ briefly press button MENU : service in km or mi, according to previous setting, will be displayed (see paragraph “Units”); ❒ briefly press button MENU to go back to the menu screen or press the button for long to go back to the standard screen. IMPORTANT The Service schedule includes car maintenance every 35,000 km (or 21,000 mi); this is shown automatically, with the electronic key into the ignition device starting from 2,000 km (or 1,240 mi) from this deadline and it will be displayed in km or miles according to the unit set. When a scheduled service interval (“coupon”) is near to come, fitting the electronic key into the ignition device will display a message followed by the number of km/mi to go before car servicing. Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services to carry out any service operation provided by the Service schedule or by the Annual inspection plan, and to reset the display. Reactivating the S.B.R. (Seat Belt Reminder) buzzer (Beep Seatb.) (for versions/markets, where provided) This function is displayed only after the system has been deactivated by Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. Exit Menu (Quit setup) Selecting this option will bring back to standard screen. ILLUMINATION OF REV COUNTER/INSTRUMENTS (NIGHT PANEL) This function enables to turn on/off (ON/OFF) the lights of the rev counter and instruments. This function can be activated (only with electronic key fitted into ignition device, external lights on, and speedometer built-in sensor in poor outside light setting), by pressing for long button –. When this function is on, the display will show a warning message. Once on, the NIGHT PANEL function can be deactivated as follows: ❒ by long press on button + (also with external lights off); ❒ removing the electronic key from the ignition device. When function is off the display will show a warning message. Messages stay on the display for a few seconds, then they will go off. To stop displaying before time, briefly press button MENU. 10:48 Pagina 41 TRIP COMPUTER General features The “Trip computer” displays information (with electronic key fitted into ignition device) relating to the operating status of the car. This function comprises the “Trip A” concerning the “complete mission” of the car (journey) and “Trip B” concerning the partial mission of the car; this latter function (as shown in fig. 27) is “contained” within the complete mission. DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 8-04-2009 SAFETY DEVICES 001-045 Alfa 159 GB End of partial mission Start of new partial mission Reset TRIP B End of partial mission Start of new partial mission IN AN EMERGENCY TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE ˙ End of partial mission Start of new partial mission TRIP B ˙ ˙ ˙ fig. 27 Reset TRIP B TRIP B ˙ Reset TRIP B End of partial mission Start of new partial mission Reset TRIP B ˙ TRIP B ˙ ˙ Trip A INDEX Reset Trip A End of complete mission Start of new mission Reset Trip A End of complete mission Start of new mission WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR Both functions are resettable (reset - start of new mission). 41 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 42 8-04-2009 10:48 Pagina 42 The “Trip A” displays the figures relating to: ❒ Average consumption Values displayed Average consumption ❒ Average speed Represents the indicative average of consumptions from the beginning of the new mission. ❒ Travel time Current consumption ❒ Range This value shows instant fuel consumption (this value is updated second by second). If parking the car with engine on, the display will show “- - - -”. ❒ Current consumption ❒ Travel Distance “Trip B” displays information concerning: ❒ Travel Distance B ❒ Average consumption B ❒ Average speed B ❒ Travel time B. The display will show “- - - -“ in the following cases: ❒ value lower than 50 km (30mi); ❒ car left parked with engine running for long. This value shows the car average speed as a function of the overall time elapsed since the start of the new mission. IMPORTANT The variation of the autonomy value can be influenced by different factors: driving style (see what is described in paragraph “Driving style” in the chapter “Correct use of the car”), type of route (highways, urban, mountain, etc…), use conditions of the car (load transported, tire pressure, etc…). What was described previously must be taken in consideration when planning a trip. Travel time Travel Distance This value shows the time elapsed since the start of the new mission (driving time). This value shows the distance covered from the start of the new mission. Average speed Range This value shows the distance in km (or mi) that the car can still cover before needing fuel, assuming that driving conditions are kept unvaried. Each time the battery is connected and each time a new mission is started (reset), the display will show “0.0”. Pagina 43 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS New mission (reset) Reset can be: TRIP BUTTON Button TRIP fig. 28, set on the right steering column stalk shall be used (with electronic key into ignition device) to enter the “Trip A” and “Trip B” function. To scroll the values of each option use buttons set aside the stalk. fig. 28 A0E0076m Button TRIP shall also be used to reset the “Trip A” and “Trip B” functions to start a new mission: ❒ short push: to display the different values; ❒ long push: to reset and then start a new mission. To scroll the Trip Computer options, briefly press buttons - and .. IMPORTANT “Trip A” reset will also reset the “Trip B” function, whereas “Trip B” reset will only reset the information associated with this function. fig. 29 A0E0052m Every Trip computer screen displays two options of the active Trip (Trip A or Trip B); one option is displayed at the top of the screen, the other one at the bottom (see fig. 29). In the same screen it is not possible to have displayed at the same time the same option at the top and at the bottom of the screen. WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR ❒ “automatic” reset is performed when the trip distance reaches 9999.9 km (or mi), when travel time reaches 99.59 (99 hours and 59 minutes) or after disconnecting and then reconnecting the battery. SAFETY DEVICES ❒ “manual” reset is performed by the driver by pressing button TRIP; IN AN EMERGENCY 10:48 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 43 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 44 8-04-2009 10:48 Pagina 44 Briefly press button TRIP to select the two Trip computer modes; use button - to scroll the options at the top of the display, use button .. to scroll the options at the bottom of the display. Start of journey procedure (reset) Press briefly button TRIP to go from Trip A to Trip B. With electronic key into ignition device, to reset the “Trip A” press and keep pressed button TRIP for over 2 seconds. Trip A and Trip B reset are independent. Reset Trip A IMPORTANT Reset can be automatic only in the following cases: ❒ when the “Travel Distance” reaches 9999.9 km or the “Travel Time” reaches 99.59 (99 hours and 59 minutes); ❒ after disconnecting/reconnecting the battery. At Trip A reset a warning message will be displayed. IMPORTANT Trip A reset will not reset “Range” and “Current Consumption”. Reset Trip B As concerns the Trip B values, it is possible to select through the “Setup Menu” the reset mode (Manual or Automatic) (see paragraph “Setup Menu” on previous pages): ❒ manual reset: press and keep pressed button TRIP for over 2 seconds. ❒ automatic reset: it takes place each time the electronic key is fitted into the ignition device. At Trip B reset a warning message will be displayed. IMPORTANT Trip B reset will not reset “Range” and “Current Consumption”. 001-045 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:48 Pagina 45 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS SEATS SAFETY DEVICES MANUALLY ADJUSTABLE FRONT SEATS fig. 31 Upholstery of your car has been designed to withstand wear deriving from common use of the car. You are however recommended to avoid strong and/or continuous scratching with clothing accessories such as metallic buckles, studs, Velcro fastenings and the like, since these items cause circumscribed stress of the cover fabric that could lead to yarn breaking, and damage the cover as a consequence. fig. 31 A0E0020m Moving the seat backwards or forwards Lift the lever A (on the inner side of the seat) and push the seat forwards or backwards: in the driving position the arms should rest on the rim of the steering wheel. IN AN EMERGENCY NOTE When starting the engine and for a short time, if you have recalled the plan view by pressing the TRIP button, dashes will be displayed instead of "OK/NO". This is normal since the system is checking tyre inflation pressure values. TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE On versions fitted with T.P.M.S. system (Tyre pressure Monitoring System) (see paragraph “T.P.M.S. system” in this section), after Trip A and Trip B info, the screen with tyre pressure condition is displayed (see fig. 30). Only make adjustments when the car is stationary. INDEX A0E0053m WARNING LIGHTS CORRECT USE AND MESSAGES OF THE CAR WARNING fig. 30 45 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 46 8-04-2009 14:22 Pagina 46 WARNING Once you have released the lever, check that the seat is firmly locked in the runners by trying to move it back and forth. Failure to lock the seat in place could result in the seat moving suddenly and the driver losing control of the car. Height adjustment Move repeatedly lever B upwards or downwards to achieve the required height. IMPORTANT Adjustment must be carried out only seated at the driver’s seat. Back rest angle adjustment fig. 32 A0E0024m Back rest angle adjustment (for versions/markets, where provided) Use lever E. Pulling the lever upwards the seat will bend back by one position. Pushing the lever downwards the seat will bend forward. Seat warming (for versions/markets, where provided) Turn the knob C until obtaining the required position. With electronic key fitted into ignition device, turn ring nut A-fig. 32 to turn this function on/off. Lumbar adjustment (for versions/markets, where provided) Seat warming can be adjusted to 3 different levels (0 = seat warming off). Turn the knob D until obtaining the required position. A0E0189m fig. 33 ELECTRICALLY ADJUSTABLE FRONT SEATS fig. 33 WARNING Only make adjustments when the car is stationary. Storing driver’s seat/door mirror positions Multifunction control A: Buttons C allows to store and recall three different driver’s seat and door mirror positions. Storing and recalling are only possible with electronic key fitted into ignition device. – vertical seat movement; – longitudinal seat movement; B: Back rest angle adjustment; C: Driver’s seat positions store buttons; D: Lombar adjustment. IMPORTANT Seat can only be adjusted when the electronic key is fitted into the ignition device and for about 1 minute from removing it or after pressing button START/STOP. After opening the door the seat can be adjusted for about 3 minutes or until closing the door. Stored position can only be recalled for about 3 minutes after opening the doors and for about 1 minute after removing the electronic key from the ignition device. To store the required seat position, adjust it as required then press the button corresponding to position to store for a few seconds. To recall the stored position, press briefly the corresponding button. Storing a new position will automatically clear the one stored previously using the same button. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR – rear seat height adjustment; WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES – front seat height adjustment; SAFETY DEVICES Seat controls are the following: DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 47 fig. 33/a A0E0421m FRONT SEATS SPORTS fig. 33/a (for versions/markets, where provided) Certain versions are fitted with manually or electrically adjustable front seats with sports configuration. To adjust these seats see the indications contained in previous paragraphs. IN AN EMERGENCY 14:22 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 47 8-04-2009 14:22 Pagina 48 HEAD RESTRAINTS Head restraints are adjustable in height and they lock automatically in the required position. To adjust height proceed as follows: INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES SAFETY DEVICES FRONT HEAD RESTRAINTS CORRECT USE OF THE CAR DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 48 ❒ to raise: raise the head restraint until hearing the locking click. ❒ to lower: press button A and lower the head restraint. If required, head restraints can be removed as follows: ❒ raise head restraints to max. height; ❒ press buttons A and B-fig. 34 (set aside the two head restraint supports) then remove the head restraints by pulling them upwards. A0E0473m fig. 34 WARNING Remember that the head restraints should be adjusted to support the back of your head and not your neck. Only in this position do they exert their protective action. To optimise head restraint protective action, adjust the seat back upright and keep your head as close as possible to the head restraint. fig. 35 A0E0479m REAR HEAD RESTRAINTS Rear seats are fitted with two head restraints. Certain versions are fitted with height-adjustable head restraint also for the central seat (see previous paragraph for height adjustment). If required, head restraints can be removed as follows: ❒ raise head restraints to max. height; ❒ press buttons A and B-fig. 35 (set aside the two head restraint supports) then remove the head restraints by pulling them upwards. Release the lever A-fig. 36 pushing it downwards, then adjust the steering wheel as required. To lock the steering wheel, push lever A upwards. A0E0136m fig. 36 WARNING It is absolutely forbidden to carry out whatever after-market operation involving steering system or steering column modifications (e.g.: installation of anti-theft device) that could badly affect performance and safety, cause the lapse of warranty and also result in non-compliance of the car with homologation requirements. SAFETY DEVICES The steering wheel can be adjusted both axially and in height. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR WARNING Any adjustment of the steering wheel position must be carried out only with the car stationary and the engine turned off. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES STEERING WHEEL DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 49 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:22 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 49 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 50 8-04-2009 14:22 Pagina 50 REARVIEW MIRRORS DRIVING MIRROR The mirror is fitted with a safety device that causes it to be released in the event of a violent crash. fig. 37 A0E0135m Using lever A-fig. 37 the mirror can be adjusted to two different positions: normal or antiglare. Certain versions are fitted with electrochromic mirror fig. 38. The electrochromic function is turned on/off by pressing button ON/OFF in the lower section of the mirror. When engaging reverse, the mirror will always set to daylight colouring. fig. 39 A0E0036m Adjusting the mirror Use device A-fig. 39 to select the required mirror: ❒ turn selector A to 1 to select the left door mirror; ❒ turn selector A to 2 to select the right door mirror. fig. 38 A0E0032m DOOR MIRRORS Door mirror can only be adjusted and folded when the electronic key is fitted into the ignition device. To adjust the mirror selected press button B in the four directions shown by the arrows. IMPORTANT After adjusting the mirror, turn selector A to 0 to prevent accidental movements. A0E0081m Manually folding of the mirror When required (for example when the mirror causes difficulty in narrow spaces) it is possible to fold the mirror moving it from position A-fig. 40 to position B. To bring the mirrors back to driving position press again button C-fig. 39. To store mirror position proceed as follows: As the driver’s door mirror is curved, it may slightly alter the perception of distance. WARNING When driving the mirrors shall always be in open position. ❒ To perform storing, proceed as follows: engage reverse with car stopped and electronic key fitted into the ignition device; ❒ move device A-fig. 39 to position 2 (passenger door mirror selection); ❒ adjust the passenger door mirror to obtain the best position for parking manoeuvres; ❒ keep one of the buttons C-fig. 33 pressed for at least 3 seconds (see paragraph “Seats” in this section). SAFETY DEVICES When required (for example when the mirror causes difficulty in narrow spaces) it is possible to fold the mirrors by pressing button C-fig. 39. On versions equipped with electric seats, when engaging reverse for parking to improve visibility the driver can adjust (and store) the passenger's door mirror to a position different than that used commonly. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR fig. 40 Storing the “parking” position of the door mirror on the passenger side WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES Electrically folding of the mirror (only versions with 4 power windows) (for versions/markets, where provided) DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 51 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:22 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 51 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 52 8-04-2009 14:22 Pagina 52 Together with the passenger door mirror “parking” position, also the driver seat position and the driver door mirror will be stored. The sound of a buzzer will confirm that the mirror position has been stored. Recalling the passenger door mirror “parking” position Automatic door mirror realignment Proceed as follows: fit the electronic key into the ignition device, engage reverse, move device A-fig. 39 to position 2 (passenger door mirror selection). Each time the electronic key is fitted into the ignition device the door mirrors return automatically to the last position reached and/or recalled before removing the electronic key from the ignition device. The mirror will set automatically to the previously stored position. If no parking position has been stored, when engaging reverse the passenger door mirror will slightly lower to favour the parking manoeuvre. The passenger door mirror will return automatically to its original position about 10 seconds after disengaging reverse, immediately after exceeding 10 km/h with forward gear or when moving device A-fig. 39 to 0. This enables mirror alignment if, when the car is parked, one of the door mirrors has been moved manually and/or accidentally. Defrosting/demisting The electric mirrors are fitted with heating coils which come into operation when turning on the heated rear window (pressing button (). IMPORTANT This function is timed and is deactivated after a few minutes. 8-04-2009 14:22 Pagina 53 CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM 1 Upper vent - 2 Adjustable and swivel central vents - 3 Adjustable and swivel side vents - 4 Lower vents for rear seats 5 Adjustable and swivel air vents for rear seats (for versions/markets, where provided) - 6 Lower vents for front seats - 7 Windscreen and front windows demisting/defrosting vents. INDEX fig. 41 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES A0E0220m DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 53 8-04-2009 14:22 Pagina 54 fig. 42 A0E0014m IN AN EMERGENCY INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 54 fig. 44 A0E0057m A0E0067m fig. 45 UPPER VENT fig. 44 The vent has an opening/closing control. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 046-082 Alfa 159 GB I O = Completely closed O I = Completely open OFF AUTO AUTO fig. 43 A0E0012m CENTRAL AND SIDE VENTS fig. 42-43 These vents are aligned on the dashboard. Each vent A features a wheel B to adjust air flow and a device C to direct air flow horizontally or vertically. O = Completely closed I = Completely open WINDSCREEN AND FRONT SIDE WINDOW DEMISTING/ DEFROSTING VENTS These vents are located at the ends (Afig. 45) and on the front part B of the dashboard. fig. 46 A0E0088m REAR VENTS fig. 46 (for versions/markets, where provided) Each vent A features a wheel B to adjust air flow and a device C to direct it. O = Completely closed I = Completely open 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 14:22 Pagina 55 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS MANUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM SAFETY DEVICES (for versions/markets, where provided) CORRECT USE OF THE CAR CONTROLS fig. 47 A - Air temperature knob (mixing warm and cold air); E - Windscreen, front side windows and door mirrors max. demisting/defrosting on/off button; F - Air recirculation on/off button; G - Compressor on/off button. fig. 47 AIR DISTRIBUTION SELECTION O: air flow to driver’s/passenger’s body; M: air flow to driver’s/passenger’s body and lower part of the passenger compartment; N: air flow towards the front and rear lower part of the passenger compartment; A0E0011m Q: air flow towards the lower part of the passenger compartment and windscreen; ü: air flow towards the windscreen TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE D - Heated rear window and door mirrors defrosting on/off button; INDEX C - Fan speed knob; IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES B - Air distribution knob; 55 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 56 8-04-2009 14:22 Pagina 56 WARMING THE PASSENGER COMPARTMENT Proceed as follows: ❒ turn knob A to the required temperature; ❒ turn knob C to the required speed; ❒ turn knob B to the required distribution: N: to warm the feet of front and rear passengers; M: to warm the feet and keep the face cool (bilevel function); Q: to warm the feet and at the same time demist the windscreen; ❒ turn air recirculation off (if on). QUICK WINDSCREEN AND FRONT SIDE WINDOW DEMISTING/DEFROSTING (MAX-DEF function) Press button -: the button leds -, √ and ( will turn on. To turn this function off, press again button - the button led will turn off. After defrosting, turn the function off to keep top comfort conditions. Window demisting Climate control system √ is very useful to speed up window demisting and it is therefore to be turned on in the event of considerable moisture. In any case it is recommended to perform the following preventive demisting procedure: ❒ turn air recirculation off (if on); ❒ turn knob C to second speed; ❒ turn knob B to Q. HEATED REAR WINDOW AND DOOR MIRROR DEMISTING/DEFROSTING Press button ( to activate the demisting/defrosting function: when this function is on, the circular led around the button will turn on. On certain versions, turning this function on will also activate windscreen defrosting in the windscreen wiper area. This function is timed and switches off automatically after few minutes, or by pressing again the button or by turning the engine off. It will not be switched on automatically when restarting the engine. IMPORTANT Do not apply stickers on the inside of the heated rear window over the heating filaments to avoid damage that might cause it to stop working properly. IMPORTANT The compressor √ can be enabled only if the ventilation is enabled. During the winter, the climate control system √ must be turned on at least once a month for about ten minutes. Proceed as follows: Before summer, have the system checked at Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. ❒ turn knob A completely leftwards; ❒ turn knob C to top speed; Do not use the air recirculation function on rainy/cold days as it would considerably increase the possibility of the windows misting inside. ❒ turn knob B to O; IMPORTANT The inside air recirculation system makes it possible to reach the required (“heating” or “cooling”) conditions faster. How to keep the required cooling ❒ press buttons √ and v (buttons leds on). Proceed as follows: ❒ turn air recirculation off (if on). ❒ turn knob A to the required temperature; ❒ turn the knurled ring C to the required fan speed. After connecting/disconnecting the battery, wait for 3 minutes at least before fitting the electronic key into the ignition device in order to allow the climate control system control unit to reset the positions of the electric actuators that adjust air temperature and distribution. SAFETY DEVICES This function is particularly useful when the outside air is heavily polluted (in a traffic jam, tunnel, etc.) However, it is better not to use it for long periods, especially if there are several people in the car to prevent window misting up. LOOKING AFTER THE SYSTEM CORRECT USE OF THE CAR To turn this function on press button v: the button led will turn on. CLIMATE CONTROL (fast cooling) WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES RECIRCULATION DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 57 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:22 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 57 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 58 8-04-2009 14:22 Pagina 58 AUTOMATIC TWO-/ THREE-ZONE CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM (for versions/markets, where provided) ❒ compressor activation; ❒ air recirculation. The following parameters and functions can be set or changed manually: ❒ required temperature; ❒ fan speed; ❒ air distribution on seven levels ; DESCRIPTION The car is fitted with a two-/three-zone climate control system which makes it possible to separately adjust the air temperature in the two/three passenger’s compartment areas to reach the required comfort. For top quality temperature control in the two/three areas of the passenger's compartment, the system is fitted with external temperature sensor, passenger's compartment temperature sensor and two-side sun radiation sensor. The climate control system automatically controls and adjusts the following parameters and functions: ❒ air temperature at driver/passengers vents; ❒ fan speed; ❒ air distribution at driver/passenger vents; ❒ compressor on/off; ❒ window demisting/defrosting; ❒ air recirculation. The system is fitted with AQS (Air Quality System) sensor (where provided), that turns on air recirculation automatically when it detects the presence of outside polluted air (for example in queues and tunnels). Where provided, the system is integrated with an anti-misting sensor A-fig. 48 set behind the driving mirror, capable of “monitoring” a preset internal area of the windscreen and of intervening automatically to prevent or to reduce window misting up through a proper strategy. fig. 48 A0E0091m This sensor can be deactivated through any manual system control when the strategy is operating. The sensor is enabled at each start-up and in any case when the user presses one of the AUTO buttons. To guarantee perfect and regular sensor operation do not apply stickers in the “monitoring” area between sensor and windscreen. Keep windscreen and sensor clean and avoid to accumulate dust or other substances. Pagina 59 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS TWO-ZONE controls fig. 49 A - air distribution buttons (on driver and passenger side); SAFETY DEVICES B - temperature adjustment knob on driver side; C - automatic operation button (AUTO); CORRECT USE OF THE CAR D - climate control data display; E - temperature adjustment knob on passenger side; G - MAX-DEF function button (fast defrosting/demisting function for windscreen, heated rear window and door mirrors with heating function); H - buttons for adjusting the fan speed; WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES F - heated rear window/door mirrors on/off button; fig. 49 - TWO-ZONE configuration I - OFF button to disable climate control; L - air recirculation on/off button; M - climate control compressor on/off button; N - passenger’s compartment temperature sensor A0E0453m IN AN EMERGENCY 14:22 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 59 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 60 8-04-2009 14:22 Pagina 60 THREE-ZONE controls fig. 50 Front controls A - air distribution buttons (driver and passenger side); B - temperature adjustment knob on driver side; C - automatic operation button (AUTO); D - climate control data display; E - temperature adjustment knob on passenger side; F - heated rear window/door mirrors on/off button; G - MAX-DEF function button (fast defrosting/demisting function for windscreen, heated rear window and door mirrors with heating function); H - buttons for adjusting the fan speed; I - OFF button to disable climate control; L - air recirculation on/off button; M - climate control compressor on/off button; N - passenger’s compartment temperature sensor Rear controls P - knob for adjusting temperature on rear passenger side; Q - button for turning on automatic operation (AUTO) and for turning off air flow to rear seats (OFF); R - air distribution buttons; S - rear temperature display. fig. 50 - THREE-ZONE configuration - Front and rear controls A0E0454m The system can be turned on by pressing any button (excluding (, v and OFF); it is however advisable to set the required temperatures on the display and then to press the AUTO button. Turning the knob knurled rings (B/ E/P), clockwise or counter-clockwise, respectively raises or lowers the temperature of the air required respectively in the left front zone (knob B) or right front zone (knob E) or rear zone (knob P) of the passenger compartment. The temperatures set are shown on the display D/S. It is switched on by setting a temperature of more than 32°C on the display, and can be switched on independently from the driver’s or passengers’ side, or both of them; this setting brings the system to the “one-zone” mode and it is shown by both displays. The climate control system allows to personalise required temperatures (driver and passengers). Turning the knob knurled rings fully clockwise or counter-clockwise until they reach the extreme selections HI or LO, the maximum heating or cooling functions are respectively engaged. This functions can be switched on when you wish to heat the passenger compartment as quickly as possible, by taking the greatest advantage from the system potential. The function uses the maximum temperature of the heating fluid, whereas air distribution and fan speed are controlled automatically by the system. SAFETY DEVICES HI function (HIGH) (maximum heating power) CORRECT USE OF THE CAR AIR TEMPERATURE ADJUSTMENT KNOBS WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES SWITCHING THE CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM ON DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 61 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:22 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 61 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 62 8-04-2009 14:22 Pagina 62 This function should not be activated when the engine is cold, to prevent air not warm enough from entering the passenger compartment. With the function switched on, however, all the manual settings can be made. To switch the function off, you only need to turn the ring of knob (B or E/P) of the temperature set to a value lower than 32°C; the opposite display and the rear display (for versions/markets, where provided) will show 32°C. Pressing button AUTO, the display will show a temperature of 32°C and returns to an operating condition with automatic temperature adjustment. LO (LOW) function (highest cooling power) It is switched on by setting a temperature lower than 16°C on the display; this setting is shown on the display. This function can be switched on when you wish to cool the passenger compartment as quickly as possible, by taking the greatest advantage from the system potential. The function cuts off air heating, switches on both internal air recirculation (to prevent hot air from entering the compartment) and the climate control compressor, brings air distribution to ¯/˙ and the fan speed is controlled automatically by the system. With the function switched on, however, all the manual settings can be made. To switch the function off, you only need to turn the ring of knob B/E/P of the temperature set to a value higher than 16°C; the opposite display and the rear display (where provided) will show 16°C. Pressing button AUTO, the display will show a temperature of 16°C and returns to an operating condition with automatic temperature adjustment. ❒ fan speed; ❒ air distribution in passenger compartment; ❒ air recirculation; ❒ compressor; and it will cancel all the previous manual adjustments. Wording AUTO will disappear from the display of the involved area (driver or front passenger side or rear passenger side) when performing whatever operation (excluding temperature change). Press buttons +/– to increase or to decrease the fan speed. The fan speed is shown by the lit bars on the display: WARNING It is inadvisable to use air recirculation on rainy/cold days as it would considerably increase the possibility of windows misting up inside. ❒ min fan speed = one bar lit; ❒ max fan speed = 6 bars lit; At starting, if climate control system is operating in automatic mode, the fan speed is kept at minimum until the engine has started. With compressor on and engine running, the fan speed cannot fall below the min. speed. The fan can be cut off (all bars off) only if the climate control compressor has been switched off by pressing button √. To restore automatic fan speed control after a manual adjustment, press buttons AUTO. SAFETY DEVICES FAN SPEED ADJUSTMENT CORRECT USE OF THE CAR Pressing button AUTO (front and rear controls) the displays will show AUTO and the system will automatically adjust: AUTO will also go off if the system (specially when compressor is turned off manually) cannot reach or cannot keep the required temperature. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES AUTOMATIC OPERATION (AUTO BUTTON) DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 63 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:22 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 63 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 64 8-04-2009 14:22 Pagina 64 QUICK FRONT WINDOW DEMISTING/DEFROSTING (MAX-DEF function) Pressing button - the climate control automatically activates timed operation of all the functions required to quicken demisting/defrosting of the windscreen and front side windows and, on certain versions, electric windscreen demisting in the windscreen wiper area. The MAX-DEF can be turned on also with engine off. When this function is on the circular led around the button will turn on. The MAX-DEF function activates the following operations: ❒ rear panel turning off (for versions/markets, where provided); ❒ air flow increase; ❒ air distribution at DEF; ❒ outside air intake; ❒ compressor activation; ❒ AQS function deactivation (where provided) ❒ rear window heating activation. When the MAX-DEF function is on, the only manual operations possible are manual adjustment of the fan speed and switching heated rear window off. IMPORTANT If the engine is not warm enough, the function will not engage the predefined fan speed immediately, to limit the flow to the passenger compartment of air that is not warm enough to demist the windows. Pressing again one of the following buttons: v, √, AUTO, or - the system switches off the MAX-DEF function, resuming the system operating conditions prior to turning it on, in addition to activating the last function required, if any. IMPORTANT Don’t turn the MAX-DEF function on with engine off to prevent draining the battery. On certain versions, turning this function on will also activate windscreen defrosting in the windscreen wiper area. This function is timed and switches off automatically after few minutes, or by pressing again the button or by turning the engine off. It will not be switched on automatically when restarting the engine. IMPORTANT Do not apply stickers on the inside of the rear window over the heating filaments to avoid damage that might cause it to stop working properly. To turn the compressor off press again button √. With compressor off, the system will check whether outside temperature is higher or lower/same as the set one: ❒ if outside temperature is lower than the set one, the system will operate regularly also with compressor off; ❒ if outside temperature is higher than the set one, the system will not be able to keep the required condition, the set temperature values will then start to flash on the display. SAFETY DEVICES Press button √ to turn the compressor on: when climate control compressor is on the circular led around the button will turn on. Compressor will stay on also after turning the engine off. Temperature detection (compressor off and outside temperature higher than set temperature) is activated each time the electronic key is fitted into the ignition device. WARNING Operation of the climate control compressor is necessary for cooling and dehumidifying the air; it is advisable to keep this function always on, to prevent window misting problems. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR Press button ( to activate the demisting/defrosting function: when this function is on, the circular led around the button will turn on. CLIMATE CONTROL COMPRESSOR ON/OFF WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES HEATED REAR WINDOW AND DOOR MIRROR DEMISTING/DEFROSTING DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 65 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:22 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 65 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 66 8-04-2009 14:22 Pagina 66 AIR DISTRIBUTION SELECTION Front seat Two-zone/ Three-zone configuration Pressing buttons (front controls) A/S/D you can manually choose one of the 7 possible modes for air distribution inside the compartment: D Flow of air to the dashboard centre and side outlets (passenger’s body). D Splitting of the air flow between S the vents to the lower part of the passenger compartment (warmest air) and the dashboard centre and side outlets and the rear outlet (coolest air). S Air flow towards the front and rear lower part of the passenger compartment. This type of distribution allows heating of the passenger compartment in the shortest time by proper setting of the temperature. A Splitting of the air flow between S windscreen and front side window demisting/defrosting vents and the lower part of the passenger compartment. This type of air distribution allows satisfactory heating of the passenger compartment while preventing possible misting of the windows. A Air flow to the windscreen and front side window vents to demist or defrost them. A Splitting of the air flow between D the central/side dashboard vents, rear vents and windscreen and side window defrosting / demisting vents. This type of air distribution allows satisfactory ventilation of the passenger compartment while preventing possible misting of the windows. A Splitting of the air flow between D all vents. S Rear seat Three-zone configuration controls Pressing buttons A/S (rear controls) you can manually choose one of the 3 possible modes for air distribution to the rear side of passenger's compartment A Air flow to the vents on the central console (passengers’ body). S Air flow towards the rear lower part of the passenger compartment. This type of distribution allows heating of the passenger compartment in the shortest time by proper setting of the temperature. A Splitting of the air flow between S the vents to the lower part of the passenger compartment (warmest air) and the rear vents (coolest air). To restore automatic air distribution control after a manual selection, press buttons AUTO (front controls) or AUTO (rear controls). ❒ automatic control, indicated by button led “A”; ❒ forced switching on (inside air recirculation always on), indicated by the turning on of the circular led around the button; ❒ forced switching off (air recirculation always off with air inlet from the outside), indicated by the turning off of the circular led around the button. With A.Q.S. (air quality sensor - where provided), the operating logics becomes sequential by pressing button v. SAFETY DEVICES In certain weather conditions (e.g. outside temperature around 0°C) and with automatic air recirculation control on, mist may form on the windows. In this case press button v to switch off recirculation and if necessary press button + to increase the flow of air to the windscreen. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR Inside air recirculation is controlled according to the following operating logics: IMPORTANT The inside air recirculation system makes it possible to reach the required heating or cooling conditions faster. It is however inadvisable to use it on rainy/cold days as it would considerably increase the possibility of the windows misting inside, especially if the climate control compressor is off. It is advisable to turn on the inside air recirculation system in queues or tunnels to avoid admitting polluted air from outside. The prolonged use of this function should however be avoided, especially with several persons on board, to avoid the possibility of the windows misting inside and to guarantee the required fresh air inlet. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES AIR RECIRCULATION AND AQS FUNCTION (AIR QUALITY SYSTEM) ON/OFF (for versions/markets, where provided) DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 67 With the outside temperature below -1°C the climate control compressor is unable to work. It is therefore inadvisable to use the inside air recirculation function with low outside temperature as windows may mist over quickly. IN AN EMERGENCY 14:22 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 67 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 68 8-04-2009 14:22 Pagina 68 AQS function (Air Quality System) (for versions/markets, where provided) The AQS function turns on automatically air recirculation when it detects the presence of polluted air (e.g. in queues and tunnels). IMPORTANT With AQS function on, after a preset time with recirculation on, the compressor will enable outside air inlet (for about 1 minute) to change air inside the passenger compartment, regardless of outside air pollution level. IMPORTANT The AQS function is disabled when the outside temperature is cold to prevent window misting up. To reactivate this function, press button v. Led “A” on button v will turn on to indicate that the function is on. POLLEN FILTER/ ACTIVATED CARBON POLLEN FILTER According to versions, the car can be fitted with pollen filter or activated carbon pollen filter (where provided). The filter has the specific capability of admitting to the passenger compartment purified air, free from particles such as dust, pollen, etc. The filtering action takes place under all air inlet conditions and it is clearly most effective with the windows shut. Have the conditions of the filter checked by Alfa Romeo Authorized Services at least once a year, preferably at the onset of summer. If the car is used mainly in polluted or dusty areas it should be checked and if necessary replaced at shorter intervals than specified in the Service Schedule (see section “Car Maintenance”). Failure to replace the filter may considerably reduce the effectiveness of the climate control system up to blocking the air flow from the outlets and vents. ❒ the system stores performed operations; ❒ the display is off; ❒ air recirculation is active (button led on); ❒ compressor is active; ❒ ventilation is off. To turn the climate control system on again press button AUTO or any other button (excluding ( and v). Turning the climate control system on again, air recirculation will be again controlled automatically. (for versions/markets, where provided) After connecting/disconnecting the battery, wait for 3 minutes at least before fitting the electronic key into the ignition device in order to allow the climate control system control unit to reset the positions of the electric actuators that adjust air temperature and distribution. The car is fitted with an additional heater that supports the engine during cold or winter weather to quickly reach a comfortable temperature in the passenger compartment. The additional heater works with the engine running when the outside temperature is below 20°C and the engine has not yet reached normal operating temperature. SAFETY DEVICES With climate control system off: ADDITIONAL HEATER (diesel versions only) CORRECT USE OF THE CAR Press OFF button. The circular led around the button turns on, signalling the OFF state. Pressing button OFF on the rear control will display the wording OFF on the rear display and will stop air flow to rear seats. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES SWITCHING THE CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM OFF DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 69 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:22 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 69 8-04-2009 14:22 Pagina 70 Direction indicators EXTERNAL LIGHTS Push the stalk to (stable) position: ❒ up: to turn the right-hand direction indicator on; LEFT-HAND STALK fig. 51 The left-hand stalk control almost all external lights. The external lights can only be switched on with electronic key fitted into ignition device. fig. 51 A0E0064m Main beam headlamps Turn the knurled ring A to 6. The warning light 3 on the instrument panel will turn on. To turn the main beams off, pull again the stalk towards the steering wheel (2nd unstable position). Dipped beam headlamps Flashing the main beams Turn the knurled ring A to 2. The warning light 2 on the instrument panel will turn on. Pull the stalk towards the steering wheel (1st unstable position) regardless of the position of the knurled ring A. Warning light 1 on the instrument panel will turn on. INDEX WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES Sidelights With knurled ring A at 2 pull the stalk towards the steering wheel (2nd unstable position). Warning light 1 on the instrument panel will turn on. IN AN EMERGENCY Lights switched off ❒ down: to turn the left-hand direction indicator on. TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 70 Knurled ring at O. Warning light Î or ¥ will come on flashing on the instrument cluster at the same time. Indicators are switched off automatically when the steering wheel is straightened. If you want to show that you are about to change lane, move the left-hand stalk to unstable position. The required direction indicator will flash 3 times and then it will turn off automatically. Pull the stalk towards the steering wheel within 2 minutes from when the engine is turned off. At each single movement of the stalk, the staying on of the lights is extended by 30 seconds up to a maximum of 3.5 minutes; then the lights are switched off automatically. Each time the stalk is operated, the 3 warning light turns on together with the message on the display (see section “Warning lights and messages”). Deactivation Keep the stalk pulled towards the steering wheel for more than 2 seconds. On certain versions, the daylight sensor sensitivity can be adjusted through the “Setup Menu” of the display (see section “Reconfigurable multifunction display” in this section). Activation A: Turn the knurled ring A-fig. 51 to 2 in this way, the automatic activation of the side/taillights and dipped beam headlights is simultaneously enabled according to outside brightness. With lights switched on automatically and in the presence of a switching off control by the sensor, the main beams will be switched off first and a few seconds after also the sidelights. As a result of the sensor control, the dipped beam headlights will switch off and, after a few seconds, sidelights will switch off too. The sensor is not able to detect the fog presence, under this condition lights shall therefore be switched on manually. Failure warnings On certain versions headlight sensor failure is shown by the instrument panel warning light 1, whereas on other versions a dedicated message is shown on the display (see section “Warning lights and messages”). SAFETY DEVICES Activation It detects the changes of the external light intensity of the car according to the light sensitivity set: the greater the sensitivity is, the smaller the amount of external light necessary to control the switching-on of the external headlights will be. Deactivation CORRECT USE OF THE CAR This function allows the illumination of the space in front of the car for a preset period of time. AUTOMATIC HEADLIGHTS SENSOR (daylight sensor) (for versions/markets, where provided) WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES “FOLLOW ME HOME” DEVICE DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 71 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:22 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 71 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 14:23 Pagina 72 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Parking lights INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES With instrument panel off they turn on by pressing button C. When pressing the button a buzzer will sound and the instrument panel warning light 3 will turn on. 72 fig. 52 A0E0061m DASHBOARD BUTTONS fig. 52 Front fog lights (where provided) To turn front fog lights on, press button A; to activate these lights it is necessary to have the side/taillights switched on. The instrument panel warning light 5 will turn on. Press the button again or turn side/taillights off to turn the lights off. Press the button again to turn the lights off. With parking lights on, move the external lights left-hand stalk upwards or downwards to select on which side (right or left) the lights must stay on. In this event warning light 3 will turn off. With left stalk at central position the four parking lights and the number plate light will turn on. A0E0100m fig. 53 Hazard lights These lights are turned on by pressing button A-fig. 53. When these lights are on, the switch flashes and warning lights Î and ¥ on the instrument panel will turn on at the same time. Press switch A again to turn the lights off. Rear fog lights To turn rear fog lights on, press button B to activate these lights it is necessary to have the dipped beams or front fog lights switched on. The instrument panel warning light 4 will turn on. They turn off by pressing the button again, turning the front or rear fog lights off or by turning the engine off. WARNING Use of the hazard warning lights is ruled by the Highway Code of the country in which the car is used. Observe regulations. With external lights on, activating the windscreen washer will also activate the headlight washer, if provided. Windscreen washer/wiper The stalk can be moved to five different positions: 0: windscreen wiper off; 1: intermittent. With the stalk in position 1, turning the knurled ring A four possible intermittent speeds are obtained: ■ = slow intermittent ■ = intermittent medium ■ = intermittent medium-fast ■ = fast intermittent fig. 54 A0E0066m 2: continuous slow 3: continuous fast 4: fast temporary (unstable position) Operation in position 4 is limited to the time the stalk is held in this position. When the stalk is released, it returns to position 0 automatically stopping the wiper. SAFETY DEVICES Right-hand stalk fig. 54 controls windscreen washer/wiper operation. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR RIGHT-HAND STALK Never use the window wiper to remove ice or snow from the windscreen. In these conditions, the wiper is submitted to excessive effort that results in motor protection cutting in and wiper operation inhibition for few seconds as a consequence. If operation is not restored contact Fiat Dealership. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES WINDOW WASHING DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 73 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:23 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 73 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 74 8-04-2009 14:23 Pagina 74 “Smart washing” function Turning the knurled ring A-fig. 54 it is possible to increase the sensitivity of the rain sensor, obtaining a quicker change from stationary (no wiping) when the windscreen is dry, to first continuous speed (continuous, slow). A further stroke will confirm operation. Pulling the lever towards the steering wheel (unstable position) operates the windscreen washer. Keeping the stalk pulled with just one movement it is possible to operate the washer jet and the wiper at the same time; the wiper actually comes into operation automatically when the stalk is pulled for more than half a second. The wiper stops working 3 strokes after releasing the stalk; a further stroke after about 6 seconds will complete the wiping operation. RAIN SENSOR (for versions/markets, where provided) Operating the windscreen washer with the rain sensor activated (stalk at position 1-fig. 54) the normal washing cycle is performed at the end of which the rain sensor resumes its normal automatic function. The rain sensor A-fig. 55, located behind the driving mirror, is an electronic device combined with the windscreen wiper which has the purpose of automatically adjusting the number of wipes to intensity of the rain. All the other functions controlled by the right-hand stalk remain unchanged. Removing the electronic key from the ignition device, the rain sensor is deactivated and the next time the engine is started it will not be reactivated even if the stalk has remained in position 1fig. 54. In this case to activate the rain sensor, simply move the stalk to 0 or 2 and then back to 1. The rain sensor is activated automatically moving the right-hand stalk to position 1-fig. 54 and it has a range of adjustment that gradually varies between wiper stationary (no wiping) when the windscreen is dry, to wiper at second speed (continuous, medium wiping) with heavy rain. When the rain sensor is reactivated in this way, the wiper performs one stroke, even if the windscreen is dry, to indicate that reactivation has occurred. fig. 55 A0E0227m ❒ impurities on the controlled surface (salt, dirt, etc.); ❒ difference between day and night. Failure warnings On certain versions rain sensor failure is shown by the instrument panel warning light u, whereas on other versions a dedicated message is shown on the display (see section “Warning lights and messages”). SAFETY DEVICES wash. Make sure the rain sensor is deactivated if there is ice on the windscreen. fig. 56 A0E0046m HEADLIGHT WASHERS (where provided) fig. 56 Streaks of water could cause unrequired blade movements. WARNING Make sure the device is off when cleaning the windscreen. Headlight washers are visible and are fitted with a nozzle for each external light function. They come into operation automatically when operating the windscreen washer with external lights turned on. IMPORTANT Check at regular intervals correct operation and cleanness of nozzles. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR The rain sensor is able to recognize and automatically adjust itself in the presence of the following particular conditions: Rain sensor shall be deactivated when washing the car at automatic car- WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES IMPORTANT In the event of rain sensor failure, windscreen wiper operation with right-hand stalk at 1-fig. 54 shall be intermittent. If failure occurs during automatic operation, the system will keep the last wiper operating condition. Operation is however guaranteed although moving the stalk to other positions. DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 75 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:23 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 75 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 76 8-04-2009 14:23 Pagina 76 CRUISE CONTROL TO MEMORISE SPEED (for versions/markets, where provided) Proceed as follows: ❒ turn the knurled ring A-fig. 57 to Ü and press the accelerator pedal to the required speed; GENERAL The speed regulator (CRUISE CONTROL), with electronic control, makes it possible to drive the car at the required speed, without pressing the accelerator pedal. This reduces driving fatigue during long journeys (specially on highways) because the speed memorised is automatically maintained. IMPORTANT The Cruise Control must be activated at speeds of between 45 and 180 k.p.h., in fourth, fifth and sixth gears. fig. 57 A0E0095m DEVICE ENGAGEMENT Turn knurled ring A-fig. 57 to Ü. The device cannot be engaged in first speed or reverse. It is recommended to engage it in 4th or higher speeds. Travelling downhill with the device engaged, the car speed may increase more than the memorised one. When the device is activated the instrument panel warning light Ü turns on (on certain versions together with a message on the display) (see section “Warning lights and messages”). ❒ push the stalk upwards (+) or downwards (–), then release it: car speed is memorised and it is therefore possible to release the accelerator pedal. In the case of need (when overtaking for instance) acceleration is possible simply pressing the accelerator pedal: releasing the accelerator pedal, the car will return to the speed memorised previously. The speed memorised can be increased in two ways: TO INCREASE THE MEMORISED SPEED The speed memorised can be increased in two ways: ❒ pressing the accelerator and then memorising the new speed reached; or ❒ moving the stalk upwards (+). Each operation of the stalk will correspond to a slight increase in speed (about 1.5 km/h), while keeping the stalk upwards will correspond to a continuous speed increase. ❒ disengaging the device and then memorising the new speed; or ❒ moving the stalk downwards (–) until reaching the new speed which will be memorised automatically. Each operation of the stalk will correspond to a slight decrease in speed (about 1.5 km/h), while keeping the stalk downwards will correspond to a continuous speed decrease. DEVICE DISENGAGEMENT The device is disengaged in one of the following cases: ❒ turning the knurled ring A-fig. 57 to O; ❒ turning the engine off or removing the electronic key from the ignition device; ❒ pressing the accelerator pedal; in this case the system is disengaged only temporarily; device operation will be resumed automatically when releasing the pedal; ❒ with car speed below the preset limit (in these cases the last stored speed will stay memorised, to resume it press button RES); Automatic Cruise Control deactivation The Cruise Control is temporarily deactivated when the ABS or VDC systems come into operation (above a max. preset time): in this case the last set speed will stay memorised, to recall it press button RES. In the event of Cruise Control or engine control system failure, the device is deactivated until removing the electronic key from the ignition device. In this event contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. SAFETY DEVICES If the device has been disengaged for example pressing the brake or clutch pedal, the memorised speed can be reset as follows: ❒ accelerate gradually until reaching a speed approaching the one memorised; ❒ engage the gear selected at the time of speed memorising (4th or 5th gear); ❒ press the RES button (set at stalk end). ❒ pressing the brake pedal, pressing the clutch pedal (in these cases the last stored speed will stay memorised, to resume it press button RES); CORRECT USE OF THE CAR TO REDUCE MEMORISED SPEED WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES TO RESET THE MEMORISED SPEED DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 77 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:23 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 77 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 78 8-04-2009 14:23 Pagina 78 The device is automatically deactivated when operating accidentally or incorrectly the stalk, the knurled ring A or button RES: in this event to reactivate the device: bring the car to the required speed and then move the stalk upwards (+) or downwards (–). CEILING LIGHTS FRONT CEILING LIGHT fig. 58 Press button: A: to turn on/off the driver’s courtesy light; WARNING In the event of device malfunction or failure, turn the knurled ring A-fig. 57 to O and contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services after checking the protection fuse integrity. WARNING When travelling with the device on, never set the gearshift lever to neutral. B: to turn on/off the central light; C: to turn on/off the passenger’s courtesy light. Keeping pressed button B will turn off all front ceiling lights and rear ceiling lights. Turning off is also indicated by the sound of a buzzer. To turn these lights on again press briefly button B. fig. 58 A0E0481m IMPORTANT Leaving inadvertently a door open, the front ceiling light and the puddle lights will turn off automatically after a few minutes. To turn them on again, open another door or close and open again the same door. Opening one of the front/rear doors Central front light and rear light turning on for a few minutes. This timed operation will be reactivated each time a door is opened. Closing all the doors With electronic key removed from ignition device: ceiling lights will stay on for other 10 seconds. This timed operation is stopped when refitting the electronic key into the ignition device Starting the engine: front central and rear courtesy lights will turn off Removing the electronic key from the ignition device Front central and rear courtesy lights turning on for about 10 seconds Locking the doors Front central and rear courtesy lights turning off Unlocking the doors Front central and rear courtesy lights turning on for about 10 seconds Cutting in of the fuel cut-off switch Front central and rear courtesy lights turning on for a few minutes. Reactivating the fuel cut-off switch will turn off the ceiling lights In all the cases tabulated above, front and rear ceiling lights turning on/off is gradual, for 2 seconds. SAFETY DEVICES Front and rear ceiling lights turning on/off mode CORRECT USE OF THE CAR Cause WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES In the following table are summarised the causes that make front/rear ceiling lights turn on/off and their turning on/off mode: DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 79 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:23 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 79 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 14:23 Pagina 80 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS DOOR PUDDLE LIGHTS INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES The door light will turn on when opening the door regardless of the electronic key position. It will stay on for about 3 minutes when the door is open, then it will go off automatically. 80 fig. 59 A0E0094m REAR CEILING LIGHT fig. 60 A0E0037m Press button: IMPORTANT Leaving inadvertently a door open, the ceiling lights will turn off automatically after a few minutes. To turn them on again, open another door or close and open again the same door. A: to turn on/off the driver’s courtesy light; Versions with sunroof fig. 60 (for versions/markets, where provided) B: to turn on/off the passenger’s courtesy light. Versions with sunroof are fitted with two rear ceiling lights located above the rears doors. Versions without sunroof fig. 59 Closing the doors, the ceiling lights will stay on for a few seconds, then they will switch off automatically. Ceiling lights will turn off when fitting the electronic key into the ignition device. Press lens A-fig. 60 to turn these lights on/off. Certain versions are equipped with an additional safety switch that in the event of a crash comes into operation by cutting off the power supply. These two safety switches therefore prevent dangerous fuel leaks due to fuel line cracking, and sparks or electric discharges due to damaging or malfunctioning of the electric components of the car in the event of a crash. IMPORTANT After a crash, remember to remove the key from the ignition device to prevent battery run-down. Door unlocking in the event of a crash In the event of a crash that triggers the fuel cut-off switch, the doors will unlock automatically to enable getting into the car and at the same time the passenger’s compartment lights will turn on. It is however always possible to open the doors from the passenger’s compartment by means of the internal door handles. If, after a crash no fuel leaks or damages to the electric devices (e.g. headlights) are found and the car can be started again, reset the fuel cut-off switch and the power supply cut-off switch (for versions/markets, where provided). Follow the instructions given below. SAFETY DEVICES The car is fitted with a safety switch that in the event of a crash comes into operation by cutting off fuel and turning off the engine as a consequence. WARNING If central door locking has been activated from inside the car and after a crash the fuel cut-off switch cannot activate automatic door unlocking, it will not be possible to get into the car. In any case, door opening from the outside depends on door conditions after the crash: if a door is badly damaged it will be impossible to open it. In this event try to open one of the other doors. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR POWER SUPPLY AND FUEL CUT-OFF SWITCHES WARNING If, after a crash, you smell fuel or see leaks from the fuel system, do not reset the switches to avoid fire risk. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CONTROLS DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 81 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:23 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 81 8-04-2009 14:23 Pagina 82 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 046-082 Alfa 159 GB 82 A0E0221m fig. 61 Resetting the fuel cut-off switch WARNING Before resetting the fuel cut-off switch carefully inspect the car for fuel leaks or damages to electric devices (e.g. headlights). To reset the fuel cut-off switch, press button A-fig. 61. A0E0126m fig. 62 Resetting the power supply cut-off switch (for versions/markets, where provided) WARNING Before resetting the power supply cut-off switch carefully inspect the car for fuel leaks or damages to electric devices (e.g. headlights). fig. 63 A0E0071m The switch is located inside the fuse box at battery positive terminal. To reset the power supply cut-off switch, proceed as follows: ❒ press button A-fig. 61 to reset the fuel cut-off switch; ❒ open the bonnet; ❒ operate the retaining clips A-fig. 62 and remove the protection cover B; ❒ press button C-fig. 63 to reset the power supply cut-off switch. Pagina 83 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS INTERIOR FITTINGS Oddment compartment To open the oddment compartment, press button A-fig. 64 and raise the cover B. A0E0039m fig. 65 A0E0141m fig. 66 A0E0139m Air-conditioned food box (for versions/markets, where provided) WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES On certain versions the central armrest can be adjusted forward or backward by operating the cover B-fig. 64. fig. 64 Access to the food box is gained from the oddment compartment by lifting tab A-fig. 65. Turn wheel B to adjust the air flow inside the food box. IMPORTANT Function of the food box is to keep the temperature of the drinks placed inside it; drinks shall be warmed or cooled as required before being put inside the food box. Pay attention not to spill the drinks: the food box bottom however is provided with a hole to drain spilled liquids, if any. IN AN EMERGENCY The central armrest is located between the front seats. Inside the armrest are housed an oddment compartment and an air-conditioned food box (where provided) (see next paragraphs). SAFETY DEVICES CENTRAL ARMREST CORRECT USE OF THE CAR 14:08 REAR ARMREST (for versions/markets, where provided) To use the central armrest A-fig. 66 lower it as shown in the figure. TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 83 3-12-2009 14:08 Pagina 84 fig. 67 A0E0142m IN AN EMERGENCY INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 84 fig. 69 A0E0146m fig. 70 A0E0199m fig. 71 A0E0200m REAR ARMREST WITH ODDMENT COMPARTMENT (for versions/markets, where provided) WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 083-128 Alfa 159 GB fig. 68 A0E0143m Ski compartment (for versions/markets, where provided) To use the central armrest B-fig. 69, take it from tab A and then lower it. Inside the armrest is fitted an oddment compartment fig. 71. To open it, press button B-fig. 70 and raise the cover C-fig. 70. Ski compartment (for versions/markets, where provided) This compartment can be used for carrying long loads. This compartment can be used for carrying long loads. To have access to this compartment, lower the armrest, pull the lid tab Afig. 67, then lower it on the armrest fig. 68. To have access to this compartment, lower the armrest, press button A-fig. 72 of the lid B, then lower it on the armrest. 3-12-2009 14:08 Pagina 85 GLOVE COMPARTMENT fig. 73 A0E0148m To open the lid B, switch A-fig. 73 (accessible from the boot) shall be set in vertical position (horizontal position Á = compartment locked). To open the glove compartment use lever A-fig. 74. When the glove compartment is opened, the internal courtesy light turns on. Leaving inadvertently open the glove compartment, this light will turn off automatically after a few minutes. The folding top is also provided with a recess for a pen or a pencil. Do not travel with the glove compartment open; it could harm the passenger in the event of an accident. fig. 75 A0E0031m CIGAR LIGHTER Front cigar lighter (for versions/markets, where provided) It is located on the central console, near the handbrake lever. To use the cigar lighter, raise cover A-fig. 75 as shown by the arrow. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES A0E0149m IN AN EMERGENCY fig. 74 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE A0E0147m INDEX fig. 72 CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 85 3-12-2009 14:08 Pagina 86 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 083-128 Alfa 159 GB Do not plug electric accessories with absorption exceeding the max. specified value. Prolonged current absorption could drain the battery and impair next engine start up. I INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES O 86 OFF AUTO AUTO fig. 76 A0E0152m fig. 77 A0E0068m Press button B-fig. 76 to switch on the cigar lighter with key fitted into ignition device. Rear cigar lighter (for versions/markets, where provided) IMPORTANT Always check that the cigar lighter has turned off. It is located on the central console between the seats (see fig. 77). IMPORTANT The cigar lighter gets very hot. Handle it with care and make sure that it is not used by children: danger of fire and/or burns. IMPORTANT Do not plug electric accessories with power exceeding 100W to the front cigar lighter seat. IMPORTANT Do not plug electric accessories with power exceeding 140W to the rear cigar lighter seat. IMPORTANT Oversize plugs could damage the cigar lighter outlet tabs. IMPORTANT To safeguard the lighting life of certain internal devices (e.g.: cigar lighter ring and ashtray), when switching on the external lights, these devices will switch on according to the passenger's compartment brightness: with enough daylight these devices will not switch on. On the contrary they will switch on with poor daylight. 3-12-2009 14:08 Pagina 87 It is located on the central console, near the handbrake lever. To use the cigar lighter, raise cover Afig. 78 and open lid B. fig. 80 A0E0101m fig. 81 A0E0156m Rear ashtray It is located on the central console, between front seats. To use the ashtray, lift lid A-fig. 79 as shown by the arrow. Rear ashtray is removable: to remove it, press on the central part and pull it upwards. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES Front ashtray A0E0153m IN AN EMERGENCY ASHTRAY (for versions/markets, where provided) fig. 79 Front ashtray is removable: to remove it, pull it upwards. IMPORTANT Do not use the ashtray as paper bin: it could set on fire on contact with cigarette stubs. EYEGLASSES HOLDER (for versions/markets, where provided) IMPORTANT Do not use the ashtray as paper bin: it could set on fire on contact with cigarette stubs. GLASS/CAN HOLDER fig. 80 It is located near the front ceiling light. To use it, press lid A-fig. 81. It is located on the central console, near the handbrake lever. To use it lift cover A-fig. 75. TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE A0E0140m INDEX fig. 78 CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 87 3-12-2009 14:08 Pagina 88 fig. 82 A0E0197m IN AN EMERGENCY INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 88 fig. 84 A0E0154m ODDMENTS COMPARTMENTS fig. 84 (for versions/markets, where provided) WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 083-128 Alfa 159 GB They are located on the central console between the front seats. SUN VISORS fig. 83 A0E0198m SUN VISORS (for versions/markets, where provided) Certain versions are provided with sunvisors behind the rear seats. To use it, take the tab A-fig. 82, pull it forwards and secure it to the hooks set on the top of the car roof (see fig. 83). These are positioned to the sides of the rear-view mirror. They can swing to the sides and up or down. On certain versions, sun visors are fitted on the back with a courtesy mirror and a light which enables to use the mirror also with poor sunlight. fig. 85 A0E0102m To use the mirror open cover A-fig. 85. Mirror lights will turn on automatically when lifting the cover and they will turn off when lowering it or few minutes after removing the electronic key from the ignition device. 1) press and keep pressed the outer buttons (A and C): 20 seconds after led D will start flashing. Release both buttons; DESCRIPTION The HomeLink fixed-system installed on your car enables to control up to three different devices for opening/closing garage doors or gates, or for turning on/off lighting system and for activating/deactivating alarm systems installed at home and/or office. fig. 86 A0E0311m PROGRAMMING IMPORTANT While programming the system, check for the absence of people, animals or objects within the manoeuvre space of main doors or gates to prevent the risk of injuries or damages. IMPORTANT Pull up the handbrake and fit the key into the ignition device. Do not start the engine. NOTE This operation clears the standard codes programmed by the manufacturer. It will not be necessary to repeat this operation the next time you program the buttons. 2) press and keep pressed the required HomeLink button A or B or C. Do not release the button until completing operation 4; 3) when the HomeLink led D starts flashing slowly (about 20 seconds after) bring the portable remote control (keeping the button to program pressed) as close as possible to the HomeLink. SAFETY DEVICES (for versions/markets, where provided) CORRECT USE OF THE CAR Proceed as follows: WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES HOMELINK DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 89 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:08 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 89 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 90 3-12-2009 14:08 Pagina 90 The distance required between the portable remote control and the HomeLink depends on the system to be programmed (type of frequency of main door, gate or other system). If D does not start to flash quickly try again changing the distance between HomeLink and portable remote control (move them away slightly). If 20 seconds later the led is still flashing slowing, repeat the operation changing again the distance between Homelink and remote control. 4) the HomeLink led D will start blinking, first slowly and then quickly. When it starts flashing quickly, release both buttons (HomeLink and portable remote control). HOW TO USE THE HOMELINK SYSTEM SYNCHRONISING ALTERNATE CODES The HomeLink remote control activates the operation of the garage door motor or gate motor exactly as the portable remote control. The car shall be within the range of the motor and the key shall be fitted into the ignition device. To ascertain whether your garage door motor or gate motor is provided with an alternate code, proceed as follows: Press the programmed button (A or B or C). During signal transmission the led D will stay on and the set system (garage door, gate, etc.) will obey. If the HomeLink system set as described above does not work, this may be due to the fact the original portable remote control has an alternate code (see paragraph "Synchronising alternate codes"). It is however always possible to use the original portable remote control to operate the system (garage door, gate, etc.). consult the owner handbook provided by the garage door motor's or gate motor's manufacturer; the portable remote control seems to have programmed HomeLink; HomeLink however is not up to open or to close the garage door or the gate; press and keep pressed the programmed button (A or B or C). With an alternate code system, the led D blinks fast for short and then it stays on glowing steadily for two seconds. This sequence is repeated for 20 seconds. IMPORTANT The car shall be within the range of the motor. Pull up the handbrake and fit the key into the ignition device. Do not start the engine. It is possible to programme another original portable remote control on one HomeLink button already programmed. Previous programming will be cancelled. ❒ press the motor set-up button (this action will usually turn up the "setup" pilot light). After operation 2, start to perform operation 3 within 30 seconds; IMPORTANT While programming the system, check for the absence of people, animals or objects within the manoeuvre space of main doors or gates to prevent the risk of injuries or damages. ❒ press the programmed button (A or B or C) and release it. Press again the programmed button and then release it to end the operation. Certain motors could require to repeat once again the operation for concluding the setting. IMPORTANT Pull up the handbrake and fit the key into the ignition device. Do not start the engine. Now the motor should be up to recognise the signal transmitted by HomeLink and therefore to open/close the garage door or the gate. Proceed as follows: 1) press and keep pressed the required HomeLink button A or B or C. Do not release the button until completing operation 3; 2) when the HomeLink led D starts flashing slowly (about 20 seconds after) bring the portable remote control (keeping the button to program pressed) as close as possible to the HomeLink. SAFETY DEVICES ❒ find the set-up button on the upper side of the garage door/gate motor. Colour and position may vary according to the manufacturer (consult the motor handbook); RE-PROGRAMMING ONE SINGLE BUTTON CORRECT USE OF THE CAR IMPORTANT While synchronising the system, check for the absence of people, animals or objects within the manoeuvre space of main doors or gates to prevent the risk of injuries or damages. Proceed as follows: WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES HomeLink can only work if the programmed alternate code is synchronised with the system of the device (garage door, gate, etc.). DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 91 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:08 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 91 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 92 3-12-2009 14:08 Pagina 92 The distance required between the portable remote control and the HomeLink depends on the system to be programmed (type of frequency of main door, gate or other system). If D does not start to flash quickly try again changing the distance between HomeLink and portable remote control (move them away slightly). If 20 seconds later the led is still flashing slowing, repeat the operation changing again the distance between Homelink and remote control. 3) the HomeLink led D will start blinking, first slowly and then quickly. When it starts flashing quickly, release both buttons (HomeLink and portable remote control). In this way the system previously programmed on HomeLink is cleared and the new system is ready for use. This operation has no effect on the other two HomeLink buttons. CLEARING THE PROGRAMMED BUTTONS TECHNICAL DATA FOR THE ASSISTANCE SERVICE You are recommended to clear the HomeLink programming before selling the car. If after following the previous instructions you are still unable to set the HomeLink system, contact the Assistance Service (HomeLink toll free number 00800046635465) and communicate the following data: Programming is cleared on all the three buttons at the same time. Proceed as follows: ❒ press and keep pressed the outer buttons (A and C): 20 seconds after led D will start flashing. ❒ Release both buttons. ❒ make and model of your car, including the date of manufacture and the country where you bought it; ❒ make, model, date of manufacture and operating frequency of the original portable remote control (if known). IMPORTANT Certain phone carriers do not permit the use of the toll-free number. It is therefore required to dial the alternative pay-number, +49 6838 907-277 (dialling this number will start an international call). When closed it enables sunlight to get into the passenger compartment, whereas when open it enables wide opening of the whole glass sunroof surface. The sunroof is provided with manuallyoperated sun curtain with handle and air vents. Sunroof can only be operated when the key is fitted into the ignition device. Do not open the sunroof if there is snow or ice on it: it could be damaged. SAFETY DEVICES The sunroof consists of a moving pane sliding horizontally and retractable. WARNING When leaving the car, the ignition key should be removed to prevent the sunroof from being operated inadvertently and harming anyone remaining in the car. Improper use of the sunroof can be dangerous. Before and during its operation ensure that any passengers are not at risk from the moving roof either by personal objects getting caught in the mechanism or by being injured by it directly. C fig. 87 A0E0238m IMPORTANT Top comfort position with sunroof open is obtained by turning selector A-fig. 87 to position. Operating the selector it is possible to open/close the sunroof in one of the following cases: ❒ fitting the electronic key into the ignition device; SUNROOF OPENING Opening from inside the car Turn selector A-fig. 87, as shown by the arrow. The sunroof will stop in position as soon as the selector is released. The movement of the roof may be interrupted and restarted by means of slight pressure on selector A. ❒ in the first 2 minutes after removing the key from the ignition device or up to door opening. Opening from outside the car Press the electronic key button Ë for over 2 seconds. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR (for versions/markets, where provided) WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES SUNROOF DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 93 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:08 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 93 3-12-2009 14:08 Pagina 94 SUNROOF CLOSING The movement of the roof may be interrupted and restarted by means of slight pressure on selector A. Though the selector A (by pressing it) it is possible to use the “Inhibit” position that will exclude the anti-crushing safety system. INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES SAFETY DEVICES Turn selector A-fig. 87 counter-clockwise. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 94 If when removing the key from the ignition device, you activate sunroof sliding by pressing the electronic key button Ë while sunroof sliding by manual control (by pressing the selector) is being performed, this last control will prevail. To make the sunroof sliding automatically you have to press again button Ë. Sunroof sliding by pressing the electronic key button Ë can be stopped by operating selector A-fig. 87 (by changing its position or pressing it). Changing selector position, will make the sunroof slide to the new position ignoring button Ë. fig. 88 WARNING Open and close the roof only when the vehicle is stationary. A0E0070m SUN CURTAIN fig. 88 The sun curtain shall be used to adjust brightness inside the passenger compartment. Sun curtain is fitted with handle and air vents. After disconnecting the battery or failing the protection fuse, the sunroof shall be “initialised” again, proceed as follows: When an obstacle is found, sunroof stroke is stopped immediately and its stroke is reversed to the preset position: ❒ during horizontal closing it is active along the whole stroke of the sunroof and when it finds an obstacle on the front side of the pane it guarantees a 10 cm stroke reversal; ❒ during vertical closing it is active along the whole stroke of the sunroof and when it finds an obstacle on the rear side of the pane it guarantees stroke reversal. ❒ turn selector fully leftwards (counterclokwise); fig. 89 A0E0187m EMERGENCY OPERATION In a emergency or during servicing (without power supply), the sunroof can be operated manually; proceed as follows: ❒ press and keep pressed selector until sunroof locking; ❒ release selector; ❒ press selector again within 3 seconds, and keep it pressed; ❒ press the light notches to release the clips and remove the front ceiling light A-fig. 89. ❒ a few seconds after the sunroof will move automatically (during this stage keep on pressing the knob); ❒ fit the setscrew wrench into the proper slot B; ❒ initialisation will end when the sunroof stops. Release selector. ❒ turn the key to open or to close (according to rotation direction) the sunroof. SAFETY DEVICES The anti-crushing safety system fitted on the front curtain outline is active during horizontal closing (front edge) and vertical closing of the panel (rear edge) and it will cut in when it finds an obstacle (e.g.: finger, hand, etc …), thus guaranteeing sunroof reversal for a short section. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SUNROOF INITIALISATION PROCEDURE WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES ANTI-CRUSHING SAFETY SYSTEM DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 95 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:08 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 95 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 96 3-12-2009 14:08 Pagina 96 DOORS CENTRAL DOOR LOCKING/ UNLOCKING SYSTEM Door locking from the outside With the doors closed, press the electronic key button Á or fit and turn the metal insert (inside the key) into the lock of the driver’s door. Central door locking can only be activated if all the doors are closed. If one or more doors are open after pressing the electronic key button Á the direction indicators and the driver’s door led will flash fast for about 3 seconds. If one or more doors are open by turning the metal insert of the electronic key, only the driver’s door led will flash fast for about 3 seconds. If the doors are closed but the tailgate is open, central locking is actuated: the direction indicators (only for locking performed by pressing button Á) and the driver’s door led will flash fast for about 3 seconds. Through the “Setup menu” (or the Radionavigation system for certain versions) it is possible to activate the function that enables to unlock only the driver’s door lock by pressing the electronic key button Ë (see paragraph “Reconfigurable multifunction display” in this section). With this function on (ON) it is however possible to unlock the other doors by pressing button q (fig. 90) set on the central console. Door unlocking from the outside Press the electronic key button Ë or, fit and turn the metal insert (inside the key) into the lock of the driver’s door. Door locking/unlocking from the inside Press button q (fig. lock/unlock all the doors. 90) to The button is provided with a circular led indicating the car condition (doors locked or unlocked). When doors are locked the led is on: in this case pressing the button again will unlock all the doors and will turn the led off. fig. 90 A0E0025m With key removed the led will turn off after about 2 minutes. When doors are unlocked the led is off; pressing the button will lock all the doors. Central door locking will only take place if all doors are perfectly closed. fig. 91 A0E0155m CHILD LOCK Rear doors are fitted with a locking device fig. 91 that inhibits door opening from the inside. This device can be engaged/disengaged (by the metal insert of the key) only with doors open: ❒ position 1: engaged (door locked); ❒ position 2: disengaged (door can be opened from the inside). IMPORTANT After engaging the child lock on both rear doors, check for proper engagement by trying to open a rear door with the internal handle. SAFETY DEVICES IMPORTANT Always use this device when transporting children. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR IMPORTANT With central locking system on, pulling the internal door handle will unlock all the doors. Lacking power (blown fuse, battery disconnected, etc.) it is however possible to lock the doors manually. IMPORTANT Each device acts only on the relevant door. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES Button q is disabled after door locking carried out by operating the remote control, the driver's door revolving plug, or by automatic door locking after about 2.5 minutes and it will be enabled again after door unlocking carried out by pressing the key button Ë, by turning the metal insert of the key into the driver's door lock or by fitting the key into the ignition device. DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 97 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:08 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 97 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 98 3-12-2009 14:08 Pagina 98 DOOR LOCKING WITH RUN DOWN BATTERY If the car battery is run down, to lock the doors proceed as described in the following points. Right front door Proceed as follows: ❒ remove the protection plug on the door; ❒ fit the electronic key metal insert into A-fig. 92; fig. 92 A0E0237m Doorknobs can be realigned (only after recharging the battery) as follows: ❒ pressing the electronic key button Ë; IMPORTANT As concerns rear doors, with child lock device on and the previously described locking active, operating the internal door handle will not open the door but will only realign doorknobs; to open the door pull the external door handle. Emergency locking will not disable central door locking/unlocking button q. IMPORTANT After disconnecting the battery or failing the protection fuse, the door locking/unlocking mechanism shall be “initialised” again, proceed as follows: ❒ turn the key clockwise (counter-clockwise for right-hand drive versions); ❒ pressing door locking/unlocking button q; ❒ remove the key from A-fig. 92 and then efit the plug on the door. ❒ opening with the key in front door revolving plug; ❒ press the remote control button Á or the button q on the central console; ❒ pulling internal door handle. ❒ press the remote control button Ë or the button q on the central console. ❒ lock the doors; This system is particularly useful when children operate the windows inadvertently and make it possible to close/ open (where provided) the windows using the remote control when leaving the car. In this case it is necessary to carry out system restore procedure as follows: ❒ open the windows; or ❒ remove and then refit the key into the ignition device. If no malfunction is present, the window returns to its normal operation automatically. In the event of a failure see section “Warning lights and messages”. Windows and sunroof opening/closing by the electronic key (for versions/ markets, where provided) By the metal insert of the key On all versions: ❒ turning clockwise the metal insert of the key into the driver's door revolving plug will open all the win- ❒ turning counterclockwise the metal insert of the key into the driver's door revolving plug will close all the windows and the sunroof (for versions/ markets, where provided) at the same time. By remote control On all versions, keep button Ë pressed for over 2 seconds to open all the windows and the sunroof (where provided) at the same time. SAFETY DEVICES Versions with 4 power windows are fitted with automatic window opening/ closing on all doors. For versions/markets where applicable the passenger side electrical window and the rear electrical windows are provided with a safety system with anti-crushing seal able to recognize the eventual presence of an obstacle during the closing movement of the window; upon verification of this event the system interrupts and immediately inverts the run of the window. dows and the sunroof (for versions/ markets, where provided) at the same time. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR Versions with 2 front power windows are fitted with automatic window opening/closing only on the driver’s side. IMPORTANT In the event the anticrushing function is activated 5 times in only 1 minute or in the event of a failure, the system will automatically enter the “recovery” mode (self-protection). This condition is pointed out by the fact that, in the closing stroke, the windows goes up in jerks. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES POWER WINDOWS DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 99 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:08 The system complies with the forthcoming Standard 2000/4/ EC concerning the safety of passengers leaning out of the passenger compartment. TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 99 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 3-12-2009 14:08 Pagina 100 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS C (for versions/markets, where provided) – rear left window opening/closing; “automatic continuous” mode operation during window opening/closing; 100 fig. 93 A0E0051m CONTROLS Driver side On the driver’s door panel are set the buttons fig. 93 for controlling, with electronic key fitted into the ignition device: A – front left window opening/closing; window opening or closing in “automatic continuous” mode; B – front right window opening/closing; window opening or closing in “automatic continuous” mode (only versions with 4 power windows); D (for versions/markets, where provided) – rear right window opening/closing; “automatic continuous” mode operation just during window opening; E (for versions/markets, where provided) – rear power window enabling/disabling controls (when rear power window controls are disabled, the led on button E will turn on and disabled controls will turn off). Improper use of the power windows can be dangerous. Before and during its operation ensure that any passengers are not at risk from the moving glass either by personal objects getting caught in the mechanism or by being injured by it directly. Always remove the ignition key when getting out of the car to prevent the power windows being operated accidentally and constituting a danger to the passengers in the car. Press buttons A, B, C or D to open/ close the required window. Front passenger door/ rear doors Pressing briefly one of the buttons the window “jerks” whereas a prolonged pressing makes the window opening or closing in “automatic continuous” mode. Front passenger door and, on certain versions, rear doors are fitted with button panels controlling opening/closing of the corresponding window. Pressing button A, B, C or D again will stop the window in the required position. Opening the boot its internal light will turn on and it will turn off automatically when re-closing the tailgate. Leaving the tailgate inadvertently open, the light will turn off automatically after a few minutes. Through the “Setup menu” (or the Radionavigation system for certain versions) boot opening can be set by selecting the option “Indep. boot” (see paragraph “Reconfigurable multifunction display” in this section): when this function is on, the boot can only be opened by pressing the electronic key button `. fig. 94 A0E0498m On certain versions, improper boot closing is indicated by the instrument panel warning light ´, whereas on other versions the symbol R and a message are displayed (see section “Warning lights and messages”). When unlocked, the boot can be opened from outside the vehicle pressing the electric logo (fig. 94) until it snaps unlocked. SAFETY DEVICES The boot lock is electric and it is disabled when the car is running. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR Tailgate opening is facilitated by the side gas shock springs. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES BOOT DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 101 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:08 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 101 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 3-12-2009 14:08 Pagina 102 ❒ lock the doors and the tailgate; A0E0228m EMERGENCY OPENING OF THE BOOT FROM THE PASSENGER COMPARTMENT (foreseen only on the 3-volume saloon version) If the battery is disconnected, the boot can be opened by pulling the lever A-fig. 95 set under the rear left seat. INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES fig. 95 IN AN EMERGENCY CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS IMPORTANT After disconnecting the battery or failing the protection fuse, the tailgate locking/unlocking mechanism shall be “initialised” again, proceed as follows: 102 Refit the handle under the cushion after using it. OPENING BY REMOTE CONTROL Press the electronic key button `. Opening is indicated by double flashing of direction indicators. ❒ press the remote control button Á or the button q on the central console; Opening the boot with alarm (for versions/markets, where provided) on will cause the following: ❒ press the remote control button Ë or the button q on the central console. ❒ volumetric protection deactivation; ❒ anti-raising protection deactivation; ❒ tailgate monitoring sensor. Re-closing the tailgate will restore all the above functions and direction indicators will turn on for about 1 second. The addition of objects (speakers, spoilers, etc.) on the rear shelf or boot lid, except those envisaged by the manufacturer, may prevent the gas filled struts at the sides of the boot from working properly. EXTENDING THE BOOT (for versions/markets, where provided) To extend the boot proceed as follows: ❒ remove rear head restraints; ❒ move aside the seat belt, check that it is not twisted; WARNING Never travel with objects on the rear shelf to prevent them being thrown forwards and injuring passengers in case of accident or sharp braking. SAFETY DEVICES IMPORTANT If the option for ”Indep. boot” is on, before closing the boot, check whether you have with you the ignition key since the boot will be locked automatically. WARNING When using the boot, make sure the loads do not exceed the permitted weight (see “Technical specifications” chapter). Also make sure the items in the boot are arranged properly to prevent them being thrown forwards and injuring passengers should you brake sharply. fig. 96 A0E0085m ❒ lift seat back lever A-fig. 96 and tilt the seat back forward. Lever raising is indicated by a “red band” B. IMPORTANT Before folding the backrest over onto the cushion, in order to avoid interference, make sure that the seat belt branches are in their housings on the cushion. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR Lower the tailgate pressing the lock until hearing the locking click. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES TAILGATE CLOSING DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 103 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:08 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 103 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 104 3-12-2009 14:08 Pagina 104 TO RETURN THE REAR SEAT BACK TO ITS ORIGINAL POSITION WARNING Move aside the seat belts, check that they are not twisted. Raise the seat backrests and push them back until hearing the locking click of both retainers; the “red band” B aside the levers A shall no longer be visible. The “red band” B actually indicates that the backrest is not properly secured. IMPORTANT Make sure the head restraints are properly positioned. WARNING Make sure the backrest is properly secured at both sides (“red bands” Bfig. 96 not visible) to prevent it moves forward in the event of sharp braking causing injuries to passengers. A0E0131m fig. 97 ANCHORING THE LOAD The boot houses 4 hooks A-fig. 97 for anchoring ropes in order to guarantee perfect load anchoring. WARNING A heavy load that has not been secured may cause serious harm. If you want to carry reserve fuel in a can, follow law regulations, only using a certified can, suitably fastened to the load securing eyelets. Even in this way the risk of fire is increased in the case of an accident. ❒ pull lever A-fig. 98 until hearing the releasing click; ❒ press the safety lever B-fig. 99 upwards and raise the bonnet. fig. 98 A0E0122m WARNING IMPORTANT Bonnet raising is aided by two gas springs. Do not tamper with these springs and guide the bonnet while raising it. IMPORTANT Before opening the bonnet, check that windscreen wiper arms are not lifted from the windscreen. IMPORTANT Always check that the bonnet is closed properly to avoid its opening while the car is travelling. Carry out operations only when the car is stationary. WARNING fig. 99 A0E0470m TO CLOSE THE BONNET Lower the bonnet at approx. 20 centimetres from the engine compartment and then let it drop, ensuring that it is fully closed and not just held in position by the safety catch. If the bonnet does not close properly, do not push it down but open it again and repeat the above procedure. For safety reasons the bonnet must be closed properly to avoid its opening while the car is travelling. Therefore, always check it is properly closed and the catch engaged. Should you notice that the catch is not perfectly engaged when travelling, stop the car immediately and close the bonnet. SAFETY DEVICES Proceed as follows: CORRECT USE OF THE CAR TO OPEN THE BONNET WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES Improper bonnet closing is indicated (on certain versions) by the instrument panel warning light ´ (where provided), or by symbol S and a message on the display (see section “Warning lights and messages”). BONNET DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 105 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:08 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 105 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 106 3-12-2009 14:09 Pagina 106 HEADLIGHTS ROOF RACK/ SKI RACK ADJUSTING THE HEADLIGHT BEAM The car is preset for mounting roof racks/ski racks. Front hooks are in points A-fig. 100. Rear hooks are in points B. fig. 100 A0E0097m IMPORTANT After few kilometers, check that fastening screws are firmly tightened. Distribute the load evenly and when driving, bear in mind the increased sensitivity to side wind. IMPORTANT Never exceed the max. permissible loads (see section “”Technical specifications”). Proper adjustment of the headlight beams is of vital importance for your safety and comfort and also for the other road users. To ensure you and other drivers have the best visibility conditions when travelling with the headlights on, the headlights must be set properly. Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services to have the headlights properly adjusted. HEADLIGHT AIMING DEVICE It works with the key fitted into the ignition device and dipped beams on. When the car is loaded, it slopes backwards. This means that the headlight beam rises. In this case, it is necessary to return it to the correct position. 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 3-12-2009 14:09 Pagina 107 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Control has four positions corresponding to the loads given below: SAFETY DEVICES ❒ position 0: one or two passenger on front seats and kerb weight (including full fuel tank, tools and accessories); FRONT FOG LIGHT ADJUSTMENT Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services to have the headlights correctly adjusted. HEADLIGHT ADJUSTMENT ABROAD The dipped beam headlights are adjusted for circulation in the country in which the car is marketed. In countries with opposite circulation, to avoid glaring oncoming vehicles, proceed as follows: ❒ remove headlight cover (see paragraph “Dipped beam headlights” in section “In an emergency”); ❒ move lever A-fig. 102 aside; WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES IMPORTANT Check headlight slant each time the transported load changes. A0E0050m IN AN EMERGENCY If the car is fitted with bixenon headlights, headlight aiming is electronic and therefore control A is not present. ❒ position 3: driver plus 300 kg load completely stored into the boot. fig. 102 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE In this event, to adjust the headlight slant use control A-fig. 101 set on the button control panel near the steering wheel. ❒ position 2: five passengers and boot fully loaded (about 50 kg); INDEX fig. 101 CORRECT USE OF THE CAR ❒ position 1: five passengers; A0E0226m 107 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 108 3-12-2009 14:09 Pagina 108 ABS SYSTEM The car is fitted with ABS braking system, which prevents the wheels from locking when braking, makes the most of road grip and gives the best control when emergency braking under difficult road conditions. System is completed by EBD (Electronic Braking Force Distribution), which distributes the braking action between front and rear wheels. IMPORTANT To have the maximum efficiency of the braking system, it is necessary a setting period of about 500 km: during this period it is better to avoid sharp, repeated and prolonged brakes. ABS SYSTEM INTERVENTION The driver can tell the ABS system has come into action because the brake pedal pulsates slightly and the system gets noisier: it means that the car speed should be altered to fit the type of road surface. WARNING The ABS exploits the tyre-road grip at the best, but it cannot improve it; you should therefore take every care when driving on slippery surfaces without taking unnecessary risks. WARNING If the ABS system cuts in, it is a sign that the grip between tyre and the road surface has reached the limit: you must slow down to match the speed to the road grip available. WARNING When the ABS cuts in, and you feel the brake pedal pulsating, do not remove your foot, but keep it pressed; in doing so you will stop in the shortest amount of space possible under the current road conditions. Drive carefully to the closest Alfa Romeo Authorized Services to have the system checked. In this case with sharp braking the rear wheels might lock too early, with the possibility of skidding. Drive extremely carefully to the closest Alfa Romeo Authorized Services to have the system checked. The system, which cannot be cut out, recognizes emergency braking (on the ground of the brake pedal operation speed) and considerably increases the pressure in the brake circuit. Brake Assist is deactivated on the versions equipped with VDC system in the event of VDC system failure, indicated by the turning on of warning light á on the instrument panel (on certain versions together with a message on the display). SAFETY DEVICES ABS failure is indicated by the turning on of warning light > on the instrument panel (on certain versions together with the dedicated message on the display) (see section “Warning lights and messages”). In this case the braking system is still efficient, though without the aid of the ABS system. EBD failure is indicated by the turning on of warning lights > + x on the instrument panel (on certain versions together with the dedicated message on the display) (see section “Warning lights and messages”). BRAKE ASSIST (emergency braking assistance) CORRECT USE OF THE CAR ABS failure EBD failure WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES FAILURE WARNING LIGHTS DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 109 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:09 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 109 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 110 3-12-2009 14:09 Pagina 110 VDC SYSTEM (Vehicle Dynamics Control) (for versions/markets, where provided) The VDC system is an electronic system controlling the car stability in the event of tyre grip loss. The VDC system is therefore particularly useful when grip conditions of the road surfaces changes. VDC SYSTEM INTERVENTION It is signalled by the blinking of the warning light á on the instrument panel, to inform the driver that the car is in critical stability and grip conditions. TURNING THE VDC SYSTEM ON/OFF The VDC system is automatically activated when the engine is started. When travelling, to turn the VDC off press the ASR/ VDC button on the central console fig. 103 for 2 seconds. Turning off the VDC will also turn off the ASR. Both functions can be reactivated by pressing the ASR/VDC button. VDC system deactivation is indicated by the instrument panel warning light á (on certain versions a symbol is displayed) and by the circular led around the ASR/VDC button. If the VDC has been turned off when travelling, at next engine start-up it will turn on again automatically. fig. 103 A0E0026m FAILURE WARNING LIGHTS In the event of failure, the VDC system is automatically disconnected and the warning light á comes on with fixed light on the instrument panel (on certain versions together with a message on the display) (see section “Warning lights and messages”). In this case contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services as soon as possible. WARNING For correct operation of the VDC system, the tyres must absolutely be of the same brand and type on all wheels, in perfect conditions and, above all, of type, brand and size specified. This system is an integral part of the VDC system and it is provided to facilitate starting on slopes: ❒ uphill: car at a standstill on a road with a gradient higher than 6%, engine running, clutch and brake pedal depressed, gearbox to neutral or engaged gear other than reverse; ❒ downhill: car at a standstill on a road with a gradient higher than 6%, engine running, clutch and brake pedal depressed and reverse gear engaged. At pickup the VDC system control unit will keep brake force on wheels until reaching the torque suitable for starting, or in any case for about 1 second in order to pass easily from the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal. SAFETY DEVICES During the use of the space-saver spare wheel for versions/markets, (where provided), the VDC system carries on working. However, you must remind that the space-saver spare wheel has dimensions smaller than the standard tyre and therefore its grip is reduced as to the other car tyres. HILL HOLDER SYSTEM (for versions/markets, where provided) CORRECT USE OF THE CAR Performance of the VDC system, in terms of active safety should not induce the driver to take pointless and unnecessary risks. The style of driving must in any case always be adapted to the conditions of the road surface, visibility an traffic. Road safety is always the driver’s responsibility. WARNING WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES WARNING DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 111 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:09 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 111 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 112 3-12-2009 14:09 Pagina 112 This time elapsing without starting, the system will deactivate automatically by releasing gradually the brake force. At releasing, the typical brake disengagement noise indicating that the car is going to move will be heard. Failure warnings System failure is indicated by the turning on of warning light * (where provided) on the instrument panel (on certain versions together with the dedicated message on the display) (see section “Warning lights and messages”). IMPORTANT The Hill Holder system is not a parking brake. Never get out of the car without engaging the handbrake, switching the engine off and engaging the first gear. ASR SYSTEM (AntiSlip Regulation) This system is an integral part of the VDC system, it controls car drive and cuts in automatically every time one or both driving wheels slip. According to slipping conditions, two different control systems are activated: ❒ if slipping involves both driving wheels, the ASR function intervenes reducing the power transmitted by the engine; ❒ if slipping involves only one driving wheel, the ASR system cuts in automatically braking the wheel that is slipping. ❒ acceleration on slippery, snowy or frozen surfaces; ❒ in the case of loss of grip on a wet surface (aquaplaning). ASR turns on automatically when turning the instrument panel on. When travelling the ASR can be switched off by pressing briefly the ASR/VDC button on the central console. When the ASR is switched off this is shown by the lighting up of the ASR/VDC button led (on versions fitted with “Reconfigurable multifunction display” symbol V will also be displayed). If the ASR is switched off when travelling, it will turn on again automatically the next time the engine is started. When travelling on snowy roads with snow chains, it may be helpful to turn the ASR off: in fact, in these conditions, slipping of the driving wheels when moving off makes it possible to obtain better drive. SAFETY DEVICES ❒ too much power transmitted to the wheels also in relation to the conditions of the road surface; The performance of the system, in terms of active safety should not induce the driver to take pointless and unnecessary risks. The style of driving must in any case always be adapted to the conditions of the road surface, visibility an traffic. Road safety is always the driver’s responsibility. Switching the ASR system on/off CORRECT USE OF THE CAR ❒ slipping of the inner wheel due to the effect of dynamic load changes or excessive acceleration; WARNING WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES The action of the ASR is particularly helpful in the following circumstances: DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 113 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:09 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 113 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 114 3-12-2009 14:09 Pagina 114 Failure warnings In the event of malfunctioning, the ASR system is automatically disconnected and on versions fitted with “Reconfigurable multifunction display” symbol V is displayed. In this case contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services as soon as possible. WARNING For correct operation of the ASR system, the tyres must absolutely be of the same brand and type on all wheels, in normal conditions of use, at the proper inflation pressure values and, above all, of type, brand and size specified (see paragraph “Wheels” in section “Technical Specifications”). MSR system (engine braking torque control) It is an integral part of the ASR system that in case of sudden gear shifting, cuts in providing torque to the engine thus preventing excessive driving wheel drive that, specially in poor grip conditions, can lead to loss of stability. It also alerts the driver, by turning on the warning light U on the instrument panel (on certain versions together with the message on the display) (see section “Warning lights and messages”), when these conditions are no longer in peak conditions. ❒ to warn when a fault causes emission levels to increase; ❒ to warn of the need to replace deteriorated components. The system also has a diagnostic connector that can be interfaced with appropriate tools, which makes it possible to read the error codes stored in the control unit, together with a series of specific parameters for engine operation and diagnosis. This check can also be carried out by the traffic police. IMPORTANT After eliminating the inconvenience, to check the system completely, Alfa Romeo Authorized Services are obliged to run a bench test and, if necessary, road tests which may also call for a long journey. If when fitting the key into the ignition device, the warning light U does not turn on or if, while travelling it turns on glowing steadily or flashing, contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services as soon as possible. Warning light U operation can be checked by means of special equipment by traffic agents. Always comply with the traffic regulations in force in the country where you are travelling. SAFETY DEVICES The EOBD system (European On Board Diagnosis) allows continuous diagnosis of the components of the car correlated with emissions. ❒ to keep system efficiency under control; CORRECT USE OF THE CAR (for versions/markets, where provided) The objective is: WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES EOBD SYSTEM DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 115 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:09 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 115 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 116 3-12-2009 14:09 Pagina 116 SOUND SYSTEM PRESETTING (for versions/markets, where provided) When the sound system has not been requested the car is provided with two oddment compartments on the instrument panel. Sound system presetting includes: ❒ sound system power cables; ❒ front and rear speakers cables; ❒ aerial power cable; ❒ sound system compartment; If you decide to install the sound system after buying the car, contact first Alfa Romeo Authorized Services that will give you useful advice about installation and how to safeguard the battery. Excessive loadless absorption damages the battery and the battery warranty can be invalidated. ACCESSORIES PURCHASED BY THE OWNER If after buying the car, you decide to install electrical accessories that require a permanent electric supply (alarm, satellite antitheft system, etc.) or accessories that in any case burden the electric supply, contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services, whose qualified personnel, besides suggesting the most suitable devices belonging to Lineaccessori Alfa Romeo, will also evaluate the overall electric absorption, checking whether the car’s electric system is able to withstand the load required, or whether it needs to be integrated with a more powerful battery. ❒ aerial on car roof. The sound system shall be installed in the proper space occupied by the oddment compartment that shall be removed by pressing the two retaining tabs set in the oddment compartment: here you will find the power cables. WARNING Take care when fitting additional spoilers, alloy rims and non-standard wheel caps: they might reduce ventilation of the brakes, thus their efficiency, during abrupt and repeated braking, or long downhill slopes. Make sure that nothing (mats, etc.) gets in the way of the pedals when they are pushed down. Fiat Auto S.p.A. authorizes the installation of transceivers provided that installation is carried out at a specialized shop, workmanlike performed and in compliance with manufacturer’s specifications. Fiat Auto S.p.A. declines all responsibility for damages caused by the installation of non-genuine accessories or not recommended by Fiat Auto S.p.A. and installed not in compliance with the specified requirements. Radio transceiver equipment (vehicle mobile phones, CB radios, amateur radio and similar equipment) shall not be used inside the car unless a separate aerial is mounted on the roof. IMPORTANT The use of mobile phones, HAM radio systems or other similar devices inside the passenger compartment (without separate aerial) may cause electronic systems equipping the car to malfunction. This could compromise safety in addition to constituting a potential hazard for the passengers. In addition, transmission and reception of these devices may be affected by the shielding effect of the car body. As concerns the use of mobile phones (GSM, GPRS, UMTS) with homologation , keep strictly to the mobile phone manufacturer’s specifications. SAFETY DEVICES RADIO TRANSMITTERS AND CELLULAR TELEPHONES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR Electric/electronic devices installed after buying the car or in aftermarket shall bear the and marking: IMPORTANT Installation of devices resulting in modifications of car characteristics may cause driving license seizing by traffic agents and also the lapse of the warranty as concerns defects due to the abovementioned modification or traceable back to it directly or indirectly. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES INSTALLATION OF ELECTRIC/ELECTRONIC DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 117 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:09 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 117 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 118 3-12-2009 14:09 Pagina 118 PARKING SENSORS (where provided) Parking sensors inform the driver about the presence of obstacles behind the car (versions fitted with 4 rear sensors) or behind and in front of the car (versions fitted with 4 rear sensors and 4 front sensors). This system is therefore an aid for the driver when parking the car since it detects obstacles out of the driver’s sight range. The presence and the distance from the car of an obstacle is indicated by a warning buzzer - as the distance from the obstacle decreases, the acoustic alarm becomes more frequent - and, only on certain versions, by an image on the display (see paragraph “Indications on the display). Versions with 8 sensors Front and rear sensors are automatically activated with electronic key fitted into the ignition device when reverse gear is engaged or when pressing the front ceiling light button A-fig. 104 with speed below 15 km/h. Versions with 4 sensors Sensors are deactivated by pressing again button A-fig. 104 if the speed is lower than 15 km/h or when exceeding 18 km/h. If the system is off, the button led is off. Front sensors are automatically activated with electronic key fitted into the ignition device when reverse gear is engaged or when pressing the front ceiling light button A-fig. 104 with speed below 15 km/h. When sensors are on, front and rear indicators will sound warning signals as soon as an obstacle is detected: as the distance from the obstacle decreases, the acoustic alarm becomes more frequent. Sensors are deactivated when exceeding 18 km/h or, on certain versions by pressing again the button if the speed is lower than 15 km/h A-fig. 104. If the system is off on versions with deactivation button, the button led is off. When the distance between the car and the obstacle is less than 30 cm, the acoustic alarm becomes continuous. According to obstacle position (in front or behind the car), the acoustic alarm will be emitted by front or rear indicators. fig. 104 A0E0482m ACTIVATION In any case the system will indicate the obstacle closest to the car. The presence of any obstacle and its distance from the car is indicated by the buzzers installed inside the passenger compartment: fig. 105 A0E0231m fig. 106 A0E0232m ❒ on versions with 8 sensors (4 front sensors and 4 rear sensors) obstacles are indicated by rear and front buzzers. This feature gives the driver the direction (front/rear) of the obstacle. IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING Parking manoeuvres however are always under the driver’s responsibility that shall always check the absence of people (specially children) or animals in the manoeuvre space. This system is just a help for the driver but she/he shall never reduce attention during dangerous manoeuvres even if performed at low speed. ❒ on versions with 4 rear sensors, the rear buzzer will indicate the presence of rear obstacles; SAFETY DEVICES BUZZER CORRECT USE OF THE CAR The acoustic alarm will stop immediately as distance raises. The acoustic alarm is constant if the distance measured by central sensors is unvaried, whereas if this situation takes place for side sensors the acoustic alarm is muted after about 3 seconds to prevent sound indications when performing manoeuvres near walls. DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 119 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:09 SENSORS Obstacles are detected by 4 sensors located in the front bumper (where provided) fig. 105 and 4 sensors located in the rear bumper fig. 106. TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 119 3-12-2009 14:09 Pagina 120 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 120 fig. 107 A0E0239m INDICATIONS ON THE DISPLAY (for versions/markets, where provided) On versions with 8 sensors, sensor activation is indicated on the “Reconfigurable multifunction display” (where provided) by screen fig.107; therefore obstacle presence and distance is indicated (in addition to buzzer) also on the instrument panel display. In the event of several obstacles, the obstacle closest to the car will be indicated. For proper operation, the parking sensors shall always be clean from mud, dirt, snow or ice. When cleaning the sensors, take the utmost care to prevent their damaging; do not use therefore dry or rough clothes. Sensors shall be washed with clean water and car detergent, if required. In washing stations, clean sensors quickly keeping the vapour jet/high pressure washing nozzles at 10 cm at least from the sensors. Repainting the bumpers or touch-up in the sensor area, if required, shall be carried out at Alfa Romeo Authorized Services only. Incorrect repainting may impair regular operation of the parking sensors. SENSOR DETECTION RANGE Sensors enable the system to monitor the front part (versions with 8 sensors) and the rear part of the car. Actually their position covers the central and side areas of the front and rear part of the car. An obstacle positioned at central area is detected at a distance less than 0.9 m (front) and 1.40 m (rear). An obstacle positioned at side area is detected at a distance less than 0.6 m. Rear sensors operation is deactivated automatically when the trailer electric cable plug is fitted into the car tow hook socket. FAILURE INDICATIONS The system control unit checks every system component each time the key is fitted into the ignition device. Sensors and relevant electrical connections are then constantly monitored during system operation. Sensor failure is indicated by turning on of warning light t (where provided) on the instrument panel (on certain versions together with the message on the display) (see section “Warning lights and messages”). If the warning light stays on, contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services to have the system inspected, although the system keeps on working. If the failure detected does not impair system operation, the system keeps on working and failure is stored in order to be then detected by Alfa Romeo Authorized Services at next inspection. When parking, take the utmost care to obstacles that may be set above or under the sensors. Objects set close to the car front or rear part, under certain circumstances are not detected and could therefore cause damages to the car or be damaged. Indications sent by the sensors can be altered by dirt, snow or ice deposited on the sensors or by ultrasound systems (e.g.: truck pneumatic brakes or pneumatic hammers) set nearby the car. SAFETY DEVICES GENERAL WARNINGS CORRECT USE OF THE CAR Rear sensors are reactivated automatically when removing the trailer cable plug. If a failure is indicated, stop the car, turn the engine off and then clean the sensors. Make sure to be far from possible ultrasound sources (e.g.: truck pneumatic brakes or pneumatic hammers). If failure cause has been eliminated the system will resume regular operation and warning t and the corresponding warning message will turn off. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES TOWING TRAILERS DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 121 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:09 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 121 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 122 3-12-2009 14:09 Pagina 122 TYRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM T.P.M.S. (for versions/markets, where provided) The car may be equipped with a Tyre Pressure Monitoring System, which indicates to the driver the tyre pressure status by two different indications: “Check tyre pressures” and “Low tyre pressures”. For a detailed description of the two indications, see the “Warning Lights and Messages” section. This system consists of a radio-frequency sensor, installed on each wheel (on the rim inside the tyre) that sends pressure information to the control unit. WARNING The T.P.M.S. does not exempt the driver from checking tyre pressure, including the space-saver spare wheel (for versions/markets, where provided) at regular intervals. IMPORTANT NOTES Failure indications will not be stored and therefore will not be displayed when turning the engine off and on again. If failure persists, the control unit will send warning indications to the instrument panel only after a few seconds when the car is moving. Tyre pressure should be checked with tyres cold. Should it become necessary for whatever reason to check pressure with hot tyres, do not reduce pressure although it is higher than the prescribed value but repeat the check when tyres are cold (see section “Wheels” in section “Technical Specifications”). T.P.M.S. cannot indicate sudden tyre pressure drops (e.g.: tyre burst). In this event, brake the car cautiously and avoid sudden steering. The T.P.M.S. system requires special equipment. Consult Alfa Romeo Authorized Services to know what type of accessories are compatible with the system (wheels, wheel caps, etc.). Using other accessories could cause system malfunctioning. Due to inflation valve special characteristics, use only tyre repair sealants approved by Alfa Romeo; other sealants could cause system malfunctioning. Tyre pressure could change according to outside temperature. For this reason the T.P.M.S. system could temporarily indicate low tyre pressure. In this event check pressure with cold tyres and restore proper inflation values if required. SAFETY DEVICES Strong radio-frequency disturbances could inhibit proper TPMS system operation. This condition is indicated by a dedicated massage on the display. This indication will go off automatically as soon as the radio-frequency disturbance ceases. If the car is fitted with T.P.M.S. system, tyre and/or rim removal and refitting operations involve special precautions; to prevent damages or wrong sensor refitting, contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services to have tyre and/or rim changed. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR If after repairing a punctured tyre with the Fix&Go automatic kit and restoring the initial conditions the flat tyre warning light continues to stay on, contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES If the car is fitted with T.P.M.S. system, when changing a tyre, change also the rubber seal of the valve and the fastening ring of the sensor. Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 123 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:09 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 123 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 124 3-12-2009 14:09 Pagina 124 In order to use the system properly, refer to the following table when you have to change wheels/tyres: Operation Sensor presence Failure Indication Alfa Romeo Authorized Services operation – – YES Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services Wheel change with space-saver spare wheel NO YES Repair damaged wheel Wheel change with snow tyres NO YES Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services Wheel change with snow tyres YES NO – Wheel change with others of different size (*) YES NO – Wheel cross switching (front/rear) (**) YES NO – (*) Given as an alternative on the owner's manual and to be found in Lineaccessori Alfa Romeo. (**) Not crossed (tyres shall remain on the same side). Use only unleaded petrol. To prevent errors, the diameter of the fuel tank filler is too small to introduce a lead petrol pump filler. Use petrol with a rated octane number (R.O.N.) not lower than 95. If the outside temperature is very low, the diesel thickens due to the formation of paraffins and could clog the diesel fuel filter. IMPORTANT An inefficient catalyst leads to harmful exhaust emissions, thus contributing to air pollution. IMPORTANT Never use leaded petrol, even in small amount or in an emergency, as this would damage the catalyst beyond repair. In order to avoid these problems, different types of diesel are distributed according to the season: summer type, winter type arctic type (mountains/cold areas). If refuelling with diesel fuel not suitable for the current temperature, mix diesel fuel with TUTELA DIESEL ART additive in the proportions stated on the can, putting first the antifreeze in the tank and then the diesel fuel. If driving or parking the vehicle for a long period in cold areas/mountains, refuel with the diesel fuel available at local filling stations. In this situation you are also recommended to have in the tank an amount of fuel 50% higher than usable capacity. SAFETY DEVICES DIESEL ENGINES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR IMPORTANT Refuelling shall always be performed with engine off. Failing to observe this precaution could cause the gauge to provide wrong indications. Should this occur, to restore proper indication just have next refuelling with the engine off. Otherwise contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. PETROL ENGINES WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES AT THE FILLING STATION DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 125 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:09 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 125 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 126 3-12-2009 14:09 Pagina 126 The car must only be filled with diesel fuel for motor vehicles, in compliance with European Standard EN590. The use of other products or mixtures may irreparably damage the engine with invalidation of the warranty due to the damage caused. In the event of accidentally filling with another type of fuel, do not start the engine and empty the tank. If the engine has been run even for only a very short time, in addition to the tank, it is also necessary to drain out the whole fuel circuit. REFUELLING To guarantee full tank filling, carry out two refuelling operations after the first click of the fuel delivery gun. Avoid further topping up operations that could cause damages to the fuel system. FUEL FILLER CAP The fuel filler cap is unlocked when central door locking is off and it is automatically locked when activating the central door locking. Opening Open the flap A-fig. 109 by means of front part (see figure), turn cap B anti-clockwise and extract it. The cap has a device C retaining it to the flap so it cannot be lost. When refuelling, attach the cap to the flap, as illustrated. Closing Fit cap B in its housing and turn it clockwise until it clicks once or more, then close the flap A. When refuelling, position the cap on the device inside the flap as shown in the figure. A C fig. 109 B A0E0799m IMPORTANT The sealing of the tank may cause light pressurising in the tank. A little breathing off, while slackening the cap, is absolutely normal. fig. 110 A0E0130m EMERGENCY OPENING OF THE FUEL FILLER CAP In case of failure, the fuel filler cap can be opened by pulling string set on the right side of the boot fig. 110. ❒ Lambda sensor; ❒ fuel evaporation system. In addition, do not let the engine run, even for a test, with one or more spark plugs disconnected. The devices for curtailing diesel fuel engine emissions are the following: ❒ oxidising catalytic converter; ❒ exhaust gas recirculation system (E.G.R.); ❒ diesel particulate filter (DPF) (where required). SAFETY DEVICES ❒ three-way catalytic converter; CORRECT USE OF THE CAR The devices for curtailing petrol engine emissions are the following: WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES PROTECTING THE ENVIRONMENT WARNING Do not put naked flames or lighted cigarettes near the fuel filler hole as there is danger of fire. Do not bend too close to the hole either so as not to breathe in harmful vapours. DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 127 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:09 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 127 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 083-128 Alfa 159 GB 128 3-12-2009 14:09 Pagina 128 WARNING During normal service the diesel particulate filter (DPF) (where required) reaches high temperatures. Do not therefore park the car over inflammable materials (grass, dry leaves, pine needles, etc.): fire hazard. DIESEL PARTICULATE FILTER (DPF) (where required) The Diesel Particulate Filter is a mechanical filter, integral with the exhaust system, that physically traps particulate present in the exhaust gases of Diesel engines. The diesel particular filter has been adopted to eliminate almost totally particulates in compliance with current / future law regulations. During normal use of the car, the engine control unit records a set of data (e.g.: travel time, type of route, temperatures, etc.) and it will then calculate how much particulates has been trapped by the filter. Since this filter physically traps particulates, it shall be cleaned (reclaimed) at regular intervals by burning carbon particles. Reclaiming procedure is controlled automatically by the engine control unit according to the filter conditions and the conditions of use of the car. During reclaiming the following phenomena could take place: idling slight increase, fan activation, slight smoke increase, high exhaust temperatures. These situations shall not be considered as faults and they do not affect car performance and environment. SEAT BELTS ...................................................... 130 S.B.R. SYSTEM ................................................ 131 PRETENSIONERS ............................................... 132 SAFETY DEVICES SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 129 PRESETTING FOR MOUNTING THE “UNIVERSAL ISOFIX”CHILD RESTRAINT SYSTEM..... 140 CORRECT USE OF THE CAR CARRYING CHILDREN SAFELY .............................. 135 SIDE AIR BAGS (Side bag - Window bag) ............. 145 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES FRONT AIR BAGS............................................... 142 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:50 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 129-148 Alfa 159 GB 129 8-04-2009 10:50 Pagina 130 SEAT BELTS SAFETY DEVICES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR To fasten seat belts, take the tongue A-fig. 1 and insert it into the buckle B, until hearing the locking click. At removal, if it jams, let it rewind for a short stretch, then pull it out again without jerking. To unfasten the seat belts, press button C. Guide the seat belt with your hand while it is rewinding, to prevent it from twisting. INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE The belt should be worn keeping the chest straight and rested against the seat back. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES USING THE SEAT BELTS IN AN EMERGENCY DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 129-148 Alfa 159 GB 130 A0E0083m fig. 1 WARNING Never press button C when travelling. Through the reel, the belt automatically adapts to the body of the passenger wearing it, allowing freedom of movement. When the car is parked on a steep slope the reel mechanism may block; this is normal. The reel mechanism prevents the webbing coming out when it is jerked or if the car brakes sharply, in a collision or when cornering at high speed. fig. 2 A0E0055m The rear seat is fitted with inertial seat belts with three anchor points and reel for side and central seats. Rear seat belts shall be worn as shown in the figure fig. 2. A0E0085m IMPORTANT On certain versions, correct backrest fastening is guaranteed when the “red band” A-fig. 3 aside levers B is no longer visible. The “red band” actually indicates that the backrest is not properly secured. IMPORTANT After putting the seats back to their travelling position, restore the seat belt position to make them ready for use. WARNING Make sure the backrest is properly secured at both sides (red band A-fig. 3 not visible) to prevent it moves forward in the event of sharp braking causing injuries to passengers. The buzzer can be muted temporarily by the following procedure: ❒ fasten the front seat belts; ❒ fit the electronic key into the ignition device; ❒ wait for over 20 seconds but less than 1 minute and then unfasten one of the front seat belts. This procedure will stand valid till next engine switching off. For permanent deactivation, contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. The S.B.R. system can only be reset through the setup menu (see paragraph “Reconfigurable multifunction display“ in section “Dashboard and controls”). SAFETY DEVICES The car is fitted with the S.B.R. system (Seat Belt Reminder), consisting of a buzzer which, together with the turning on of warning light <, warns the driver and the front passenger to fasten the seat belt. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR fig. 3 S.B.R. SYSTEM (Seat Belt Reminder) WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES WARNING Remember that in the event of a violent collision, back seat passengers not wearing seat belts also represent a serious danger for the front seat passengers. DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 131 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:50 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 129-148 Alfa 159 GB 131 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 129-148 Alfa 159 GB 132 8-04-2009 10:50 Pagina 132 PRETENSIONERS To increase the efficiency of the seat belts, the car is fitted with front pretensioners. These devices, in the event of a violent crash, rewind the seat belts a few centimetres. In this way they ensure that the seat belt adheres perfectly to the wearer before the restraining action begins. Front pretensioners activation is indicated by buckle withdrawal downwards. IMPORTANT To obtain the highest degree of protection from the action of the pretensioning device, wear the seat belt keeping it firmly close to the chest and pelvis. Front seat pretensioners activate only if front seat belts are properly fitted into buckles. A small amount of smoke may be produced. This smoke is in no way toxic and presents no fire hazard. Anything that modifies its original conditions invalidates its efficiency. Anything that modifies its original conditions invalidates its efficiency. If due to unusual natural events (floods, seas storm, etc.) the device has been affected by water and mud, it must necessarily be replaced. WARNING The pretensioner can only be used once. After a collision that has triggered it, have it replaced at Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. Pretensioner validity is indicated on the label inside the glovebox. Pretensioners should be replaced at Alfa Romeo Authorized Services as this date approaches. Operations which lead to knocks, vibrations or localised heating (over 100°C for a maximum of 6 hours) in the area around the pretensioners may cause damage or trigger them. These devices are not affected by vibrations caused by irregularities of the road surface or low obstacles such as kerbs, etc. Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services for any assistance. LOAD LIMITERS To increase passenger’s safety, the front seat belt reels contain a load limiter which allows controlled sag in such a way as to dose the force acting on the chest and shoulders during the belt restraining action in case of front crash. A0E0104m GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS FOR USING THE SEAT BELTS The driver must comply with (and have the vehicle occupants follow) all the local legal regulations concerning the use of seat belts. Always fasten the seat belts before starting. Seat belts are also to be worn by expectant mothers: the risk of injury in the case of accident is greatly reduced for them and the unborn child if they are wearing a seat belt. Of course they must position the lower part of the belt very low down so that it passes under the abdomen fig. 5. fig. 6 A0E0103m IMPORTANT The belt should not be twisted. The upper part should pass over the shoulder and cross the chest diagonally. The lower part should adhere to the pelvis fig. 6 and not the abdomen of the passenger. Do not use any objects (pegs, stoppers, etc.) to keep the belts away from the body. SAFETY DEVICES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR fig. 5 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES WARNING For maximum protection keep the back of your seat upright, lean back into it and make sure the seat belt fits closely across your chest and hips. Make sure that the seat belts of the front and rear passengers are fastened at all times! You increase the risk of serious injury or death in a collision if you travel with the belts unfastened. DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 133 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:50 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 129-148 Alfa 159 GB 133 129-148 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:50 Pagina 134 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS WARNING 134 fig. 7 A0E0105m IMPORTANT Never travel with a child sitting on the passenger’s lap with a single belt to protect them both fig. 7. Do not fasten other objects to the body. Under no circumstances should the components of the seat belts and pretensioners be tampered with or removed. Any operation should be carried out by qualified and authorised personnel. Always contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. WARNING If the belt has been subjected to heavy stress, for example after an accident, it should be changed completely together with the anchors, anchor fastening screws and the pretensioners. In fact, even if the belt has no visible defects, it could have lost its resilience. HOW TO KEEP THE SEAT BELTS ALWAYS IN EFFICIENT CONDITIONS ❒ Always use the belt with the tape taut and never twisted; make sure that it is free to run without impediments; ❒ after a serious accident, replace the belt being worn at that time, even if it does not appear damaged. Always replace the seat belts if pretensioners have been activated; ❒ to clean the belts, wash by hand with neutral soap, rinse and leave to dry in the shade. Never use strong detergents, bleach or dyes or other chemical substance that might weaken the fibres; ❒ prevent the reels from getting wet: their correct operation is only guaranteed if water does not get inside; ❒ replace the seat belt when showing significant wear or cut signs. This prescription is compulsory in all EC countries according to EC Directive 2003/20/EC. Compared with adults, a child’s head is proportionately larger and heavier than the rest of the body, while muscles and bone structure are not completely developed. Therefore, in order to restraint them correctly in the event of a crash, different systems are needed than adult seat belts. Group 0 - 0-10 kg in weight SAFETY DEVICES Lineaccessori Alfa Romeo offers seats for each weight group, which are the recommended choice, as they have been designed and experimented specifically for Alfa Romeo cars. Group 0+ - 0-13 kg in weight Group 1 9-18 kg in weight Group 2 15-25 kg in weight Group 3 22-36 kg in weight As it may be noted, the groups overlap partly and in fact, in commerce it is possible to find devices that cover more than one weight group. All restraint devices must bear the certification data, together with the control brand, on a solidly fixed label which must absolutely never be removed. Over 1.50 m in height, from the point of view of restraint systems, children are considered as adults and wear the seat belts normally. WARNING With passenger’s air bag active, never place child’s seats with the cradle facing backwards since the air bag activation could cause to the child serious injuries, even mortal, regardless of the seriousness of the crash that triggered it. You are advised to carry children always with proper restraint systems on the rear seats, as this is the most protected position in the case of a crash. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR For optimal protection in the event of a crash, all passengers must be seated and wearing adequate restraint systems. This is even more important for children. The results of research on the best child restraint systems are contained in the European Standard ECE-R44. This Standard enforces the use of restraint systems classified in five groups: WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CARRYING CHILDREN SAFELY DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 135 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:50 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 129-148 Alfa 159 GB 135 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 129-148 Alfa 159 GB 136 8-04-2009 10:50 Pagina 136 WARNING SERIOUS DANGER If it is absolutely necessary to carry a child on the front passenger seat with the cradle child’s seat facing backwards, the front passenger’s air bags (front air bag, knees air bag, for versions/markets, where provided, and side bag on seat), must be deactivated using the key switch. In this case it is absolutely necessary to check the warning light F on the front ceiling light panel (see paragraph “Passenger’s front air bag”) to make sure that deactivation has actually taken place. Moreover, the front passenger’s seat shall be adjusted in the most backward position to prevent any contact between the child’s seat and the dashboard. fig. 8 A0E0106m A0E0106m fig. 9 GROUP 0 and 0+ GROUP 1 Babies up to 13 kg must be carried facing backwards fig. 8 on a cradle seat, which, supporting the head, does not induce stress on the neck in the event of sharp deceleration. Starting from 9 kg to 18 kg in weight, children may be carried facing forwards, with seat fitted with front cushion fig. 9, through which the car seat belt restrains both child and seat. The cradle is restrained by the car seat belts and in turn it must restrain the child with its own belts. WARNING The figure is only an example for mounting. Attain to the instructions for fastening which must be enclosed with the specific child restraining system you are using. Pagina 137 A0E0108m A0E0109m fig. 11 GROUP 2 GROUP 3 Starting from 15 kg to 25 kg in weight, children may be restrained directly by the car belts. The only function of the seat is to position the child correctly in relation to the belts, so that the diagonal part adheres to the chest and not to the neck and that the horizontal part clings to the child’s pelvis and not the abdomen fig. 10. For children from 22 kg to 36 kg the size of the child’s chest no longer requires a support to space the child’s back from the seat back. Fig. 11 shows proper child seat positioning on the rear seat. Children taller than 1.50 m can wear seat belts like adults. WARNING The illustrations are indicative only for assembly. Assemble the seat according to the compulsory instructions provided with it. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES fig. 10 CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS WARNING Seats exist which are suitable for covering weight groups 0 and 1 with a rear connection to the car belts and their own belts to restrain the child. Due to their size, they can be dangerous if installed incorrectly fastened to the car belts with a cushion. Carefully follow the instructions for installation provided with the seat. IN AN EMERGENCY 10:50 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 129-148 Alfa 159 GB 137 SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 129-148 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:50 Pagina 138 PASSENGER SEAT COMPLIANCE WITH REGULATIONS ON CHILD’S SEAT USE Your car complies with the new European Directive 2000/3/EC regulating child’s seat assembling on the different car seats according to the following tables: Front and rear seat (fixed and double seat) INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SEAT 138 Group Range of weight Front Rear Seat with 6 positions Seat with 8 positions Rear seat side up to 13 kg U (*) U (*) U U Group 1 9-18 kg U (*) U (*) U U Group 2 15-25 kg U (*) U (*) U U Group 3 22-36 kg U (*) U (*) U U Group 0, 0+ Rear seat central Key: U = suitable for child restraint systems of the “Universal” category, according to European Standard EEC-R44 for the specified “Groups”. (*) = on cars not fitted with passenger’s seat adjustable in height, the seat back shall be positioned perfectly upright. On cars fitted with passenger’s seat adjustable in height, the seat shall be raised as much as possible. ❒ if the passenger’s air bag is deactivated always check that the warning light F on the front ceiling light panel is glowing steadily to indicate that the air bag has been deactivated; ❒ attain to the instructions for fastening the specific child restraint system which you are using. These instructions must be provided by the manufacturer. Keep the child restraint system installation instructions with the car documents and this Handbook. Never use a child restraint system without installation instructions; ❒ always check the seat belts do not fit around the child’s throat; ❒ while travelling, do not let the child sit incorrectly or release the belts; ❒ passengers should never carry children on their laps. No-one, however strong they are, can hold a child in the event of a crash; ❒ in case of an accident, replace the seat with a new one. SAFETY DEVICES ❒ only one child is to be strapped to each retaining system; WARNING With passenger’s air bag active, never place child’s seats with the cradle facing backwards since the air bag activation could cause to the child serious injuries, even mortal, regardless of the seriousness of the crash that triggered it. You are advised to carry children always with proper restraint systems on the rear seats, as this is the most protected position in the case of a crash. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR ❒ the recommended position for installing child’s seat is on the rear seat, as it is the most protected in the case of a crash; ❒ always check the seat belt is well fastened by pulling the webbing; WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES Below is a summary of the rules of safety to be followed for carrying children: DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 139 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:50 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 129-148 Alfa 159 GB 139 8-04-2009 10:50 Pagina 140 CORRECT USE OF THE CAR Fig. 11/a shows an example of child restraint system. The Universal Isofix child’s seat covers weight group: 1. Due to its different anchoring system, the Universal Isofix child's seat shall be anchored to the proper lower metal rings A-fig.12, set between rear seat back and cushion. The upper belt (provided with the child's seat) shall be then secured to fasteners B-fig.13 set behind head restraints. INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE This car is preset for mounting the Universal Isofix child restraint system, a new European standardised system for carrying children safely. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES PRESETTING FOR MOUNTING THE “UNIVERSAL ISOFIX” CHILD RESTRAINT SYSTEM IN AN EMERGENCY SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 129-148 Alfa 159 GB 140 It is possible to mount at the same time both the traditional restraint system and the “Universal Isofix” one. Remember that in case of Universal Isofix child’s seat, you can only use all those seats approved with the marking ECE R44/03 “Universal Isofix”. fig. 11/a A0E0241m At Lineaccessori Alfa Romeo is available the “Universal Isofix” “Duo Plus” child’s seat shown in. For any further installation/use detail, refer to the “Instructions Manual” that must be provided by the child restraint system Manufacturer. fig. 12 A0E0174m fig. 13 A0E0190m WARNING Mount the child restraint system only with the car stationary. The Isofix child restraint system is properly anchored to the mounting brackets when clicks are heard. In any case, keep to the installation instructions that must be provided by the child restraint system Manufacturer. 8-04-2009 10:50 Pagina 141 PASSENGER SEAT COMPLIANCE WITH REGULATIONS ON UNIVERSALS ISOFIX CHILD’S SEAT USE Group 0 - 0 to 10 kg Facing backwards E IL Facing backwards E IL Facing backwards D IL Facing backwards C IL Facing backwards D IL Facing backwards C IL Facing forwards B IUF Facing forwards BI IUF Facing forwards A IUF Group 0+ - 0 to 13 kg Group I - 9 to 18 kg IUF: suitable for Isofix child restraint systems to be set facing forwards, universal class (fitted with third upper fastener), approved for the weight group. IL: suitable for Isofix Type child restraint systems, specific and approved for this type of car. The child's seat can be installed by moving forward the front seat WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES Isofix position side rear IN AN EMERGENCY Isofix size group TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE Child’s seat direction INDEX Range of weight CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES The table below, according to ECE 16 European Directive, shows the different installation possibilities of Isofix restraint systems on seats fitted with Universals Isofix fasteners. DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 129-148 Alfa 159 GB 141 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 129-148 Alfa 159 GB 142 8-04-2009 10:50 Pagina 142 FRONT AIR BAGS The car is fitted with front multistage air bags (“Smart bags”) for the driver and the passenger and with knees air bag for the driver and for the passenger (for versions/markets, where provided). “SMART BAG” SYSTEM (FRONT MULTISTAGE AIR BAGS) The front air bags (driver and passenger) and knees air bags (driver and passenger) have been designed to protect the occupants in the event of head-on crashes of medium-high severity, by placing cushions between the occupant and the steering wheel or dashboard. In case of crash, an electronic control unit, when required, triggers the inflation of the cushions that inflate, as a protection, between the body of the front occupants and the structure that could cause injuries. Immediately after, the cushions deflate. The front air bags (driver and passenger) and knees air bags (driver and passenger) are not a replacement of but complementary to the use of belts, which should always be worn, as specified by law in Europe and most non European countries. In case of crash, a person not wearing the seat belt moves forward and may come into contact with the cushion while it is still inflating. Under this circumstance the protection offered by the air bag is reduced. Front air bags may not be activated in the following situations: ❒ front collisions against highly deformable objects not affecting the car front surface (e.g. bumper collision against guard rail, etc.); ❒ in case of wedging under other vehicles or protective barriers (for example under a truck or guard rail); ❒ the air bag is not triggered as it offers no additional protection compared with the seat belts, consequently it would be pointless. Therefore, failure to come into action in the above circumstance does not mean that the system is not working properly. WARNING Do not apply stickers or other objects to the steering wheel or to the air bag cover on the passenger’s side or on the side roof lining. Never put objects (e.g. mobile phones) on the dashboard on passenger side since they could interfere with proper passenger air bag inflation and also cause serious injury. A0E0077m DRIVER’S FRONT AIR BAG It consists of an instant-inflating cushion contained in a special recess in the centre of the steering wheel fig. 14. A0E0078m fig. 15 PASSENGER’S FRONT AIR BAG It consists of an instant-inflating cushion contained into a special recess in the dashboard fig. 15, this cushion has a volume bigger than that of the driver. WARNING With passenger’s air bag active, never place child’s seats with the cradle facing backwards since the air bag activation could cause to the child serious injuries, even mortal. SAFETY DEVICES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR fig. 14 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES WARNING On cars fitted with front passenger’s air bag deactivation (front air bag, knees air bag (for versions/markets, where provided) and side on seat), these air bags shall be deactivated when placing the child’s seat on the front passenger’s seat. Moreover, the front passenger’s seat shall be adjusted in the most backward position to prevent any contact between the child’s seat and the dashboard. Even if not compulsory by law, you are recommended to reactivate the air bag immediately as soon as the child transport is no longer necessary. DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 143 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:51 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 129-148 Alfa 159 GB 143 8-04-2009 10:51 Pagina 144 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 129-148 Alfa 159 GB 144 fig. 16 A0E0079m DRIVER’S AND PASSENGER’S KNEES AIR BAG (for versions/markets, where provided) Knees air bag consists of an instant-inflating cushion housed into a special compartment provided for the purpose under the steering wheel for the driver fig. 16 and into the lower part of the dashboard for the passenger fig. 17, to give further protection in the event of frontal crash. fig. 17 A0E0092m fig. 18 A0E0062m MANUAL DEACTIVATION (for versions/markets, where provided) OF PASSENGER’S FRONT AIR BAG , KNEES AIR BAG (for versions/markets, where provided) AND PASSENGER’S FRONT SIDE BAG Should it be absolutely necessary to carry a child on the front seat, the passenger’s front air bag, knees air bag (for versions/markets, where provided) and the side bag can be deactivated. Deactivation/activation shall be performed (with key removed from ignition device) using the key switch set on the right side of dashboard fig. 18. You can reach the switch only if the door is opened. When the door is open, the metal insert of the key can be inserted and removed in both positions. IMPORTANT Operate the switch only when the engine is not running and the ignition key is removed. The key-operated switch has two positions: ❒ passenger's front air bag and knees air bag (for versions/markets, where provided) and side bag activated (ON position P): warning light F on front ceiling light panel off; it is absolutely prohibited to carry a child on the front seat; Pagina 145 Passenger's air bags deactivation will not inhibit the operation of the head protection side bag (Window Bag). DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS SAFETY DEVICES The car is fitted with front side bags for driver and passenger for protecting the chest and window bags for protecting front and rear occupant’s head. fig. 19 A0E0093m Side bags protect car occupants from side crashes of medium-high severity, by placing the cushion between the occupant and the internal parts of the side structure of the car. Side air bags are not a replacement of but complementary to the belts, which you are recommended to always wear, as specified by law in Europe and most non-European countries. Non-activation of side bags in other types of collisions (front collisions, rear shunts, roll-overs, etc...) is not a system malfunction. FRONT SIDE BAGS CHEST AND PELVIS ZONE PROTECTION In case of side crash, an electronic control unit, when required triggers the inflation of the cushion. The cushion immediately inflates, placing itself as a protection, between the occupant’s body and the structure that could cause injuries. Immediately after, the cushion deflates. They are composed by two types of instant inflation cushions and are housed in the back rest of the front seats fig. 19. The task of the side air bags is to increase protection of the occupants’ chest and pelvis zone in the event of a side crash of medium-high severity. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR The warning light F on front ceiling light panel stays on permanently until the passenger’s air bags are reactivated. SIDE AIR BAGS (Side bag Window bag) WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES ❒ passenger's front air bag and knees air bag (for versions/markets, where provided) and side bag deactivated (OFF position F): warning light F on front ceiling light panel on; it is possible to carry a child protected by special restraint systems on the front seat. IN AN EMERGENCY 10:51 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 129-148 Alfa 159 GB 145 129-148 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:51 Pagina 146 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS IMPORTANT In the event of side crash, you can obtain the best protection by the system keeping a correct position on the seat, allowing thus a correct window bag unfolding. 146 fig. 20 A0E0185m SIDE WINDOW BAGS HEAD PROTECTION They are “curtain” cushions located behind the side coverings of the roof fig. 20 and covered by proper finishing. Window bags have been designed for protecting the head of front and rear occupants in the event of side crash, thanks to the wide cushion inflation surface. In minor side crashes (for which the restraining action of the seat belts is sufficient), the air bags are not deployed. Also in this case it is of vital importance to wear the seat belts since in case of side crash they guarantee proper positioning of the occupant and prevent the occupants to be pitched out of the car in case of violent crashes. IMPORTANT The front air bags and/or side bags may be deployed if the car is subject to heavy knocks or accidents involving the underbody area, such as for example violent shocks, against steps, kerbs or low obstacles, falling of the car in big holes or sags in the road. IMPORTANT When the airbag inflates it emits a small amount of dusts. These dusts are harmless and is not the beginning of a fire; then the unfold cushion surface and the car interiors can be covered by a dusty remains: this dust can irritate skin and eyes. In case of contact, wash yourself using neutral soap and water. Expiration dates of pyrotechnic charge and coil contact are indicated on the label inside the glovebox. As this date approaches, contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services to have the device replaced. IMPORTANT Should an accident occur in which any of the safety devices is activated, take the car to Alfa Romeo Authorized Services to have the devices activated replaced and to have the system checked. All control, repair and replacement operations concerning the air bags must only be carried out c/o Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. If you are having the car scrapped, have the air bag system deactivated at Alfa Romeo Authorized Services first. If the car changes ownership, the new owner must be informed of the method of use of air bags and the above warnings and also be given this “Owner’s Manual”. Never rest head, arms and elbows on the door, on the windows and in the window bag unfolding area to prevent possible injuries during the inflation phase. If when fitting the key into the ignition device, the warning light ¬ does not turn on or if it stays on when travelling (on certain versions together with the message on the display) there could be a failure in safety systems; in this event air bags or pretensioners could not trigger in case of impact or, in a minor number of cases, they could trigger accidentally. Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services immediately to have the system checked. WARNING Never lean head, arms and elbows out of the window. WARNING Always keep your hands on the steering wheel rim when driving, so that if the air bag is triggered, it can inflate without meeting any obstacles which could cause serious harm to you. Do not drive with the body bent forwards, keep the seat back rest in the erect position and lean your back well against it. WARNING Do not cover the backrest of front seats with trims or covers that are not suitable to be used with side bags. WARNING If the car has been stolen or an attempt to steal it has been made, if it has been subjected to vandals or floods, have the air bag system checked by Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. SAFETY DEVICES WARNING WARNING Never travel with objects on your lap, in front of your chest or with a pipe, pencil, etc. between your lips; injury may result in the event of the air bag being triggered. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR WARNING GENERAL WARNINGS WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES IMPORTANT The triggering of pretensioners, front air bags and side bags is decided in a differentiated manner according to the type of impact. The failure to deploy one or more of them does not mean that the system is not working properly. DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 147 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:51 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 129-148 Alfa 159 GB 147 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 129-148 Alfa 159 GB 148 8-04-2009 10:51 Pagina 148 WARNING Remember that with the key fitted into the ignition device and engine off, the air bags may be triggered on a stationary car if it is bumped by another moving car. Therefore, never seat children on the front seat even when the car is stationary. On the other hand remember that if the key is not fitted into the ignition device, no safety system (air bags or pretensioners) is triggered in the event of an impact; in this case, failure to come into action cannot be considered as a sign that the system is not working properly. WARNING When the key is fitted into the ignition device, the warning light F (with passenger’s front air bags deactivation switch at ON) turns on and flashes for few seconds to remind that passenger’s front air bag, knees air bag and side bag will be deployed in a crash, after which it should go off. WARNING Never wash seat backrests with pressurised water or steam (by hand or at automatic seat washing stations). WARNING The front air bag is triggered for shocks greater in magnitude than the pretensioners. For impacts between these two thresholds, it is therefore normal that only the pretensioners are triggered. WARNING Do not hook rigid objects to the coat hooks and to the support handles. WARNING The air bag does not substitute the seat belts, but only increases their effectiveness. Moreover, since the front air bags do not come into operation in the event of front impact at low speed, side collisions, bumps from behind or overturning, in these circumstances the occupants would only be protected by the seat belts which must therefore always be fastened. PARKING.......................................................... 155 USING THE GEARBOX......................................... 156 CONTAINING RUNNING COSTS............................. 157 TOWING TRAILERS............................................. 159 SNOW TYRES ................................................... 162 SNOW CHAINS ................................................. 163 CAR INACTIVITY ............................................... 164 SAFETY DEVICES ENGINE STARTING ............................................. 150 WARNING CORRECT USE LIGHTS AND OF THE CAR MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 149 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:51 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 149-164 Alfa 159 GB 149 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND CORRECT USE MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 149-164 Alfa 159 GB 150 8-04-2009 10:51 Pagina 150 ENGINE STARTING The car is fitted with an electronic engine immobilising system. If the engine fails to start, see paragraph “Alfa Romeo CODE system” in section “Dashboard and controls”. IMPORTANT Tampering with the ignition device can cause unrequired steering lock. IMPORTANT Fit completely the electronic key into the ignition device until it locks into place. IMPORTANT Never take the electronic key out of the ignition device while the car is moving unless you have to carry out an emergency removal (see paragraph “Removing the electronic key from the ignition device in an emergency”), this ensures that the steering column lock is deactivated while the car is moving (e.g.: towing the car). We recommend that during the initial period you do not drive to full car performance (e.g.: excessive acceleration, long journeys at top speed, sharp braking, etc.). When the engine is switched off never leave the electronic key into the ignition device to prevent pointless current absorption from draining the batter. WARNING Running the engine in confined areas is extremely dangerous. The engine consumes oxygen and produces carbon monoxide which is a highly toxic and lethal gas. STARTING PROCEDURE FOR DIESEL VERSIONS Proceed as follows: With engine off and electronic key inserted in the ignition device, it is possible to operate the automatic ignition briefly pressing the START/STOP button and keeping the clutch pedal pressed. Proceed as follows: IMPORTANT It is possible to start the engine keeping pressed only the brake pedal. In that case, automatic start is not enabled. Then press the START/STOP button and release it as soon as the engine starts. ❒ Put the gear lever neutral; ❒ Ensure that the handbrake is up; ❒ Fully press the clutch pedal, without pressing the accelerator; ❒ Put the gear lever neutral; ❒ Fit the electronic key into the ignition device to stop limit; ❒ Briefly press the START/STOP button. ❒ Ensure that the handbrake is up; ❒ Fully press the clutch pedal, without pressing the accelerator; ❒ fit the electronic key down into the ignition device until it stops. The instrument panel warning light m will turn on; ❒ Wait for the warning light m to turn off. The hotter the engine is, the quicker this will happen; ❒ Briefly press the START/STOP button as soon as the warning light m turns on. Waiting for too long means making spark plugs heating useless. SAFETY DEVICES The starter automatically operates until the engine starts. WARNING CORRECT USE LIGHTS AND OF THE CAR MESSAGES STARTING PROCEDURE FOR PETROL VERSIONS DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 151 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:51 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 149-164 Alfa 159 GB 151 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND CORRECT USE MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 149-164 Alfa 159 GB 152 8-04-2009 10:51 Pagina 152 The starter automatically operates until the engine starts. With engine off and electronic key inserted in the ignition device, it is possible to operate the automatic ignition briefly pressing the START/STOP button and keeping the clutch pedal pressed. In the event of cold weather, we recommend to wait for warning light m turn off before operating the starter. IMPORTANT It is possible to start the engine keeping pressed only the brake pedal. In that case, automatic start is not enabled. Then press the START/STOP button and release it as soon as the engine starts. IMPORTANT If at start-up the engine turns off, restart it by pressing the clutch or brake pedal and then press button START/STOP. If after a few attempts the engine does not start, do not insist but contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. With car started the electronic key is locked into the ignition device and it can be removed only after switching the engine off. With car running and key locked into the ignition device, forced key removal could damage the ignition device. Start-up failures, if any, are indicated by the turning on of the warning light Y on the instrument panel (on certain versions a dedicated message is displayed). In this case contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. If the engine will not start after pressing button START/STOP, repeat the start-up procedure by pressing the other pedal (clutch or brake). In the event of failure, the electronic key can be removed from the ignition device to enable the driver to carry out the following operations: ❒ turn the instrument panel off by pressing button START/STOP or removing the electronic key from the ignition device; ❒ start the engine again by pressing the clutch/brake pedal and button START/STOP. IMPORTANT In the event of engine locking while the car is running, due to safety reasons it will not be possible to take the electronic key out of the ignition device. To remove it, press button START/STOP with brake pedal (or clutch pedal) released and car stopped. Proceed as follows: ❒ Drive off slowly, letting the engine turn at medium revs. Do not accelerate abruptly; ❒ Do not drive at full performance for the initial kilometres. Wait until the coolant temperature gauge starts moving. STOPPING THE ENGINE With car stopped press button START/ STOP. When the engine is off it will be possible to remove the electronic key from the ignition device. WARNING In an emergency, and for safety reasons the engine can be turned off when the car is running by pressing repeatedly (3 times within 2 seconds) or by keeping pressed button START/STOP for a few seconds. In this case the steering lock cannot be engaged. IMPORTANT After a taxing drive, you should allow the engine to “catch its breath” before turning it off by letting it idle to allow the temperature in the engine compartment to fall. SAFETY DEVICES The system can recognise start-up failures. HOW TO WARM UP THE ENGINE AFTER IT HAS JUST STARTED (petrol and diesel engines) WARNING CORRECT USE LIGHTS AND OF THE CAR MESSAGES Start-up failures DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 153 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:51 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 149-164 Alfa 159 GB 153 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND CORRECT USE MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 149-164 Alfa 159 GB 154 8-04-2009 10:51 Pagina 154 IMPORTANT Turning the car off will deactivate the electronic safety systems and turn off the external lights. REMOVING THE ELECTRONIC KEY FROM THE IGNITION DEVICE IN AN EMERGENCY IMPORTANT In the event of engine locking while the car is running, due to safety reasons it will not be possible to take the electronic key out of the ignition device. To remove it, turn the instrument panel on and off by pressing button START/STOP with brake pedal (and clutch pedal) released and car stopped. In the event of a failure at engine switching off system or at electronic key unlocking system proceed as follows: A quick burst on the accelerator before turning off the engine serves absolutely no practical purpose, it wastes fuel and is damaging especially to turbocharged engines. ❒ press the unlocking button to remove the metal insert (see paragraph “Electronic key” in section “Dashboard and controls”); ❒ fit the metal insert B-fig. 1 of the electronic key into the slot A; ❒ remove the electronic key from the ignition device. fig. 1 A0E0043m IMPORTANT Only fit the metal insert B of the electronic key into slot A-fig.1. IMPORTANT Stop the car before emergency removal of the key, since removing the key with the engine running will turn both the engine and the instrument panel off and the steering lock will not be engaged. Proceed as follows: ❒ Slightly lift the handbrake A and press release button B; ❒ Stop the engine and engage the handbrake; ❒ Engage a gear (on a slope, engage first gear if the car is faced uphill or reverse if it is faced downhill) and leave the wheels steered. Block the wheels with a wedge or a stone if the car is parked on a steep slope. Do not leave the electronic key in the ignition switch to prevent draining the battery. WARNING Never leave children unattended in the car. Always remove the electronic key from the ignition device when leaving the car and take it out with you. ❒ Keep button B pressed and lower the lever. Warning light x on the instrument panel will turn off. fig. 2 A0E0030m HANDBRAKE The handbrake lever A-fig. 2 is located between the two front seats. Pull the handbrake lever A upwards, until the car cannot be moved. With electronic key fitted into the ignition device, the instrument panel warning light x will come on. IMPORTANT The car shall stop after a few clicks of the handbrake lever. If this is not the case, contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services to have the handbrake adjusted. Press the brake pedal when carrying out this operation to prevent the car from moving accidentally. SAFETY DEVICES To release the handbrake proceed as follows: WARNING CORRECT USE LIGHTS AND OF THE CAR MESSAGES PARKING THE CAR DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 155 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:51 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 149-164 Alfa 159 GB 155 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND CORRECT USE MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 149-164 Alfa 159 GB 156 8-04-2009 10:51 Pagina 156 USING THE GEARBOX WARNING The car can be fitted with 6-gear or 5-gear manual gearbox (1.8 140 HP version). Gear positions are shown on the gearshift lever knob. Always press down the clutch pedal when shifting gears. To engage the 6th gear, move the gearshift lever pressing slightly rightwards to prevent engaging the 4th gear accidentally. To engage reverse R from neutral, raise ring A-fig. 3 or A-fig. 4 under the knob and at the same time move the gearshift lever leftwards and then forward. After engaging reverse release the ring. To shift from reverse to another gear it is not necessary to raise the ring. fig. 3 fig. 4 A0E0397m A0E0151m IMPORTANT The car can only be put into reverse gear when it has stopped moving completely. With the engine running, before engaging the reverse, wait at least 3 seconds with the clutch pedal fully down to prevent damage and grating of the gears. To change gears properly you must push the clutch pedal fully down. It is therefore essential that there is nothing under the pedals: make sure mats are lying flat and do not get in the way of the pedals. Do not drive with your hand resting on the gear lever as the force exerted, even if slight, could lead over time to premature wear on the gearbox internal components. The clutch pedal must be used for gear shift only. Never drive with the foot resting, even if slightly, on the clutch pedal. For versions/markets where applicable the clutch pedal control electronics can intervene interpreting the wrong drive style as a fault. Climate control Do not travel with too much luggage stowed in the boot. The weight of the car (especially when driving in town) and its trim greatly affects consumption and stability. The air conditioner is an additional load which greatly affects the engine leading to higher consumption. When the temperature outside the car permits it, use the air vents where possible. Roof rack/ski rack Spoilers Have checks and adjustments carried out in accordance with the “Service schedule”. Remove the roof rack or the ski rack from the roof as soon as they are no longer used. These accessories lower air penetration and adversely affect consumption levels. When needing to carry particularly voluminous objects, preferably use a trailer. The use of aerodynamic optional extras which are not certified for the specific use on the vehicle, may reduce the aerodynamic penetration of the vehicle and increase consumption. Tyres Electric devices Check the pressure of the tyres routinely at an interval of no more than 4 weeks: if the pressure is too low, consumption levels increase as resistance to rolling is higher. Use electric devices only for the amount of time needed. Rear heated window, additional headlights, windscreen wipers and heater fan need a considerable amount of energy, therefore increasing the requirement of current increases fuel consumption (up to +25% in the urban cycle). Here are some suggestions which may help you to keep the running costs of your car down and lower the amount of toxic emissions released into the atmosphere. GENERAL CONSIDERATIONS Car maintenance SAFETY DEVICES Unnecessary loads WARNING CORRECT USE LIGHTS AND OF THE CAR MESSAGES CONTAINING RUNNING COSTS DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 157 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:51 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 149-164 Alfa 159 GB 157 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND CORRECT USE MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 149-164 Alfa 159 GB 158 8-04-2009 10:51 Pagina 158 DRIVING STYLE Starting Do not warm the engine with the car at a standstill or at idle or high speed: under these conditions the engine warms up much more slowly, increasing electrical consumption and emissions. It is therefore advisable to move off immediately, slowly, avoiding high speeds. This way the engine will warm faster. Unnecessary actions Avoid accelerating when waiting at traffic lights or before switching off the engine. This and also double declutching is absolutely pointless on modern cars and also increase consumption and pollution. Gear selection CONDITIONS OF USE As soon as the conditions of the traffic and road allow, use a higher gear. Using a low gear to obtain brilliant performance increases consumption. In the same way improper use of a high gear increases consumption, emissions an engine wear. Cold starting Top speed Fuel consumption considerably increases with speed. Avoid superfluous braking and accelerating, which cost in terms of both fuel and emissions. Acceleration Accelerating violently increasing the revs will greatly affect consumption and emissions: acceleration should be gradual and should not exceed the maximum torque. Short journeys and frequent cold starts do not allow the engine to reach optimum operating temperature. This results in a significant increase in consumption levels (from +15 to +30% on the urban cycle) and emission of harmful substances. Traffic and road conditions Rather high consumption levels are tied to situations with heavy traffic, for example in queues with frequent use of the lower gears or in cities with many traffic lights. Also winding mountain roads and rough road surfaces adversely affect consumption. Traffic hold-ups During prolonged hold-ups (e.g.: level crossings) the engine should be switched off. For towing caravans or trailers the car must be fitted with a certified tow hook and an adequate electric system. Installation should be carried out by specialised personnel who release a special document for circulation on the road. Install any specific and/or additional rear-view mirrors as specified by law. Remember that when towing a trailer, steep hills are harder to climb, the braking spaces increase and overtaking takes longer depending on the overall weight. The weight the trailer exerts on the car tow hook reduces by the same amount the actual car loading capacity. To make sure the maximum towable weight is not exceeded (given in the log book) account should be taken of the fully laden trailer, including accessories and personal belongings. Do not exceed the speed limits of the country you are driving in. In any case do not exceed 100 km/h. WARNING The ABS system with which the car may be fitted does not control the trailer braking system. Drive with extreme care on slippery roadbeds. WARNING Under no circumstances should the car brake system be altered to control the trailer brake. The trailer braking system must be fully independent of the car hydraulic system. SAFETY DEVICES IMPORTANT NOTES Engage a low gear when driving downhill, rather than constantly using the brake. WARNING CORRECT USE LIGHTS AND OF THE CAR MESSAGES TOWING TRAILERS DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 159 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:51 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 149-164 Alfa 159 GB 159 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND CORRECT USE MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 149-164 Alfa 159 GB 160 8-04-2009 10:51 Pagina 160 INSTALLING THE TOW HOOK The towing device should be fastened to the body by specialised personnel according to any additional and/or integrative information supplied by the Manufacturer of the device. The towing device must meet current regulations with reference to 94/20/EC Directive and subsequent amendments. For any version the towing device used must match the towable weight of the car on which it is to be installed. For the electric connection a unified connector should be used which is generally placed on a special bracket normally fastened to the towing device. For the electrical connection, 7 pin 12VDC connection is to be used (CUNA/UNI and ISO/DIN Standards). Follow the instructions provided by the car manufacturer and/or the tow hitch manufacturer. An electric brake or other device (electric winch, etc.), if required, should be supplied directly by the battery through a cable with a cross section of no less than 2.5 mm2. In addition to the electrical branches, the car’s electric system can only be connected to the supply cable for an electric brake and to the cable for an internal light, though not above 15W. Assembly diagram fig. 4 The structure of the tow-hook must be fixed in the indicated points with Ø with n. 2 M10 screws and n. 4 M12 screws. The fixing points (1) must be provided with Ø 25x6 mm spacers. The counter-plates (2) must have a minimum thickness of 4 mm. The counter-plates (3) must have a minimum thickness of 6 mm. IMPORTANT It is compulsory to fasten a label (plainly visible) of suitable size and material with the following wording: MAX LOAD ON BALL 75 kg After fitting, screw holes shall be sealed to prevent exhaust gas inlet. IMPORTANT The hook should be fastened to the body avoiding any type of drilling and trimming of the bumper. INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE fig. 4 SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 10:51 WARNING CORRECT USE LIGHTS AND OF THE CAR MESSAGES full load 8-04-2009 IN AN EMERGENCY Standard tow ball REAR AXLE 149-164 Alfa 159 GB Pagina 161 A0E0428m 161 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND CORRECT USE MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 149-164 Alfa 159 GB 162 8-04-2009 10:51 Pagina 162 SNOW TYRES Use snow tyres of the same size as the normal tyres provided with the car. Alfa Romeo Authorized Services will be glad to provide advice concerning the most suitable type of tyre for the customer’s requirements. For the type of tyre to be used, inflation pressures and the specifications of snow tyres, follow the instructions given in paragraph “Wheels” in section “Technical specifications”. The winter features of these tyres are reduced considerably when the tread depth is below 4 mm. In this case, they should be replaced. Due to the snow tyre features, under normal conditions of use or on long motorway journeys, the performance of these tyres is lower than that of normal tyres. It is therefore necessary to limit their use to the purposes for which they are certified. IMPORTANT When snow tyres are used with a max speed index below the one that can be reached by the car (increased by 5%), place a notice in the passenger compartment, plainly in the driver’s view which states the max permissible speed of the snow tyres (as per EC Directive). All four tyres should be the same (brand and track) to ensure greater safety when driving and braking and better driveability. Remember that it is inappropriate to change the direction of rotation of tyres. WARNING The max speed for snow tyres with “Q” marking is 160 km/h; 190 km/h for tyres with “T” marking and 210 km/h for tyres with H marking. The Road Traffic Code speed limits must however be always strictly observed. Snow chains should only be applied to the driving wheels (front wheels). Check the tension of the chains after the first few metres have been driven. Use snow chains with reduced size: for tyres 205/55 R16” and 215/55 R16” use snow chains with reduced size with max protrusion beyond the tyre profile of 9 mm. Use of snow chains may be compulsory also for cars with four-wheel drive. Also for 3.2 JTS version, snow chains shall be fitted on the FRONT axle of the car. Traditional snow chains may not be used on tyres type 225/50 R17” only spider type chains can be used. Tyres 235/45 R18” and 235/40 ZR 19” cannot be fitted with snow chains due to interference with the fender. WARNING Keep your speed down when snow chains are fitted. Do not exceed 40 km/h. Avoid potholes, steps and pavements and avoid also to drive for long distances on roads not covered with snow to prevent damaging the car and the roadbed. When snow chains are fitted, switch the ASR system off. Press the ASR/VDC button (see paragraph “ASR system” in section “Dashboard and controls”). SAFETY DEVICES Use of snow chains should be in compliance with local regulations. IMPORTANT Snow chains cannot be fitted to the space-saver spare wheel. So, if a front (drive) wheel is punctured and chains are needed, a rear wheel should be fitted to the front of the car and the spare wheel should be fitted to the rear (adjust tyre pressure to the specified value as soon as possible). This way with two normal drive wheels, snow chains can be fitted to them to solve an emergency. WARNING CORRECT USE LIGHTS AND OF THE CAR MESSAGES SNOW CHAINS DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 163 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:51 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 149-164 Alfa 159 GB 163 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND CORRECT USE MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 149-164 Alfa 159 GB 164 8-04-2009 10:51 Pagina 164 CAR INACTIVITY ❒ clean and protect the painted parts using protective wax; If the car is to be left inactive for longer than a month, the following precautions should be noted: ❒ clean and protect the shiny metal parts using special compounds readily available; ❒ park the car in covered, dry and if possible well-ventilated premises; ❒ sprinkle talcum powder on the rubber windscreen and rear window wiper blades and lift them off the glass; ❒ engage a gear; ❒ check that the handbrake is not engaged; ❒ disconnect battery negative terminal and check the battery charge. This check is to be repeated every three months when the car is left inactive. Recharge if the optical(where provided) indicator shows a dark colour without the central green area (see paragraph “Battery” in “Car maintenance” section); ❒ slightly open the windows; ❒ cover the car with a cloth or perforated plastic sheet. Do not use sheets of non-perforated plastic as they do not allow moisture on the car body to evaporate; ❒ inflate tyres to +0.5 bar above the normal specified pressure and check it at intervals; ❒ if you don’t disconnect the battery from the electric system, check its charge every month and recharge it if the optical indicator shows a dark colour without the central green area; ❒ do not drain the engine cooling system. IMPORTANT If the car is fitted with alarm system, switch off the alarm with the remote control. 166 167 167 168 168 169 169 170 170 170 171 171 171 171 172 172 173 173 174 174 175 175 VDC SYSTEM ................................................... HILL HOLDER FAILURE ....................................... ASR SYSTEM (WHEEL ANTISKID SYSTEM) ............ EXTERNAL LIGHTS FAILURE ................................. BRAKE LIGHTS FAILURE ...................................... REAR FOGLIGHTS .............................................. FRONT FOG LIGHTS ........................................... SIDE/TAILLIGHTS/FOLLOW ME HOME.................. DIPPED BEAM HEADLIGHTS................................. MAIN BEAM HEADLIGHTS ................................... LEFT-HAND DIRECTION INDICATOR ........................ RIGHT-HAND DIRECTION INDICATOR...................... LIGHT SENSOR FAILURE....................................... RAIN SENSOR FAILURE ........................................ PARKING SENSORS FAILURE................................ FUEL RESERVE – LIMITED CRUISING RANGE .......... CRUISE CONTROL ............................................. DIESEL PARTICULATE FILTER CLOGGED .................. ANTIPINCH SYSTEM FAILURE............................... WINDSCREEN WASHER FLUID LOW LEVEL ............. SPEED LIMIT EXCEEDED ..................................... T.P.M.S. SYSTEM FAILURE................................... CHECK TYRE PRESSURE...................................... LOW INFLATION PRESSURE................................. TYRE PRESSURE UNSUITABLE FOR SPEED ............ 175 176 176 176 177 177 177 177 177 177 177 177 178 178 178 178 178 178 179 179 179 179 179 180 180 SAFETY DEVICES LOW BRAKE FLUID/HANDBRAKE ON .................... BRAKE PAD WEAR ............................................. SEAT BELTS NOT FASTENED................................. AIR BAG FAILURE............................................... PASSANGER’S FRONT AIR BAGS DEACTIVATED........ ENGINE COOLANT HIGH TEMPERATURE ................. ENGINE OIL HIGH TEMPERATURE.......................... MINIMUM ENGINE OIL LEVEL .............................. LOW ENGINE OIL PRESSURE/EXHAUST OIL ........... LOW BATTERY CHARGE....................................... INCOMPLETE DOOR LOCKING .............................. BONNET OPEN.................................................. BOOT OPEN ..................................................... INJECTION SYSTEM FAILURE/ EOBD SYSTEM FAILURE...................................... CAR PROTECTION SYSTEM FAILURE/ STEERING LOCK INHIBITION ................................ ALARM FAILURE/BREAK-IN ATTEMPT ELECTRONIC KEY NOT RECOGNIZED...................... POSSIBLE PRESENCE OF ICE ON THE ROAD ........... PRE-HEATING GLOW PLUGS/ PRE-HEATING GLOW PLUG FAILURE....................... WATER IN DIESEL FUEL FILTER............................. INERTIAL FUEL CUT-OFF SWITCHED ON ................ ABS SYSTEM FAILURE........................................ EBD SYSTEM FAILURE........................................ WARNING CORRECT USE LIGHTS AND OF THE CAR MESSAGES WA R N I N G L I G H T S A N D M E S S A G E S DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 165 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:09 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 165-180 Alfa 159 GB 165 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND CORRECT USE MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 165-180 Alfa 159 GB 166 3-12-2009 14:09 Pagina 166 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES GENERAL WARNINGS Failure indications shown on the display are divided into two categories: very serious and less serious failures. Every failure indication is accompanied by the turning on of the relevant warning light (where provided) and by dedicated warning messages, if any. In certain cases, failure indications can be accompanied by the sound of a buzzer (adjustable). These indications are concise and cautionary and are aimed to suggest the prompt action the driver must adopt when a car malfunctioning appears. These indications, however, shall not be considered as exhaustive and/or as an alternative to the specifications contained in this “Owner’s Manual”, which shall always be read through carefully and thoroughly. In case of failure indication always refer to the specifications contained in this section. Very serious failures These failures are repeated on the display indefinitely and stop any previous indication on the display. These failures are repeated each time the key is fitted into the ignition device until the cause of malfunctioning is removed. To stop this “cycle” press button MENU: in this case the failure symbol stays on the display at the bottom of the screen until the cause of malfunctioning is removed. Serious failures These failures are repeated on the display for about 20 seconds and then they go off. These failures are repeated each time the key is fitted into the ignition device. At the end of the displaying cycle (approx. 20 seconds), or when pressing button MENU, the failure symbol will stay on the display at the bottom of the screen until the cause of malfunctioning is removed. x LOW BRAKE FLUID (red) HANDBRAKE ON (red) Fitting the key into the ignition device the warning light turns on, but it should go off after few seconds. Low brake fluid level The warning light turns on (on certain versions a dedicated message is displayed) when the level of the brake fluid in the reservoir falls below the minimum level, due to possible leak in the circuit. Handbrake on The warning light turns on when the handbrake is on. WARNING If the warning light turns on when travelling, check that the handbrake is not engaged. If the warning light stays on with handbrake disengaged, stop the car immediately and contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. IMPORTANT Since the car is fitted with wear sensors for the front brake pads, when changing them, check also the rear brake pads. < The warning light turns on glowing steadily when: ❒ the driver's seat belt is not fastened correctly; ❒ the passenger's seat belt is not fastened correctly, heavy objects are placed on the passenger's seat; ❒ unfastening the driver's or the passenger's seat belt. With car moving the warning light will turn on flashing together with the buzzer for a short time. The warning light will then stay on glowing steadily. The buzzer can be muted temporarily by the following procedure: ❒ fasten the front seat belts; ❒ fit the electronic key into the ignition device; ❒ wait for over 20 seconds but less than 1 minute and then unfasten one of the front seat belts. This procedure will stand valid till next engine switching off. For permanent deactivation, contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. The S.B.R. system can only be reset through the setup menu (see paragraph “Reconfigurable multifunction display“ in section “Dashboard and controls”). SAFETY DEVICES The warning light (where provided) turn on (on certain versions together with the message on the display) if the front brake pads are worn; in this case have them changed as soon as possible. SEAT BELTS NOT FASTENED (red) WARNING CORRECT USE LIGHTS AND OF THE CAR MESSAGES BRAKE PAD WEAR (amber) DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 167 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:09 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE d 3-12-2009 INDEX 165-180 Alfa 159 GB 167 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND CORRECT USE MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 165-180 Alfa 159 GB 168 ¬ 12-01-2010 13:40 Pagina 168 AIR BAG FAILURE (red) Fitting the key into the ignition device the warning light turns on, but it should go off after few seconds. The warning light stays on glowing steadily (on certain versions together with the message on the display) to indicate a failure in the air bag system. WARNING If the ¬ warning light does not turn on when fitting the key into the ignition device, or if stays on when travelling (on certain versions together with the message on the display), this could indicate a failure in safety retaining system; under this condition air bags or pretensioners could not trigger in the event of collision or, in a restricted number of cases, they could trigger accidentally. Before restarting contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. WARNING Failure of the ¬ warning light is indicated by the flashing for more than the normal 4 seconds of the passenger's front air bag deactivated warning light F. In addition, the air bag system will deactivate automatically the passenger's front air bag (front and side for versions/markets, where provided). In this event warning light ¬ could not indicate failure in safety systems. Before restarting contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services immediately to have the system checked. F PASSENGER’S FRONT AIR BAGS DEACTIVATED (amber) The warning light (set on the front ceiling light panel) turns on when passenger’s front air bags, passenger’s knees air bag (where provided) and passenger’s front side bag are deactivated through the relevant key switch (for versions/markets, where provided). With passenger's air bags active, when fitting the electronic key into the ignition device the warning light will turn on for about 4 seconds, will flash for the next 4 seconds and then it will turn off. WARNING Warning light Ffailure is indicated by warning light ¬. In addition, the air bag system will deactivate automatically the passenger's front air bag (front and side). Before restarting contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services immediately to have the system checked. The warning light turns on (on certain versions a dedicated message is displayed) to indicate engine overheating. If the warning light comes on, proceed as follows: – Normal driving conditions: stop the car, switch off the engine and check whether the water level in the reservoir is not below the MIN marl. Otherwise wait for few seconds to allow engine cooling, then open slowly and carefully the cap, top up coolant and check whether its level is falling between MIN and MAX marks in the reservoir. Check visually any leak. If when restarting the warning light comes on again, contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. IMPORTANT Under severe use of the car, keep the engine on and slightly accelerated for few minutes before switching it off. WARNING With engine hot, do not remove the cap: risk of burnt. ` ENGINE OIL HIGH TEMPERATURE Fitting the key into the ignition device, the warning light (set on engine oil temperature gauge) turns on but it should go off after a few seconds. Warning light turning on when travelling (on certain versions together with the message on the display) indicates that engine oil is too hot; switch the engine off and contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. If warning light ` starts flashing when travelling contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. SAFETY DEVICES Fitting the key into the ignition device, the warning light (set on engine coolant gauge) turns on but it shall go off after a few seconds. – Car heavy duty (e.g.: towing trailer uphill or fully laden car): decrease speed, if the warning light stays on, stop the car. Wait for 2 or 3 minutes leaving the engine on and slightly accelerated to further activate the circulation of the coolant fluid, then switch the engine off. WARNING CORRECT USE LIGHTS AND OF THE CAR MESSAGES ENGINE COOLANT HIGH TEMPERATURE (red) DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 169 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:09 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE u 3-12-2009 INDEX 165-180 Alfa 159 GB 169 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND CORRECT USE MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 165-180 Alfa 159 GB 170 k 3-12-2009 14:09 Pagina 170 MINIMUM ENGINE OIL LEVEL (RED) When the electronic key is inserted into the starting device the display will show the engine oil level for a few seconds. On some versions the display will show a message and a symbol if the engine oil level is too low. In this case, top up the engine oil to the correct level (see “Checking fluid levels” in “Car maintenance” chapter). v LIGHT STAYS ON: LOW ENGINE OIL PRESSURE (red) FLASHING LIGHT: EXHAUSTED ENGINE OIL (only Diesel versions with DPF - red) When the electronic key is inserted into the starting device, the warning light switches on and should go out as soon as the engine is started. 1. Low engine oil pressare The warning light turns on and stays on constantly (for versions/markets, where provided) along with the message on the display when the system detects that engine oil pressure is low. WARNING If the warning light v turns on when the vehicle is travelling (on certain versions together with the message on the display) stop the engine immediately and contact a Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. 2. Exhausted engine oil (only Diesel versions with DPF) The warning light will flash and a specific message will appear on the display (for versions/markets, where provided). The warning light may flash in the following ways, depending on the version: – for 1 minute every two hours; – for 3 minute cycles with the warning light off for intervals of 5 seconds until oil is changed. After the initial warning, each time the engine is started up, the warning light will continue to flash in the above mentioned modes, until the oil is changed. A specific message will appear on the display (for versions/markets, where provided) in addition to the warning light. If the warning light flashes, this does not mean that the car is defective but simply informs the driver that it is now necessary to change the oil as a result of regular vehicle use. Note that engine oil is exhausted faster under the following circumstances: – use of the vehicle prevalently for city driving, requiring more frequent regeneration of DPF – use of the vehicle for short drives, in which the engine does not have time to reach its regular operating temperature – repeated interruption of the regeneration process, signalled by the DPF warning light coming on. WARNING Exhausted engine oil should be replaced as soon as possible after the warning light comes on, never more than 500 km after the warning light first comes on. Failure to change the oil within the first 500 km may result in severe damage to the engine and will result in forfeiture of the warranty. Remember that when the warning light flashes, it does not mean that the level of engine oil is low, so if the light flashes you must not top up. w LOW BATTERY CHARGE (red) The warning light (where provided) turns on, but it should go off as soon as the engine has started (with the engine running at idle speed a brief delay in going out is allowed). If the warning light (or as an alternative, on certain versions, a symbol and a message are displayed) stays on glowing steadily or flashing contact immediately Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. S BONNET OPEN (for versions/markets, where provided) On certain versions message and symbol S (red) are displayed to indicate that bonnet is open. R BOOT OPEN On certain versions message and symbol R (red) are displayed to indicate that boot is open. U Injection system failure Fitting the key into the ignition device the warning light turns on, but it should go off when the engine has started. The warning light stays on or it turns on when travelling to indicate a malfunction in the injection/exhaust system with possible lack of performance, poor driveability and high consumption. In these conditions it is possible to continue driving without however requiring heavy effort or high speed from the engine. In any case, contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services as soon as possible. EOBD system failure (for versions/markets, where provided) Under normal conditions, fitting the electronic key into the ignition device, the warning light turns on, but it should go off when the engine has started. This indicates proper operation of the warning light. If the warning light stays on or turns on when travelling: – glowing steadily (on certain versions together with the message on the display): means a fault in the supply/ignition system which could cause high emissions at the exhaust, possible lack of performance, poor handling and high consumption levels. In these conditions it is possible to continue driving without however requiring heavy effort or high speed from the engine. Prolonged use of the car with the warning light on may cause damages. Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services as soon as possible. The warning light goes off if the fault disappears, but it is however stored by the system. SAFETY DEVICES The warning light (where provided) (or symbol on the display) turns on when one or more doors, the boot or the bonnet (where provided) are not properly shut. INJECTION SYSTEM FAILURE (diesel versions - amber) EOBD SYSTEM FAILURE (petrol versions amber) (for versions/markets, where provided) WARNING CORRECT USE LIGHTS AND OF THE CAR MESSAGES INCOMPLETE DOOR LOCKING (red) DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 171 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:09 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE ´ 3-12-2009 INDEX 165-180 Alfa 159 GB 171 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND CORRECT USE MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 165-180 Alfa 159 GB 172 3-12-2009 14:09 Pagina 172 – flashing: indicates the possibility of damage to the catalyst (see “EOBD system” in section “Dashboard and controls”). If the light flashes, it is necessary to release the accelerator pedal to lower the speed of the engine until the warning light stops flashing; continue the journey at moderate speed, trying to avoid driving conditions that may cause further flashing and contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services as soon as possible. If when fitting the key into the ignition device, the warning light U does not turn on or if turns on with fixed light or flashing when the car is travelling, contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services as soon as possible. Warning light U operation can by checked by traffic agents by proper equipment therefore, comply with laws and regulations in force in the country where you are driving. > CAR PROTECTION SYSTEM FAILURE (amber) STEERING LOCK INHIBITION (amber) Car protection system failure Warning light (where provided) coming on (on certain versions a message is displayed) indicates car protecting system failure: in this event contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services as soon as possible. Steering lock inhibition Warning light (where provided) turns on (on certain versions a message is displayed) when removing the electronic key from the ignition device when the car has turned off while travelling. Y ALARM FAILURE (amber) (for versions/markets, where provided) BREAK-IN ATTEMPT (amber) ELECTRONIC KEY NOT RECOGNIZED (amber) Alarm failure The turning on of the warning light (where provided) (on certain versions a message is displayed) indicates that there is a failure in the alarm system. Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services as soon as possible. Break-in attempt The turning on of the warning light (where provided) (on certain versions a message is displayed) indicates an attempt of break-in. Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services as soon as possible. Electronic key not recognized The turning on of the warning light (where provided) (on certain versions a message is displayed) indicates that the electronic key being used is not enabled. On certain versions, once the above warning indication cycle is over or when pressing briefly the button MENU: – the displayed message goes off and previously active screen is displayed again; – temperature indication stops flashing; – symbol √ stays displayed at the bottom right of the screen (until outside temperature is lower than or equal to 6°C). IMPORTANT In the event of outside temperature sensor failure, the display will show dashes instead of the value. m PRE-HEATING GLOW PLUGS (diesel versions amber) PRE-HEATING GLOW PLUGS FAILURE (diesel versions - amber) Pre-heating glow plugs Fitting the key into the ignition device the warning light turns on and it will turn off when glow plugs reach the preset temperature. Start the engine immediately after warning light switching off. IMPORTANT With mild or hot ambient temperature, warning light stays on for very short time. SAFETY DEVICES When the outside temperature reaches or falls below 3°C, the display will show a warning message, symbol √ to warn the driver of the possible presence of ice on the road. This cycle is performed only once when the outside temperature read is lower than or equal to 3°C and it can be repeated only when outside temperature exceeds 6 °C and then falls down to 3 °C or below. WARNING CORRECT USE LIGHTS AND OF THE CAR MESSAGES POSSIBLE PRESENCE OF ICE ON THE ROAD DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 173 IN AN EMERGENCY 8:23 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 16-03-2010 INDEX 165-180 Alfa 159 GB 173 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND CORRECT USE MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 165-180 Alfa 159 GB 174 3-12-2009 14:09 Pagina 174 Pre-heating glow plugs failure The warning light (on certain versions together with the message on the display) will flash to indicate a failure in the pre-heating glow plugs system. Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services as soon as possible to have the failure eliminated. c WATER IN FUEL FILTER (diesel versions amber) The warning light turns on glowing steadily when travelling (on certain versions together with the message on the display) to indicate that there is water in the diesel fuel filter. The presence of water in the fuel circuit may cause serious damage to the entire injection system and cause irregular engine operation. If the warning light c on the dial turns on (on certain versions together with the message on the display) contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services as soon as possible to have the system relieved. If the above indications come on immediately after refuelling, water has probably been poured into the tank: turn the engine off immediately and contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. s INERTIAL FUEL CUTOFF SWITCHED ON On certain versions, the intervention of the inertial fuel cut-off switch is indicated by a message + symbol (amber) on the display. WARNING If, after a crash, you smell fuel or see leaks from the fuel system, do not reset the switch to avoid fire risk. The warning light turns on (on certain versions a dedicated message is displayed) when the system is inefficient. In this case the braking system keeps its effectiveness unchanged, but without the potential offered by the ABS system. Drive carefully and contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services as soon as possible. x > á VDC SYSTEM (amber) (for versions/markets, where provided) With the engine running the turning on at the same time of the > and x warning lights (on certain versions together with the message on the display) indicates that the EBD system is inefficient; in this case heavy braking may cause the rear wheels to lock before time, with the possibility of skidding. Fitting the key into the ignition device the warning light turns on, but it should go off after few seconds. Drive with the utmost care to the nearest Alfa Romeo Authorized Service to have the system checked. When the VDC is deactivated manually (pressing the ASR/VDC button for 2 seconds) (see paragraph “VDC system” in section “Dashboard and controls”) the instrument panel warning light turns on (on certain versions a message is displayed). The warning light flashes when the VDC cuts in, to alert the driver that the system is adapting to the road surface grip conditions. VDC deactivation VDC failure In case of failure, the VDC system will deactivate automatically and the instrument panel warning light á will turn on glowing steadily (on certain versions a message will also be displayed). In this case contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services as soon as possible. SAFETY DEVICES Fitting the key into the ignition device the warning light turns on, but it should go off after few seconds. EBD SYSTEM FAILURE (red) (amber) WARNING CORRECT USE LIGHTS AND OF THE CAR MESSAGES ABS SYSTEM FAILURE (amber) DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 175 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:09 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE > 3-12-2009 INDEX 165-180 Alfa 159 GB 175 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND CORRECT USE MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 165-180 Alfa 159 GB 176 * 3-12-2009 14:09 Pagina 176 HILL HOLDER FAILURE (amber) (for versions/markets, where provided) Fitting the key into the ignition device, the warning light (where provided) turns on, but it should go off after a few seconds. If the warning light stays on (on certain versions a message is displayed) there is a failure in the Hill Holder system. Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. á ASR SYSTEM (WHEEL ANTISKID SYSTEM) (amber) Fitting the key into the ignition device the warning light turns on, but it should go off after few seconds. The warning light flashes when the system cuts in, to alert the driver that the system is adapting to the road surface grip conditions. ASR deactivation When the ASR is deactivated manually (pressing the ASR/VDC button) (see paragraph “ASR system” in section “Dashboard and controls”) the ASR/VDC button turns on (on versions fitted with “Reconfigurable multifunction display” symbol V is also displayed). ASR failure In the event of a failure the ASR system is deactivated automatically and on versions fitted with “Reconfigurable multifunction display” the symbol V is displayed. In this case contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services as soon as possible. W EXTERNAL LIGHTS FAILURE (amber) The warning light (where provided) turns on (on certain versions a message is displayed) when one of the following lights is failing: – sidelights – direction indicators – rear fog guards – number plate lights. The failure referring to these lights could be: one or more blown bulbs, a blown protection fuse or an electric connection cut-off. FOLLOW ME HOME (green) 1 The warning light turns on when the main beams are turned on. Sidelights The warning light turns on when side/taillights are turned on. R Follow me home 4 REAR FOG LIGHTS (amber) The warning light turns on when the rear fog lights are turned on. 5 FRONT FOG LIGHTS (green) The warning light turns on when the front fog lights are turned on. The warning light comes on (together with the message on the display) when the Follow me home device is activated (see paragraph “Follow me home” in section “Dashboard and controls”). 2 DIPPED BEAM HEADLIGHTS (green) The warning light turns on when the dipped beams are turned on. MAIN BEAM HEADLIGHTS (blue) LEFT-HAND DIRECTION INDICATOR (green) The warning light turns on when the direction indicator stalk is moved downwards or, together with the right indicator, when the hazard light button is pressed. E RIGHT-HAND DIRECTION INDICATOR (green) The warning light turns on when the direction indicator stalk is moved upwards or, together with the left indicator, when the hazard light button is pressed. SAFETY DEVICES The warning light (where provided) turns on (on certain versions a message is displayed) when a failure at brake lights (stop) is detected. The failure could be due to: blown bulb, blown protection fuse or electric connection cut-off. 3 SIDE/TAILLIGHTS (green) WARNING CORRECT USE LIGHTS AND OF THE CAR MESSAGES BRAKE LIGHTS FAILURE (amber) DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 177 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:09 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE T 3-12-2009 INDEX 165-180 Alfa 159 GB 177 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND CORRECT USE MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 165-180 Alfa 159 GB 178 1 3-12-2009 14:09 Pagina 178 LIGHT SENSOR FAILURE (amber) (for versions/markets, where provided) The warning light (or as an alternative, on certain versions, a symbol and a message are displayed) turns on to indicate a failure at the light sensor. u The warning light on the fuel level gauge turns on when about 10 litres fuel are left in the tank. On certain versions. the display will show a warning message when the cruising range is less than 50 km (or 31 mi). If warning light K starts flashing when travelling contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. RAIN SENSOR FAILURE (amber) (for versions/markets, where provided) The warning light (where provided) turns on (on certain versions a message is displayed) when the rain sensor is failing. t K PARKING SENSOR FAILURE (amber) (for versions/markets, where provided) The warning light (or as an alternative, on certain versions, a symbol and a message are displayed) turns on to indicate a failure at parking sensors. FUEL RESERVE – LIMITED CRUISING RANGE (amber) Ü CRUISE CONTROL (green) (for versions/markets, where provided) The warning light turns on (on certain versions a dedicated message is displayed) when turning the the knurled ring of the Cruise Control to Ü. CLEANING DPF (PARTICULATE FILTER) h IN PROGRESS (only Diesel versions with DPF - amber) When the electronic key is inserted into the starting device, the warning light switches on but it must switch off after a few seconds. The warning light comes on constantly to notify the driver that the DPF system needs to eliminate captured pollutants (particulate) by the regeneration process. The warning light does not come on during every DPF regeneration, but only when driving conditions require notification of the driver. To switch the warning light off, the car must stay in motion until regeneration has been completed. The process normally takes about 15 minutes. The optimum conditions to end the process are achieved by keeping the car in motion up to 60 km/h with an engine speed higher than 2,000 rpm. This light coming on is not a car defect and therefore the car does not need to go to the workshop. A specific message will appear on the display when the warning light comes on (for versions/markets, where provided). WARNING Always drive at a speed appropriate to the traffic conditions, the weather and speed limits. The engine may be turned off while the DPF light is on; however, repeated interruption of the regeneration process may result in premature exhaustion of engine oil. For this reason it is always advisable to wait for the light to go off before turning off the engine, following the instructions appearing above. It is not advisable to complete DPF regeneration with the vehicle stationary. Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. ) WINDSCREEN WASHER FLUID LOW LEVEL (amber) The warning light (where provided) turns on (on certain versions a message is displayed) when the windscreen washer fluid level falls down the preset min. level. The display will show a warning message + symbol (red) and the buzzer will sound when the car exceeds the speed limit set through the “Setup menu” (e.g.: 120 km/h) (see paragraphs “Multifunction Display” or “Reconfigurable Multifunction Display” in section “Dashboard and controls”). T.P.M.S. SYSTEM FAILURE (for versions/markets, where provided) n On certain versions the display will show a warning message + symbol (amber) when a failure is detected in the T.P.M.S. system (Tyre Pressure Monitoring System). Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services as soon as possible. Should one or more wheels without sensor be fitted, the display will show a warning message until initial conditions are restored. CHECK TYRE PRESSURE (for versions/markets, where provided) n On some versions, the display shows a message + symbol (amber) to indicate that the tyre pressure is below the recommended value which ensures the long life of the tyre and optimum fuel consumption, and/or to indicate a slow pressure leak. If two or more tyres are in one of the above-mentioned conditions, the display will show the message relating to each tyre in succession. In this case, it is advisable to check and adjust the tyre pressures (see “Technical Specification” section). SAFETY DEVICES The warning light (or as an alternative, on certain versions, a symbol and a message are displayed) turns on when a failure is detected in the antipinch system. X SPEED LIMIT EXCEEDED WARNING CORRECT USE LIGHTS AND OF THE CAR MESSAGES ANTIPINCH SYSTEM FAILURE (amber) DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 179 IN AN EMERGENCY 14:09 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 5 3-12-2009 INDEX 165-180 Alfa 159 GB 179 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND CORRECT USE MESSAGES OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 165-180 Alfa 159 GB 180 3-12-2009 14:09 Pagina 180 LOW TYRE PRESSURE (for versions/markets, where provided) n On certain versions the display will show a warning message + symbol (red) (and buzzer will sound) when the pressure of one or more tyres falls below the preset threshold. In this way the T.P.M.S. system warns the driver that tyre/s is/are dangerously flat; possible puncture. IMPORTANT Stop immediately with one or more tyres flat, avoid braking sharply and abrupt turns. Replace immediately the punctured tyre with the space-saver spare wheel (for versions/markets, where provided) or repair the puncture tyre using the proper kit (see paragraph “If a tyre is punctured” in section “In an emergency”) and then contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services as soon as possible. TYRE PRESSURE UNSUITABLE FOR SPEED (for versions/markets, where provided) IMPORTANT In this case slow down immediately since tyre overheating could impair tyre performance and life beyond repair, and even make the tyre to blowout. Should it be required to journey at a speed higher than 160 km/h, inflate tyres at full load pressures (see paragraph “Cold inflation pressures” in section "Technical Specifications"). IMPORTANT Should you have to journey anyway a speed higher than 160 km/h, stop the car when the display shows the warning symbol to inflate tyres to the proper pressure values (see paragraph "Cold inflation pressures" in section "Technical Specifications "). n On certain versions, if the T.P.M.S. system detects that the pressure of one or more tyres is unsuitable for the current speed the display will show a message + symbol (amber) that will stay on until the car speed slow downs below the preset threshold. JUMP STARTING ............................................... 182 IF A TYRE IS PUNCTURED ................................... 183 QUICK TYRE REPAIR KIT FIX&GO automatic ............................................ 190 WHEN NEEDING TO CHANGE A BULB ................... 196 IF AN EXTERIOR LIGHT BURNS OUT ...................... 199 IF AN INTERIOR LIGHT BURNS OUT ...................... 205 IF A FUSE BLOWS ............................................. 209 IF THE BATTERY IS FLAT...................................... 219 JACKING THE CAR.............................................. 220 TOWING THE CAR ............................................. 221 SAFETY DEVICES In an emergency we recommend that you call the toll-free number found on the Warranty Booklet. You can also connect to the site www.alfaromeo.com to search for the nearest Alfa Romeo Authorized Services point. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR IN AN EMERGENCY DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 181 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:10 TECHNICAL CAR IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 INDEX 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 181 SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 182 JUMP STARTING Under no circumstances should a battery charger be used to start the engine: it could damage the electronic systems and in particular the ignition and injection control units. If the battery is flat, it is possible to start the engine using an auxiliary battery with the same capacity or a little higher than the flat one. INDEX IN AN TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR Proceed as follows fig. 1: 182 ❒ Connect positive terminals (+ near the terminal) of the two batteries with a jump lead; ❒ With a second lead, connect the negative terminal (–) of the auxiliary battery and to an earthing point E on the engine of the car to be started; ❒ Start the engine; ❒ When the engine has been started, remove the leads reversing the order above. fig. 1 A0E0201m If after a few attempts the engine does not start, do not insist but contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Service. IMPORTANT Do not directly connect the negative terminals of the two batteries: sparks could ignite the flammable gas from the battery. If the other battery is fitted in another car, prevent accidental contacts between the metal parts of the two cars. WARNING Do not carry out this procedure if you lack experience; if it is not done correctly it can cause very intense electrical discharges. In addition, the fluid contained in the battery is poisonous and corrosive. Avoid contact with skin and eyes. You are also advised not to put naked flames or lighted cigarettes near the battery and not to cause sparks. WARNING Remember that the brake booster and the power steering system are not operating until the engine is started, a greater effort will therefore be required to press the brake pedal or turn the steering wheel. IF A TYRE IS PUNCTURED For versions/markets, where provided applicable, the car can be equipped with the “Quick tyre repair kit Fix&Go automatic“. Operations required to change a wheel are described in the following chapter. As an alternative to the kit “Fix & Go automatic”, the car can be provided (upon request) with space-saver spare wheel or standard size spare wheel; wheel changing and correct use of the jack and space-saver spare wheel call for some precautions as listed below. WARNING Alert other drivers that the car is stationary in compliance with local regulations: hazard warning lights, warning triangle etc. Any passengers on board should leave the car, especially if it is heavily laden. Passengers should stay away from oncoming traffic while the wheel is being changed on. If the wheel is being changed on a steep or badly surfaced road, place the wedges or other suitable material under the wheel to stop the car. Never start the engine when the car is jacked up. If you were towing a trailer, uncouple the trailer before jacking the car. SAFETY DEVICES Never bump start the engine (by pushing, towing, or coasting downhill) as this could cause fuel to flow into the catalytic exhaust system and damage it beyond repair. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR BUMP STARTING DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 183 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:10 TECHNICAL CAR IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 INDEX 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 183 INDEX IN AN TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 184 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 184 WARNING The space-saver spare wheel (for versions/ markets, where provided) is specific to your car; do not use it on other models, or use the spare wheel of other models on your car. The space-saver spare wheel shall only be used in an emergency. It shall only be used for the distance necessary to reach a service point and the car speed shall not exceed 80 Km/h. The spare wheel has a sticker that summarises the main cautions for use and limitations. The sticker should never be removed or covered!. Never fit a wheel cap on a space-saver spare wheel. WARNING When driving with a space-saver spare wheel fitted, the driving performance of the car changes. Avoid accelerating or braking sharply, abrupt turns or fast cornerings. The life of the spare wheel is approx. 3000 Km, after this distance it should be replaced with another of the same type. Never attempt to fit a conventional tyre on a rim designed for use as a space-saver spare wheel. Have the punctured wheel repaired and refitted as soon as possible. Two or more space-saver spare wheels should never be used together. Do not grease the threads of bolts before installing them: they might slip out. WARNING The jack shall only be used for changing wheels on the car with which it is provided or on cars of the same model. It must not be used for other purposes such as for instance raising cars of other models. In no case should it be used for repairs under the car. Incorrect positioning of the jack may cause the jacked car to fall. Do not use the jack for higher capacities than stated on its label. Snow chains cannot be fitted to the space-saver spare wheel. So, if a front (drive) wheel is punctured and chains are needed, a rear wheel should be fitted to the front of the car and the spare wheel should be fitted to the rear. This way with two normal drive wheels, snow chains can be fitted to them to solve an emergency. Pagina 185 fig. 2 A0E0132m fig. 3 A0E0133m Please note: To change a wheel proceed as follows: ❒ the jack weight is 1.76 kg; ❒ Stop the car in a position that is not dangerous for oncoming traffic where you can change the wheel safely. The ground should be flat and adequately firm; ❒ the jack requires no adjustment; ❒ the jack cannot be repaired. If it breaks it must be replaced with a new jack; ❒ no tool other than its cranking device may be fitted on the jack. ❒ Turn the engine off, pull up the handbrake and engage first gear or reverse; ❒ Using handle A-fig. 2, lift the stiff cover B and secure it as shown in fig. 3; CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS WARNING Never tamper with the inflation valve. Never place tools between the rim and tyre. Check and restore, if required, the pressure of tyres and spare wheel to the values given in section “Technical Specifications”. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:10 TECHNICAL CAR IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 INDEX 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 185 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 186 INDEX IN AN TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 186 fig. 4 A0E0134m fig. 5 A0E0206m ❒ Take out the tool container fig. 4; fig. 7 A0E0195m ❒ The jack shall be fitted as shown in fig. 7 (for versions fitted with sideskirts, before fitting the jack, remove cover A-fig. 9 set on the sideskirt as shown in the figure); ❒ Loosen the bolts of the wheel to be replaced by about one turn with the wrench provided A-fig. 5; if the car is fitted with alloy rims, shake the car to facilitate removing this rim from the wheel hub; fig. 6 A0E0207m ❒ Remove the wheel cap A-fig. 6 (only versions with steel rims); 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 187 A0E0049m ❒ Fit the handle L-fig. 8 to operate the jack and lift the car until the wheel to be changed is several centimetres off the ground; ❒ Loosen the fastening bolts and then remove the wheel; ❒ Make sure the contact surfaces between space-saver spare wheel and hub are clean so that the fastening bolts will not come loose; WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES ❒ Warn anybody nearby that the car is about to be lifted. They must stay clear and not touch the car until it is back on the ground; fig. 9 TECHNICAL CAR IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY ❒ Operate the device F-fig. 8 to extend the jack until the top of the jack G fits correctly into catch H; A0E0208m INDEX fig. 8 CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 187 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 188 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS REFITTING A NORMAL WHEEL INDEX IN AN TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES Following the procedure described previously, raise the car and remove the spare wheel. 188 Versions with steel rims fig. 10 A0E0209m ❒ fit the space-saver spare wheel making one of the holes A-fig. 10 coincide with the relevant pin B; ❒ Using the wrench provided, fully tighten the five fastening bolts; fig. 11 A0E0210m ❒ Lower the car and remove the jack; ❒ Use the wrench provided to fasten the bolts completely in a criss-cross fashion according to the sequence shown in fig. 11. Proceed as follows: ❒ Make sure the contact surfaces between standard wheel and hub are clean so that the fastening bolts will not come loose; ❒ Fit the standard wheel taking into account that pin B-fig. 10 shall coincide with one of the holes A; ❒ Place the wheel cap on the wheel rim making symbol C, (marked inside the wheel cap), coincide with the inflation valve fig. 12; ❒ Using the wrench provided, tighten the fastening bolts; ❒ Lower the car and remove the jack; ❒ Using the wrench provided, fully tighten the bolts in the sequence shown in fig. 11; fig. 13 A0E0211m Versions with alloy rims Proceed as follows: ❒ tighten pin A-fig. 13 in one of the holes of the wheel hub fastening bolts; ❒ insert the wheel on the pin and, using the wrench provided, tighten the four bolts available; ❒ loosen pin A-fig. 13 and tighten the last fastening bolt; ❒ lower the car and remove the jack, then, using the wrench provided tighten the bolts according to the sequence previously shown for the space-saver spare wheel fig. 11. SAFETY DEVICES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR A0E0236m When you have finished: ❒ Stow the spare wheel in the space provided in the boot; ❒ Fit the jack partially open in its container forcing it lightly to prevent it from vibrating when travelling; ❒ Put the tools back into their places in the container; ❒ Arrange the container complete with tools on the space-saver spare wheel; ❒ Reposition properly the boot stiff covering. DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 189 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:10 TECHNICAL CAR IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY fig. 12 3-12-2009 INDEX 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 189 INDEX IN AN TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 190 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 190 QUICK TYRE REPAIR KIT FIX&GO automatic The car is provided with the quick tyre repair kit “FIX&GO automatic”, instead of the traditional tool kit and space-saver spare wheel. The kit fig. 14 is placed in the boot. In this container are also housed the screwdriver and the tow hitch. fig. 14 A0E0114m The quick tyre repair kit includes: ❒ a bottle A-fig. 14 containing the sealer, fitted with: - filling pipe B - sticker C bearing the notice “max. 80 km/h”, to be placed in a position visible to the driver (on the instrument panel) after fixing the tyre; ❒ compressor D with pressure gauge and fittings; fig. 15 A0E0048m ❒ instruction brochure fig. 15, to be used for prompt and proper use of the quick repair kit and to be then handed to the personnel charged with handling the tyre treated with the tyre repair kit; ❒ a pair of protection gloves located in the side space of the compressor; ❒ adapters for inflating different elements. The sealing fluid of the quick tyre repair kit is effective with external temperatures between –20°C and +50°C. The sealing fluid has limited life. WARNING In the event of a puncture caused by foreign bodies, it is possible to repair tyres showing damages on the track or shoulder up to max 4 mm diameter. Holes and damages on the tyre side walls cannot be repaired. Do not use the quick tyre repair kit if damaging is due to running with flat tyre. WARNING Repairs are not possible in case of damages on the wheel rim (bad groove distortion causing air loss). Do not remove foreign bodies (screws or nails) from the tyre. WARNING The cylinder contains ethylene glycol. The cylinder contains latex: it can cause allergic reactions. It is harmful if ingested or inhaled and irritant for the eyes and in case of contact. In case of contact rinse immediately with water and take off contaminated clothes. If swallowed, do not induce vomit, rinse out the mouth, drink a lot of water and call the doctor immediately. Keep away from children. This product must not be used by asthmatics. Do not inhale vapours. Call the doctor immediately in case of allergic reactions. Keep the cylinder in the space provided for the purpose and far from heat. The sealing fluid has limited life. SAFETY DEVICES Hand the instruction brochure to the personnel charged with treating the tyre repaired with the kit. It should be noticed that: CORRECT USE OF THE CAR WARNING DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 191 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:10 TECHNICAL CAR IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 INDEX 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 191 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 192 WARNING The compressor shall not be operated for more than 20 minutes. Risk of overheating!. Tyres repaired with the quick tyre repair kit shall be used temporarily only. INDEX IN AN TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 192 A0E0212m fig. 16 fig. 17 A0E0116m fig. 18 A0E0214m INFLATING PROCEDURE WARNING Replace the cylinder if sealer has run out. Do not throw away the cylinder and the sealing fluid. Have the sealing fluid and the cylinder disposed of in compliance with national and local regulations. Put on the protection gloves provided together with quick tyre repair kit. Proceed as follows: ❒ set the wheel to be repaired with valve A-fig. 16 in the position shown in the figure, then pull up the handbrake, take the quick tyre repair kit and put it on the ground near the wheel to be repaired; ❒ loosen tyre inflation valve cap, take out the filler hose A-fig. 17 and screw the ring nut B-fig. 18 on the tyre valve; fig. 19 A0E0213m ❒ make sure the compressor switch Afig. 19 is set to 0 (off), start the engine and fit plug A-fig. 20 into the outlet/cigar lighter on the front console and then turn on the compressor by setting switch A-fig. 19 to I (on); ❒ Inflate the tyre to the pressure specified in paragraph “Wheels” in section “Technical Specifications”. Check tyre pressure on gauge B-fig. 19 with compressor off to obtain precise reading; fig. 20 A0E0217m ❒ if after 5 minutes it is still impossible to reach at least 1.5 bar, disengage compressor from valve and current outlet, then move the car forth for approx. 10 metres in order to distribute the sealing fluid inside the tyre evenly, then repeat the inflation operation; ❒ If after this operation it is still impossible after 5 minutes to reach at least 1.8 bar, do start driving since the tyre is excessively damaged and the quick tyre repair kit cannot guarantee suitable sealing, contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services; Apply the sticker in a visible position for the driver to indicate that the tyre has been treated with the quick tyre repair kit. Drive carefully especially when cornering and do not exceed 80 km/h. Avoid heavy braking and accelerating. ❒ after driving for about 10 minutes stop and check again the tyre pressure; pull up the handbrake; SAFETY DEVICES WARNING CORRECT USE OF THE CAR ❒ after reaching the tyre pressure specified in paragraph “Wheels” in section “Technical Specifications”, start driving immediately; DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 193 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:10 TECHNICAL CAR IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 INDEX 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 193 INDEX IN AN TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 194 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 194 WARNING If pressure falls below 1.8 bar, stop the car since the tyre is excessively damaged and the quick tyre repair kit Fix & Go automatic cannot guarantee suitable sealing, contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. A0E0215m fig. 21 WARNING ❒ if at least 1.8 bar pressure is read, restore proper pressure (with engine running and handbrake on) and restart; ❒ drive with the utmost care to the nearest Alfa Romeo Authorized Service. You shall absolutely communicate that the tyre has been repaired with the quick tyre repair kit. Hand the instruction brochure to the personnel charged with treating the tyre repaired with the kit. fig. 22 A0E0216m CHECKING AND RESTORING PRESSURE ONLY The compressor can be also used just for restoring pressure. Disconnect the quick connection A-fig. 21 and connect it directly to the tyre valve fig. 22; in this way the cylinder is not connected to compressor and the sealing fluid will not flow into the tyre. ❒ disconnect connection A-fig. 23 and hose B; fig. 23 A0E0047m ❒ turn counter-clockwise the cylinder to replace and raise it; ❒ fit the new cylinder and turn it clockwise; ❒ refit connection A or connect hose B into its seat. SAFETY DEVICES To replace the cylinder proceed as follows: WARNING Inform other people driving the car that the tyre has been repaired using the quick tyre kit. Hand the sticker to the personnel that will carry out restoring operations. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR CYLINDER REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 195 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:10 TECHNICAL CAR IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 INDEX 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 195 INDEX IN AN TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 196 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 196 WHEN NEEDING TO CHANGE A BULB GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS ❒ When a light is not working, check that the corresponding fuse is intact before changing a bulb. For the location of fuses, refer to the paragraph “If a fuse blows” in this section; ❒ Before changing a bulb check the contacts for oxidation; ❒ Burnt bulbs must be replaced by others of the same type and power; WARNING Halogen bulbs must be handled touching only the metallic part. If the transparent bulb is touched with the fingers, its lighting intensity is reduced and life of the bulb may be compromised. If touched accidentally, rub the bulb with a cloth moistened with alcohol and allow to dry. ❒ Always check the height of the headlight beam after changing a bulb. IMPORTANT The headlight inner surface may be lightly misted over: this is not a fault but a natural fact due to low temperature and the level of air humidity. It will disappear as soon the headlights are turned on. The presence of drops inside the headlights means water infiltration, therefore contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. WARNING Modifications or repairs to the electrical system (electronic control units) carried out incorrectly and without bearing the features of the system in mind can cause malfunctions with the risk of fire. WARNING Halogen bulbs contain pressurised gas which, if broken, may cause small fragments of glass to be projected outwards. WARNING Due to high voltage, the bulb of (Bixenon) gas-discharge headlights must only be replaced by experts: danger of death! Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 197 Bayonet type bulbs: press the bulb, turn counter-clockwise to remove this type of bulb from its holder. C Tubular bulbs: release them from their contacts to remove. Various types of bulbs are fitted to your car: A Glass bulbs: clipped into position. Pull to remove. D-E Halogen bulbs: to remove the bulb, release the clip holding the bulb in place. F Gas-discharge bulbs (Bixenon). WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES B TECHNICAL CAR IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY TYPES OF BULBS fig. 24 A0E0117m INDEX fig. 24 CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 197 INDEX IN AN TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 198 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 198 BULBS FIGURE 24 TYPE POWER Main beam headlights D H7 55W Dipped beam headlights D H7 55W Main beams/Dipped beams (versions with Bixenon headlights) (where provided) F D1S 55W Additional main beams (where provided) D H1 55W Front sidelights (1 per headlight) A W5WB 5W Taillights (1 on fixed light unit - 1 on mobile light unit) B P21/5W 5W Front fog lights E H7 55W Front direction indicator B PY21W 21W Side direction indicator A W5W 5W Rear direction indicator B P21W 21W Brake lights B P21/5W 21W Third brake light A W2,3W 2,3W Reversing light B P21W 21W Rear fog lights B P21W 21W Number plate lights A W5W 5W 2xA+1C 2xW5+10W 5+5+10W Boot light C 10W 10W Rear ceiling light A 2xW5W 5+5W Courtesy mirror lights A 1,5W 1.5W Glovebox light A W5W 5W Puddle/door lights A W5W 5W Front ceiling light Pagina 199 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS IF AN EXTERIOR LIGHT BURNS OUT FRONT LIGHT UNITS The front light units contain main beam, sidelights, direction indicator and dipped beam bulbs. To change the bulbs, turn cap counterclockwise and then remove it. The bulbs are arranged inside the light unit fig. 25/a as follows: A Main beam headlights A0E0540m fig. 25 Main beam headlights (halogen bulbs) On some versions a special brake servo vacuum unit is fitted which has to be removed in order to be able to replace the left main beam headlamp halogen bulb. The vacuum unit is located next to the battery drip tray (fig. 25). B Sidelights/direction indicators C Dipped beam headlights WARNING After replacement, refit the covers correctly checking that they are properly secured. WARNING It should be remembered that the vacuum unit operates at high temperatures: avoid touching it with your hands, danger of scalding! Any operations not carried out following the rules could adversely affect the operation of the braking system and therefore the safety of the vehicle. fig. 25/a A0E0191m On versions with a brake servo vacuum unit, the description is given purely as an example; this operation must be carried out by Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. To change the bulb, proceed as follows: ❒ remove cover A-fig. 25/a by turning it counter-clockwise; ❒ disconnect the electric connector Afig. 26; ❒ release the bulb holder catch B; CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES For the type of bulb and power rating, see “When needing to change a bulb”. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:10 TECHNICAL CAR IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 INDEX 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 199 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 200 INDEX IN AN TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 200 fig. 26 A0E0223m fig. 27 A0E0193m fig. 28 A0E0194m ❒ remove the bulb and replace it; Sidelights Front direction indicators ❒ fit the new bulb and refit bulb holder catch B-fig. 26; To change the bulb, proceed as follows: To change the bulb, proceed as follows: ❒ turn cover B-fig. 25 counter-clockwise; ❒ turn cover B-fig. 25 counter-clockwise; ❒ press tab A-fig. 27, remove the bulb and replace it; ❒ turn the bulb holder A-fig. 28 counterclockwise, remove the bulb and replace it; ❒ reconnect the electrical connector A; ❒ refit the protective cover properly. ❒ refit the bulb holder, it shall click into place; look at the light from the outside to check for proper bulb positioning; ❒ refit the protective cover properly. ❒ refit the bulb holder, it shall click into place; look at the light from the outside to check for proper bulb positioning; ❒ refit the protective cover properly. 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 201 To change the bulb, proceed as follows: ❒ turn cover C-fig. 25 counter-clockwise; ❒ disconnect the electric connector Afig. 29; ❒ release the bulb holder catch B; ❒ remove the bulb and replace it; ❒ fit the new bulb and refit bulb holder catch B-fig. 29; Gas-discharge dipped beam/main beam headlights (Bixenon) (where provided) WARNING Due to high voltage, the bulb of (Bixenon) gas-discharge headlights must only be replaced by experts: danger of death! Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. A0E0164m fig. 31 Side direction indicators To change the bulb, proceed as follows: ❒ push the lens by hand in opposite running direction in order to press the catch A-fig. 30. Release the front part and remove the unit; ❒ turn the bulb holder B-fig. 31 counterclockwise and remove it from lens C. ❒ remove bulb D and replace it; ❒ fit the bulb holder B into the lens C then position the unit, the catch shall click into place A-fig. 30. Be careful not to damage the car body or the lens. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES Dipped beam headlights (halogen bulbs) A0E0163m fig. 30 TECHNICAL CAR IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY A0E0192m INDEX fig. 29 CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 201 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 202 INDEX IN AN TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 202 fig. 32 A0E0196m Front fog lights fig. 32 (where provided) IMPORTANT Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services to have front fog lights replaced and adjusted. fig. 33 A0E0165m REAR LIGHT UNITS Rear light units contain: reversing light, rear fog light, direction indicators, taillights, number plate lights, brake light and third brake light bulbs. fig. 34 A0E0166m Reversing light/rear fog lights To replace the bulbs proceed as follows: ❒ open the tailgate; ❒ turn device A-fig. 33 to open lid B; ❒ lower the lid and remove the bulb holder unit by pressing the retaining tabs C-fig. 34; 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 203 D: reversing light bulb on passenger side (or right side); D: reversing light bulb on driver side (or left side) ❒ refit the bulb holder unit securing it properly using the retaining tabs Cfig. 34; ❒ close lid B-fig. 33. A0E0229m Taillight bulb on tailgate To replace the bulbs proceed as follows: ❒ open the tailgate; ❒ turn device A-fig. 33 to open lid B; ❒ lower the lid and remove the bulb holder unit by pressing the retaining tabs C-fig. 34; fig. 37 A0E0170m ❒ remove and replace the burnt-out bulb by pressing it slightly and turning it counterclockwise fig. 36: D: taillight bulb on right/left headlight ❒ refit the bulb holder unit securing it properly using the retaining tabs Cfig. 34; ❒ close lid B-fig. 33. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES ❒ remove and replace the burnt-out bulb by pressing it slightly and turning it counterclockwise fig. 35: fig. 36 TECHNICAL CAR IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY A0E0167m INDEX fig. 35 CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 203 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 204 INDEX IN AN TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 204 fig. 38 A0E0040m Direction indicators/ Taillights/Brake lights To replace the bulbs proceed as follows: ❒ open the tailgate; ❒ loosen screw A-fig. 37 and remove the protection cover B; ❒ remove the bulb holder unit Cfig. 38 by pressing the retaining tabs D. fig. 39 A0E0041m ❒ remove and replace the burnt-out bulb by pressing it slightly and turning it counter-clockwise fig. 39: fig. 40 A0E0168m Number plate light To replace the bulbs proceed as follows: F direction indicator bulb. ❒ operate with a flat blade screwdriver protected by a soft cloth on device A-fig. 40 to remove the light unit B; ❒ refit the bulb holder unit securing it properly using the retaining tabs Dfig. 38; ❒ remove the bulb holder C-fig. 41 by turning it slightly and replace the snapfitted bulb D. E taillight/brake light bulb; ❒ refit the protection cover B-fig. 37 and tighten screw A. 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 205 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS IF AN INTERIOR LIGHT BURNS OUT SAFETY DEVICES For the type of bulb and power rating, see “When needing to change a bulb”. A0E0183m fig. 43 A0E0084m REAR CEILING LIGHT WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services to have the third brake light replaced. fig. 42 Versions without sunroof To change the bulb, proceed as follows: ❒ remove the front ceiling light working in the points shown by the arrows (see fig. 42); ❒ turn the 2 bulb holders A-fig. 43 counter-clockwise, remove and replace bulbs. TECHNICAL CAR IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY Additional brake light (third stop) Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services to change the bulb. INDEX fig. 41 CORRECT USE OF THE CAR FRONT CEILING LIGHT A0E0169m 205 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 206 INDEX IN AN TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 206 fig. 44 A0E0098m Versions with sunroof To replace the bulbs proceed as follows: ❒ remove the ceiling light A-fig. 44 working in the points shown by the arrows; fig. 45 A0E0099m ❒ replace the bulb B-fig. 45 releasing it from the side contacts making sure that the new bulb is correctly clamped between the contacts. fig. 46 A0E0118m COURTESY MIRROR LIGHTS (where provided) To change the bulb, proceed as follows: ❒ open the mirror cover A-fig. 46; ❒ remove the bulb B levering in the points shown by the arrows; 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 207 A0E0172m GLOVEBOX LIGHT To change the bulb, proceed as follows: ❒ open the glovebox; ❒ remove the light unit A-fig. 48 levering in the point shown by the arrow; ❒ raise protection B-fig. 49 and replace the snap-fitted bulb; fig. 49 A0E0173m ❒ close protection B-fig. 49 on light unit A-fig. 48; ❒ refit the light unit inserting first one side and then the other one until hearing the locking click. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES ❒ replace the bulb C-fig. 47 releasing it from the side contacts making sure that the new bulb is correctly clamped between the contacts. fig. 48 TECHNICAL CAR IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY A0E0171m INDEX fig. 47 CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 207 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 208 INDEX IN AN TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 208 fig. 50 A0E0205m fig. 51 A0E0204m BOOT LIGHT PUDDLE LIGHT To change the bulb, proceed as follows: To change the bulb, proceed as follows: ❒ open the tailgate; ❒ open the door and remove lens Afig. 52 levering in the point shown by the arrow; ❒ remove the light unit A-fig. 50 levering in the point shown by the arrow; ❒ open the protection cover B-fig. 51 and replace the bulb releasing it from the side contacts making sure that the new bulb is correctly clamped between the contacts; ❒ re-close the protective cover B; ❒ refit the light unit inserting first one side and then the other one until hearing the locking click. fig. 52 A0E0075m fig. 53 A0E0235m ❒ raise protection B-fig. 53 and replace the snap-fitted bulb; ❒ close protection B-fig. 53 on light unit A-fig. 52; ❒ refit the light unit inserting first one side and then the other one until hearing the locking click. GENERAL The fuse is a protective device for the electric system: it comes into action (i.e. it cuts off) mainly due to a fault or improper action on the system. When a device does not work, check the efficiency of its fuse. The conductor element must be intact; if not, replace the fuse with one of the same amp rating (same colour). A0E0119m fig. 54 Never replace a broken fuse with anything other than a new fuse. WARNING A: undamaged fuse B: fuse with damaged filament. To replace a fuse, use the pliers C hooked to the fusebox on the dashboard. WARNING Never change a fuse with another with a higher amp rating, danger of fire. If the fuse blows again, contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. WARNING If a general protection fuse for safety systems (air bag system, braking system), power unit systems (engine system, transmission system) or steering system is triggered, contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. SAFETY DEVICES WARNING If a general fuse (MEGA-FUSE, MAXIFUSE) cuts in, do not attempt any repair and contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. Before changing a fuse, check the ignition key has been removed and that all the other electric devices have been turned off/disabled. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR IF A FUSE BLOWS DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 209 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:10 TECHNICAL CAR IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 INDEX 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 209 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 210 INDEX IN AN TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 210 fig. 55 A0E0157m FUSE LOCATION Fuses are grouped into four fuse boxes to be found respectively on the dashboard, on the battery positive pole, near the battery and inside the boot (righthand side). fig. 56 Fuse box on the dashboard To gain access to the fuses in the fuse box on the dashboard, loosen the fastening screw A-fig. 55 and remove the cover B. A0E0124m 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 211 A0E0126m To gain access to the fuses in the fuse box on the battery positive pole press the retainers A-fig. 57 and remove the protection cover B. fig. 58 A0E0125m TECHNICAL CAR IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES Fuse box on the battery positive pole INDEX fig. 57 CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 211 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 212 INDEX IN AN TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 212 fig. 59 A0E0128m Fuse box near the battery To gain access to the fuses, loosen the two fastening screws A-fig. 59 and remove the protection cover B. fig. 60 A0E0123m 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 213 A0E0129m To gain access to the fuses, open the lid on the left side of the boot as shown by the arrow A-fig. 61. fig. 62 A0E0224m TECHNICAL CAR IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES Fuse box in the boot (left-hand side) INDEX fig. 61 CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 213 INDEX IN AN TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 214 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 214 FUSE SUMMARY TABLE LIGTHS FUSE AMPERE FIGURE Right main beam headlight F14 7.5 60 Left main beam headlight F15 7.5 60 Right dipped beam headlight F12 15 56 Left dipped beam headlight F13 15 56 Front fog light F30 15 60 Reversing light/Brake light F35 7.5 56 Third brake light F37 7.5 56 Front/rear ceiling light F39 10 56 Front ceiling light F49 7.5 56 Direction indicators F53 10 56 Hazard lights F53 10 56 FUSE AMPERE FIGURE F70 (MEGA-FUSE) 150 58 Instrument panel control unit F71 70 58 Additional heater (passenger compartment water heating 600W) (diesel versions) F72 50 58 Plug pre-heating control unit (diesel versions) F73 60 58 F01 (MAXI-FUSE) 60 60 USERS Engine housing control unit services Instrument panel control unit AMPERE FIGURE Climate control system fan (1.8 140 HP versions) F02 (MAXI-FUSE) 40 60 Climate control system fan (2.2 JTS Selespeed versions) F02 (MAXI-FUSE) 50 60 Electric steering lock F03 (MAXI-FUSE) 20 60 Brake branch point (pump) F04 (MAXI-FUSE) 40 60 Brake branch point (solenoid valve) (ABS version) F05 (MAXI-FUSE) 40 60 Brake branch point (solenoid valve) (VDC version) F05 (MAXI-FUSE) 20 60 Radiator fan (low speed) (1.8 140 HP, 2.2 JTS Selespeed versions) F06 (MAXI-FUSE) 40 60 Radiator fan (high speed) F07 (MAXI-FUSE) 50 60 Additional heater supply (passenger compartment water heating 300W) (diesel versions) F08 30 60 Headlight washer F09 20 60 Horns F10 15 60 Climate control system compressor F19 7.5 60 Rear window heating F20 20 60 SAFETY DEVICES FUSE CORRECT USE OF THE CAR USERS DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 215 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:10 TECHNICAL CAR IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 INDEX 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 215 INDEX IN AN TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 216 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 216 USERS FUSE AMPERE FIGURE Fuel pump supply F21 20 60 Sound system/radionavigation system power/Blue&Me F23 15 60 Supply + key for relay coils of engine compartment control unit/ dashboard control unit/Body Computer F31 7.5 56 Driver’s door branch point/passenger’s door branch point/ ignition device F32 15 56 Rear left window control/boot node F33 20 56 Rear right window control/boot node F34 20 56 Water in diesel fuel filter sensor/flow meter/Brake light switch/ central console control panel/Cruise Control/AQS sensor F35 7.5 56 Supply of boot node/locks actuators F36 20 56 Positive under key for stop lights/third stop/instrument/ lights direction F37 7.5 56 Boot opening F38 15 56 Supply + battery for air conditioner, ceiling lights, volumetric alarm, EOBD system diagnostic socket F39 10 56 AMPERE FIGURE Heated rear window F40 30 56 Defrosting of external mirrors/heated windshield relay coil F41 7.5 56 Windshield wiper/washer F43 30 56 Front cigar lighter on central console F44 10 56 Supply of socket in the boot F45 15 56 Sunroof F46 20 56 Power supply of driver door node F47 20 56 Power supply of passenger door nodes F48 30 56 + Key for wheel node/Sunroof control unit/ Front and rear ceiling lights/Cvs/Blue&Me node/Volumetric/ Left and right seat F49 7.5 56 Supply under key for Telematic info node/ Automatic gearbox node/Additional heater/ Left dashboard controls/ START/STOP button, Parking sensors control unit/Electrochromatic mirror/ Blue&Me node/Car radio prearrangement/AQS/Cruise Control F51 7.5 56 SAFETY DEVICES FUSE CORRECT USE OF THE CAR USERS DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 217 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:10 TECHNICAL CAR IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 INDEX 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 217 INDEX IN AN TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 218 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 218 USERS FUSE AMPERE FIGURE Rear window wiper/Rear lighter F52 15 56 Instrument panel branch point F53 10 56 Amplifier Bose audio system F54 30 62 Front left seat movement control F56 25 62 Driver’s seat warming left F57 7.5 62 Front right seat movement control F60 25 62 Amplifier Bose audio system on rear parcel shelf F61 15 62 Front passenger’ seat warming right F67 7.5 62 Free F58 --- 62 Free F59 --- 62 Free F62 --- 62 Free F63 --- 62 Free F64 --- 62 Free F66 --- 62 Free F68 --- 62 Free F69 --- 62 Free F77 --- 62 Free F78 --- 62 Free F79 --- 62 Free F80 --- 62 IMPORTANT The description of the battery charging procedure is described only for informative purposes. This operation should be carried out by Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. ❒ connect the charger cables to the battery terminals, observing the poles; Charging should be slow at a low amp rating for 24 hours. Charging for a longer time may damage the battery. ❒ disconnect battery negative terminal (–); ❒ turn on the charger; ❒ when you have finished, turn the charger off before disconnecting the battery; WARNING The liquid in the battery is poisonous and corrosive. Do not let it touch the skin or eyes. Recharging the battery should be done in a well ventilated area away from naked flames or possible sources of sparks: explosion and fire risk. ❒ reconnect battery negative terminal (–). SAFETY DEVICES Charge the battery as follows: CORRECT USE OF THE CAR IF THE BATTERY IS FLAT DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 219 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:10 WARNING Do not attempt to recharge a frozen battery. Thaw it first, otherwise it could explode. If the battery froze, make sure the internal elements are not broken and that the casing is not cracked: risk of spilling the poisonous and corrosive fluid. TECHNICAL CAR IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 INDEX 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 219 INDEX IN AN TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 220 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 220 WITH THE JACK JACKING THE CAR See instructions given in paragraph “Wheel replacement” in this section USING AN ARM LIFT OR WORKSHOP LIFT Never jack the car from the front side, the car can only be jacked at the sides, jack arms or workshop lift shall be placed as shown in fig. 63. In any case, contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. fig. 63 A0E0195m Pagina 221 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS TOWING THE CAR To prevent damaging the transmission components, tow the car only in one of following ways: fig. 64 A0E0111m ❒ with front and rear wheels on the flatbed of a wrecker or maintenance vehicle. A0E0176m TOW RING HOOKING Front ❒ with front wheels raised and rear wheels resting on a truck provided for the purpose; ❒ with rear wheels raised and front wheels resting on a truck provided for the purpose; fig. 66 Proceed as follows: ❒ take the tow hook A-fig. 64 from the Fix&Go automatic container. fig. 65 A0E0230m ❒ remove the snap-fitted plug A-fig. 65 from the front bumper. If using the flat blade screwdriver B-fig. 64 provided as standard, protect its tip with a soft cloth to prevent damaging the car. ❒ tighten the tow hook in its seat. Rear The tow hook A-fig. 66 for the rear bumper is fixed. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR PRECAUTIONS FOR TOWING THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES The tow hook provided with the car is contained into the Fix&Go automatic container. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:10 TECHNICAL CAR IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 INDEX 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 221 INDEX IN AN TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 181-222 Alfa 159 GB 222 3-12-2009 14:10 Pagina 222 WARNING Before fitting the hook, clean accurately its threaded seat. Before starting to tow, make sure to have tighten the hook. WARNING Do not start the engine when towing the car. WARNING Before starting to tow, disengage the steering lock (see paragraph “Ignition device” in section “Dashboard and controls”). When towing, remember that without the help of the brake booster and power steering, a greater effort is required on the pedal and steering wheel. Do not use flexible cables for towing and avoid jerks. During towing operations make sure that fastening the joint to the car does not damage the components in contact with it. When towing the car, you must comply with the specific traffic regulations regarding the tow ring and how to tow on the road. WARNING The front and rear tow hooks must only be used for emergency situations on the road. The vehicle may be towed for short distances when a dedicated device is used in compliance with the Highway Code (rigid bar), in order to move the vehicle on the road in preparation for towing by a tow truck Tow hooks MUST NOT be used to tow vehicles off the road or where there are obstacles and/or for towing operations using cables or other non-rigid devices. Respecting the above conditions, towing must only take place with two vehicles (one towing, the other towed) travelling as far as possible in alignment along the same centreline. SCHEDULED SERVICING...................................... 224 SERVICE SCHEDULE ........................................... 225 PERIODICAL CHECKS .......................................... 227 SAFETY DEVICES CAR MAINTENANCE DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 223 CHECKING FLUID LEVELS .................................... 228 AIR FILTER/POLLEN FILTER ................................ 237 BATTERY .......................................................... 237 WHEELS AND TYRES.......................................... 241 RUBBER HOSES ................................................ 243 WINDSCREEN WIPER ........................................ 243 BODYWORK ..................................................... 245 INTERIORS ....................................................... 247 CORRECT USE OF THE CAR USE OF THE CAR UNDER HEAVY CONDITIONS ........ 227 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:11 CAR TECHNICAL IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 INDEX 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 223 3-12-2009 14:11 Pagina 224 Correct maintenance is essential for ensuring long car life under the best conditions. This is why Alfa Romeo has programmed a series of checks and maintenance operations every 35,000 km (or 21,000 mi). INDEX CAR TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES SAFETY DEVICES SCHEDULED SERVICING CORRECT USE OF THE CAR DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 224 IMPORTANT The actual engine oil and filter change frequency depends on the conditions of use of the car and is signalled by means of a warning light or message (where provided) on the instrument panel. IMPORTANT At 2,000 km from the scheduled service, the display will show a dedicated message. It is however important to remember that scheduled servicing does not completely cover all the car’s requirements: also in the initial period before 35,000 km (or 21,000 mi) service coupon and later, between one coupon and another, ordinary care is still required such as for example routine check and topping up the level of fluids, tyre pressure check, etc... IMPORTANT The Programmed Maintenance coupons are specified by the Manufacturer. The failure to have them carried out may invalidate the warranty. Scheduled Servicing is performed by all Alfa Romeo Authorized Services, at preestablished times. If during whatever service operation, in addition to the ones programmed, the need arises for further replacements or repairs, these may be carried out only with the explicit agreement of the Customer. IMPORTANT You are advised to contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services in the event of any minor operating faults, without waiting for the next service coupon. If your car is used frequently for towing, the interval between one service coupon and the other must be reduced. 35 70 105 140 175 Check tyre conditions/wear and adjust pressure if required ● ● ● ● ● Check light system operation (headlights, direction indicators, hazard lights, boot lights, passenger compartment lights, glovebox lights, warning lights, etc.) ● ● ● ● ● Check windscreen wiper/washer operation,adjust nozzles if required ● ● ● ● ● Check windscreen/rear window blade position/wear ● ● ● ● ● Check front disk brake pad conditions and wear and wear indicator operation ● ● ● ● ● Check rear disk brake pad conditions and wear ● ● ● ● ● Sight inspect the conditions of: body external parts, underbody protection, pipes and hoses (exhaust - fuel - brakes), rubber parts (boots, sleeves, bushes, etc.) ● ● ● ● ● Check cleanness of locks, bonnet and boot and lever cleanness and lubrication ● ● ● ● ● Check and top up, if required, fluid levels (brakes/hydraulic clutch, power steering, windscreen washer, battery, engine coolant, etc.) ● ● ● ● ● Check and adjust handbrake lever stroke ● ● Sight inspect accessory drive belt conditions (except 1.8 140 HP version) ● Sight inspect accessory drive belt conditions (1.8 140 HP version) ● Sight inspect timing belt conditions (1.8 140 HP version) ● ● ● SAFETY DEVICES Thousands of km CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SERVICE SCHEDULE DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 225 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:11 CAR TECHNICAL IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 INDEX 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 225 INDEX CAR TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 226 3-12-2009 14:11 Pagina 226 Thousands of km Check and adjust tappet clearance (1.9 JTDM 8v version) Check and adjust tappet clearance, if required (1.8 140 HP version) Check exhaust emissions (petrol versions) Check exhaust emissions/smoke (diesel versions) Check engine control system operation (through diagnosis socket) Replace accessory drive belt/s (except 1.8 140 HP version) Replace accessory drive belt/s (1.8 140 HP version) Replace timing belt (1.8 140 HP version) (*) Replace timing belt (1750 TURBO BENZINA version) (*) Replace timing belt (diesel versions) (*) Change spark plugs (3.2 JTS and 2.2 JTS Selespeed versions) Change spark plugs (1.8 140 HP and 1750 TURBO BENZINA versions) Replace diesel fuel filter (diesel versions) Change air cleaner cartridge Change front transmission gear oil (3.2 JTS 4x4 versions) Change engine oil and oil filter (1.8 140 HP versions) (or every 12 months) Change engine oil and oil filter (1750 TURBO BENZINA versions) (**) (or every 12 months) Change engine oil and oil filter (3.2 JTS and 2.2 JTS Selespeed versions) (or every 24 months) (***) Change engine oil and oil filter (diesel versions with DPF) (**) (or every 24 months) Change engine oil and oil filter (diesel versions without DPF) (or every 24 months) Change brake fluid (or every 24 months) Change pollen filter (or every 24 months) 35 70 105 140 175 ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● (*) Regardless of the km covered, the timing belt shall be replaced every 4 years for particularly demanding use (cold climates, driving in the city, idling for a long time) or in any case every 5 years. (**) The engine oil and the filter must be changed when the instrument panel warning light comes on (see “Warning lights and Messages” chapter) and in all cases every 24 months. If the car is mainly used for town driving or in particularly harsh climate conditions and has a low annual mileage, the engine oil and filter should be changed every 12 months. ❒ engine coolant fluid level; ❒ brake fluid level; ❒ windscreen washer fluid level; ❒ tyre pressure and conditions. ❒ check light system operation (headlights, direction indicators, hazard lights, etc.); ❒ check windscreen wiper/washer operation and windscreen/rear window blade position/wear; Every 3,000 km check and top up if required: engine oil level. You are recommended to use PETRONAS LUBRICANTS products, designed and produced specifically for Alfa Romeo cars (see table “Capacities” in section “Technical specifications”). ❒ sight inspect the conditions of: engine, gearbox, transmission, pipes and hoses (exhaust - fuel - brakes), rubber parts (boots, sleeves, bushes, etc.); Should prevailing use of the car be under one of the following specially heavy conditions: ❒ check battery charge and fluid level (electrolyte); ❒ trailer or caravan towing; ❒ dusty roads; ❒ short distances (less than 7-8 km) and repeated with external temperatures below zero; ❒ frequently idling engines or long distance low speed driving (e.g.: doorto-door deliveries) or in case of a long term inactivity; ❒ urban routes; carry out checks more frequently than required on Service Schedule: ❒ check front disk brake pad conditions and wear; ❒ check cleanness of bonnet and boot locks and lever cleanness and lubrication; ❒ visual check on various drive belt conditions; ❒ change engine oil and oil filter, if required; ❒ check and replace pollen filter, if required; ❒ check and replace air cleaner, if required. SAFETY DEVICES Every 1,000 km or before long journeys, check and top up if required: USE OF THE CAR UNDER HEAVY CONDITIONS CORRECT USE OF THE CAR PERIODICAL CHECKS DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 227 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:11 CAR TECHNICAL IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 INDEX 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 227 INDEX CAR TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 3-12-2009 14:11 Pagina 228 CHECKING FLUID LEVELS For refilling amounts refer to Technical Specifications section. When topping up take care not to confuse the various types of fluids: they are all incompatible with one another and could seriously damage the car. WARNING Never smoke while working in the engine compartment; gas and inflammable vapours may be present, with the risk of fire. 6 3 5 2 4 1. Engine oil - 2. Battery 3. Brake fluid - 4. Windscreen washer fluid - 5. Engine coolant 6. Power steering fluid 1 fig. 2 - 1750 TURBO BENZINA version 228 A0E0374m fig. 1 - 1.8 140 HP version A0E0854m 3-12-2009 14:11 Pagina 229 1. Engine oil - 2. Battery 3. Brake fluid - 4. Windscreen washer fluid - 5. Engine coolant 6. Power steering fluid A0E0161m CAR TECHNICAL IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY fig. 3 - 2.2 JTS Selespeed version WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 223-248 Alfa 159 GB INDEX 1. Engine oil - 2. Battery 3. Brake fluid - 4. Windscreen washer fluid - 5. Engine coolant 6. Power steering fluid fig. 3/a - 3.2 JTS version A0E0038m 229 3-12-2009 14:11 Pagina 230 1. Engine oil - 2. Battery 3. Brake fluid - 4. Windscreen washer fluid - 5. Engine coolant 6. Power steering fluid INDEX CAR TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 5 6 3 2 4 1 1. Engine oil - 2. Battery 3. Brake fluid - 4. Windscreen washer fluid - 5. Engine coolant 6. Power steering fluid fig. 5 - 2.0 JTDM version 230 A0E0162m fig. 4 - 1.9 JTDM 8v - 1.9 JTDM 16v versions IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 223-248 Alfa 159 GB A0E0853m 3-12-2009 14:11 Pagina 231 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES A0E0203m CAR TECHNICAL IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY fig. 6 - 2.4 JTDM version INDEX 1. Engine oil - 2. Battery 3. Brake fluid - 4. Windscreen washer fluid - 5. Engine coolant 6. Power steering fluid CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 231 3-12-2009 14:11 Pagina 232 fig. 7 A0E0400m fig. 8/a A0E0018m fig. 11 A0E0855m fig. 8 A0E0856m fig. 9 A0E0069m fig. 12 A0E0202m INDEX CAR TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 232 ENGINE OIL Checking engine oil Fig. 7: 1.8 140 HP version Fig. 8: 1750 TURBO BENZINA version Fig. 8/a: 2.2 JTS Selespeed version Fig. 9: 3.2 JTS version Fig. 10: 1.9 JTDM 8V 1.9 JTDM 16V versions Fig. 11: 2.0 JTDM version Fig. 12: 2.4 JTDM version Check the oil level a few minutes (about 5) after the engine has stopped, with the car parked on level ground. fig. 10 A0E0233m Remove the dipstick A and clean it, put it back in completely, remove it and check that the level is within the MIN and MAX marks on the dipstick. The gap between the MIN and MAX marks corresponds to about one litre of oil. If the oil level is near or even below the MIN mark, add oil through the filler neck B, until reaching the MAX mark. Oil level shall never exceed the MAX mark. Max engine oil consumption is usually 400 grams every 1000 km. IMPORTANT If a routine check reveals that the oil level is above the MAX mark, contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services to have the correct level restored. IMPORTANT After adding or changing the oil, let the engine turn over for a few seconds and wait a few minutes after turning it off before you check the level. When the car is new, the engine needs to run in, therefore the engine oil consumption can only be considered stabilised after the first 5000 - 6000 km. IMPORTANT The oil consumption depends on driving style and the conditions under which the car is used. IMPORTANT Do not add oil with specifications other than that already in the engine. WARNING When the engine is hot, take care when working inside the engine compartment to avoid burns. Remember that when the engine is hot, the fan may cut in: danger of injury. Scarves, ties and other loose clothing might be pulled by moving parts. Used engine oil and filter contain harmful substances for the environment. Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services to have the oil and filter changed. SAFETY DEVICES Engine oil consumption CORRECT USE OF THE CAR Topping up engine oil DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 233 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:11 CAR TECHNICAL IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 INDEX 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 233 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 3-12-2009 14:11 Pagina 234 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS WARNING INDEX CAR TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES Do not remove the reservoir cap when the engine is hot: you risk scalding yourself. 234 fig. 13 A0E0017m ENGINE COOLANT FLUID fig. 13 If the level is low, pour slowly a mixture of 50% distilled water and 50% PARAFLU UP through the filler neck A. A 50% mixture of distilled water and PARAFLU UP gives freeze protection to –35°C. Unter besonders strengen klimatischen Bedingungen empfehlen wir eine Mischung aus 60% PARAFLU UP und 40% demineralisiertem Wasser. fig. 14 The cooling system uses PARAFLU UP that shall be used for topping up and that cannot be mixed with other types of fluids. Should other fluids be added, do not start the engine and contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services as soon as possible. WARNING The cooling system is pressurised. If necessary, replace the cap only with another genuine one, otherwise system efficiency could be compromised. A0E0029m WINDSCREEN/HEADLIGHT WASHER FLUID fig. 14 To top up, remove the cap A and then pour a mixture of water and TUTELA PROFESSIONAL SC 35, in the following concentrations: ❒ 30% TUTELA PROFESSIONAL SC 35 and 70% water in summer; ❒ 50% TUTELA PROFESSIONAL SC 35 and 50% water in winter. In case of temperatures below –20°C, use undiluted TUTELA PROFESSIONAL SC 35. Pagina 235 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS WARNING Certain commercial additives for windscreen washers are inflammable. The engine compartment contains hot components which may set it on fire. POWER STEERING FLUID fig. 15-16 Check that the fluid level in the reservoir is at maximum level: this operation shall be carried out with the car on level surface, engine not running and cold. Check that the fluid level is at the MAX mark on the reservoir or at the top mark (maximum level) shown on the dipstick under the reservoir cap. A0E0027m fig. 15 - 1.8 140 CV 1750 TURBO BENZINA 2.2 JTS Selespeed - 2.4 JTDM versions A0E0234m fig. 16 - 3.2 JTS - 1.9 JTDM 8V 1.9 JTDM 16V - 2.0 JTDM versions If the fluid level in the reservoir is below the specified level, top up as follows: IMPORTANT For this operation it is however recommended to always contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. ❒ start the engine and wait until the fluid level in the reservoir has stabilized; ❒ with the engine started, turn repeatedly the steering wheel fully rightwards and leftwards; ❒ top up until reaching the MAX mark then refit the cap. WARNING Do not allow the power steering fluid to touch the hot parts of the engine: it is inflammable. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR WARNING SAFETY DEVICES Do not travel with the windscreen washer reservoir empty. The windscreen washer is fundamental for improving visibility. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:11 CAR TECHNICAL IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 INDEX 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 235 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 3-12-2009 14:11 Pagina 236 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS IMPORTANT For this operation it is however recommended to contact Alfa Romeo Authorised Services. INDEX CAR TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES From time to time, check the instrument panel warning light x: pressing on cap A (with key fitted into the ignition device) the warning light shall turn on. 236 fig. 17 A0E0016m BRAKE FLUID fig. 17 Check that the fluid level in the reservoir is at maximum. Top up with the brake fluid specified in the table “Fluids and lubricants” (see section “Technical Specifications "). NOTE Clean accurately the tank cap A and the surrounding surface. When opening the cap take the utmost care to prevent impurities entering the tank. When topping up, always use a funnel with built-in filter with mesh equal to or lower than 0.12 mm. IMPORTANT Brake fluid absorbs moisture. For this reason, if the car is mainly used in areas with a high degree of atmospheric humidity, the fluid should be replaced at more frequent intervals than specified in the Service schedule. WARNING Brake fluid is poisonous and highly corrosive. In the event of accidental contact, wash the parts involved immediately with neutral soap and water, then rinse thoroughly. Call the doctor immediately if the fluid is swallowed. WARNING Make sure that the highly corrosive brake fluid does not drip onto the paintwork. If it does, wash it off immediately with water. Symbol π on the container indicates synthetic brake fluid, distinguishing it from the mineral kind. Using mineral fluids irreversibly damages the special braking system rubber seals. The battery does not require top ups of distilled water to replenish the electrolyte. A periodic check carried out at an Alfa Romeo Authorised Services is, however, necessary to check efficiency. IMPORTANT The charge in the battery should be checked at the start of winter to limit the risk of electrolyte freezing. This check should be carried out more frequently if the car is used mainly for short trips, or if it is fitted with accessories that permanently absorb electricity also with the ignition key removed, especially in the case of after market accessories. After connecting/disconnecting the battery, wait for 3 minutes at least before fitting the electronic key into the ignition device in order to allow the climate control system control unit to reset the positions of the electric actuators that adjust air temperature and distribution. WARNING The liquid in the battery is poisonous and corrosive. Avoid contact with eyes and skin. Do not bring naked flames or possible sources of sparks near to the battery: risk of fire and explosion. WARNING Running the battery with low fluid level can damage the battery beyond repair and could also cause its explosion. SAFETY DEVICES Air cleaner or pollen filter replacement shall be carried out at Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. BATTERY CORRECT USE OF THE CAR AIR FILTER/ POLLEN FILTER DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 237 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:11 CAR TECHNICAL IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 INDEX 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 237 INDEX CAR TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 238 3-12-2009 14:11 Pagina 238 REPLACING THE BATTERY If required, replace the battery with a genuine spare part having the same specifications. If a battery with different specifications is fitted, the service intervals given in the Service schedule in this section will no longer be valid. Refer therefore to the instructions provided by the battery manufacturer. Incorrect fitting of electrical and electronic accessories can seriously damage the car. If after buying the car, you want to install electric accessories which require permanent electric supply (alarm, free-hand phone kit, etc.) contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services whose qualified personnel, in addition to suggesting the most suitable devices, will evaluate the overall electric absorption, checking whether the car’s electric system is capable of withstanding the load required, or whether it should be integrated with a more powerful battery. Batteries contain substances that are very harmful for the environment. You are advised to have the battery changed at Alfa Romeo Authorized Services, which is properly equipped for disposing of used batteries respecting nature and the law. WARNING If the car is left inactive for long periods at cold, remove the battery and store it in a warm place to prevent freezing. WARNING When working on the battery or near it, always wear the proper goggles. If after buying the car, you want to install electric accessories which require permanent electric supply (alarm, etc.) contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services whose qualified personnel, in addition to suggesting the most suitable devices available at Lineaccessori Alfa Romeo, will evaluate the overall electric absorption, checking whether the car’s electric system is capable of withstanding the load required, or whether it should be integrated with a more powerful battery. In fact, since these devices continue absorbing energy even when the ignition key is off, they gradually run down the battery. The total intake of these systems (factory and after-market) must be less than 0.6 mA x Ah (of the battery) as shown in the following table: Battery Maximum admitted stand-by intake 60 Ah 36 mA 70 Ah 42 mA 90 Ah 54 mA SAFETY DEVICES To avoid draining your battery and lengthen its life, observe the following indications: ❒ when you park the car, ensure the doors, tailgate and bonnet are closed properly; ❒ the ceiling lights must be off. The car is however provided with an automatic system for switching off internal lights; ❒ do not keep accessories (e.g.: sound system, hazard lights, etc.) switched on for a long time when the engine is not running; ❒ before performing any operation on the electrical system, disconnect the battery negative terminal cable; ❒ battery terminals shall always be perfectly tightened. IMPORTANT A battery which is kept at a charge of less than 50% for any length of time will be damaged by sulphation leading to a reduction in cranking power. Moreover, this might lead to a higher risk of the battery electrolyte freezing (this may even occur at –10°C). If the car is inactive for a long period of time, refer to “Car inactivity”, in section “Correct use of the car”. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR USEFUL ADVICE FOR LENGTHENING THE LIFE OF YOUR BATTERY DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 239 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:11 CAR TECHNICAL IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 INDEX 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 239 3-12-2009 14:11 Pagina 240 IMPORTANT NOTES WHEELS AND TYRES As far as possible, avoid sharp braking and screech starts, etc. Be careful not to hit the kerb, potholes or other obstacles hard. Driving for long stretches over bumpy roads can damage the tyres. Check the pressure of each tyre, including the space-saver spare wheel, every four weeks and before long journeys: pressure should be checked with the tyre rested and cold. fig. 18 A0E0120m Incorrect pressure causes abnormal tyre wear fig. 18: A normal pressure: tread evenly worn. C high pressure: tread particularly worn in the centre. INDEX CAR TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES For the correct tyre inflation pressure, see “Wheels” in “Technical specifications” section. IN AN EMERGENCY CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 240 B low pressure: tread particularly worn at the edges. Tyres must be replaced when the tread wears down to 1.6 mm. In any case, comply with the laws in the country where the car is being driven. Periodically check that the tyres have no cuts in the side wall, abnormal swelling or irregular tyre wear. If any of these occur, have the car seen to at Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. Avoid overloading the car when travelling: this may cause serious damage to the wheels and tyres; if a tyre is punctured, stop immediately and change it to avoid damage to the tyre, the rim, suspensions and steering system. In the case of replacement, always fit new tyres, avoiding those of dubious origin. If a tyre is changed, also change the inflation valve; to allow even wear between the front and rear tyres, it is advisable to change them over every 1015 thousand kilometres, keeping them on the same side of the car so as to not reverse the direction of rotation. WARNING If the pressure is too low the tyre overheats and this can cause it serious damage. WARNING Do not cross switch the tyres, moving them from the right of the car to the left and vice versa. WARNING Never submit alloy rims to repainting treatments requiring to use temperatures exceeding 150°C since the mechanical properties of the wheels could be impaired. SAFETY DEVICES WARNING Remember that road holding depends also on the correct tyre inflating pressure. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR Tyres age even if they are not used much. Cracks in the tread rubber are a sign of ageing. In any case, if the tyres have been on the car for over 6 years, they should be checked by specialised personnel, to see if they can still be used. Also remember to check the spacesaver spare wheel. DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 241 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:11 CAR TECHNICAL IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 INDEX 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 241 INDEX CAR TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 242 3-12-2009 14:11 Pagina 242 RUBBER HOSES As far as the brake system and fuel rubber hoses are concerned, carefully follow the Service schedule in this section. Indeed ozone, high temperatures and prolonged lack of fluid in the system may cause hardening and cracking of the hoses, with possible leaks. Careful control is therefore necessary. WINDSCREEN/REAR SCREEN WIPERS BLADES Periodically clean the rubber part using special products TUTELA PROFESSIONAL SC 35 is recommended. If the rubber blades are bent or worn they should be replaced. In any case they should be changed once a year. A few simple notions can reduce the possibility of damage to the blades: ❒ if the temperature fall below zero, make sure that ice has not frozen the rubber against glass. If necessary, thaw using an antifreeze product; ❒ remove any snow from the glass: in addition to protecting the blades, this prevents effort on the motor and overheating; ❒ do not operate the windscreen wipers on dry glass. WARNING Driving with worn wiper blades is a serious hazard, because visibility is reduced in bad weather. If the jet of fluid is missing, firstly check that there is fluid in the reservoir: see “Checking fluid levels” in this section). Regularly check that the spray jets are intact and clean. Then check that the nozzle holes are not clogged, if necessary use a needle. fig. 19 A0E0080m Changing the windscreen wiper blades fig. 19 How to remove the blade: – raise the windscreen wiper arm A; – turn the blade B by 90° around pin C, on the final section of the arm; – remove the blade from the pin C. How to refit the new blade: – fit pin C into the hole in the middle of the blade B; – refit the arm with the blade on the windscreen. Fluid jets shall be directed at about 1/3 height from the window upper edge. The headlight washers are automatically switched on when the windscreen washer is operated and the dipped beams are on. SAFETY DEVICES HEADLIGHT WASHERS CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SPRAY NOZZLES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 243 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:11 CAR TECHNICAL IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 INDEX 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 243 INDEX CAR TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 244 3-12-2009 14:11 Pagina 244 BODYWORK PROTECTION FROM ATMOSPHERIC AGENTS The main causes of corrosion are the following: ❒ atmospheric pollution; ❒ salty air and humidity (coastal areas, or hot humid climates); ❒ seasonal environment conditions. Not to be underestimated is also the abrasive action of wind-borne atmospheric dust and sand and mud and gravel raised by other cars. On your car, Alfa Romeo implemented the best manufacturing technologies to effectively protect the bodywork against corrosion. These include: ❒ Painting products and systems which give the car particular resistance to corrosion and abrasion; ❒ Use of galvanised (or pretreated) steel sheets, with high resistance to corrosion; ❒ Spraying of plastic parts, with a protective function, in the more exposed points: underdoor, inner fender parts, edges, etc.; ❒ Use of “open” boxed sections to prevent condensation and pockets of moisture from triggering rust inside; ❒ use of special anti-abrasion protective tapes in the most exposed areas (e.g.: rear mudguard, rear door, etc.). BODY AND UNDERBODY WARRANTY Your car is covered by warranty against perforation due to rust of any original element of the structure or body. For the general terms of this warranty, refer to the Alfa Romeo Warranty booklet. Paint ❒ remove the aerial from the roof to prevent damage to it if the car is washed in an automatic system; Paintwork does not only serve an aestethic purpose, but also protects the underlying sheet metal. In the case of deep scrapes or scores, you are advised to have the necessary touching up carried out immediately to avoid the formation of rust. Use only original paint products for touching up (see “Bodywork paint identification plate” in section “Technical specification”). Normal paint maintenance consists in washing at intervals depending on the conditions and environment of use. For example, in highly polluted areas, or if the roads are sprayed with salt, it is wise to wash the car more frequently. ❒ wash the body using a low pressure jet of water; ❒ wipe a sponge with a slightly soapy solution over the bodywork, frequently rinsing with the sponge; ❒ rinse well with water and dry with a jet of air or a chamois leather. When drying, take particular care with the less visible parts like door surrounds, bonnet and around the headlights where water may stagnate. The car should not be taken to a closed area immediately, but left in the open so that residual water can evaporate. Do not wash the car after it has been left in the sun or with the bonnet hot: this may alter the shine of the paintwork. Detergents cause water pollution. Therefore the car should be washed in areas equipped for collecting and purifying the liquid used in the washing process. To keep intact the aesthetic properties of the paintwork do not use abrasive and/or polish products for cleaning the car bodywork. Exterior plastic parts must be cleaned in the same way as the rest of the car. Where possible, do not park under trees; the resinous substance many species release give the paint a dull appearance and increase the possibility of triggering rust processes. IMPORTANT Bird droppings must be washed off immediately and thoroughly as the acid they contain is particularly aggressive. SAFETY DEVICES To wash the car correctly proceed as follows: CORRECT USE OF THE CAR ADVICE FOR PRESERVING THE BODYWORK DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 245 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:11 CAR TECHNICAL IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 INDEX 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 245 INDEX CAR TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 246 3-12-2009 14:11 Pagina 246 Windows Front headlights Engine compartment Use specific window cleaner products. Use also clean cloths to avoid scratching the glass or damaging the transparency. Front headlights shall be washed with soft cloth moistened with water and car detergent. At the end of the winter the engine compartment should be carefully washed, without directing the jet against electronic control units. Contact a specialised workshop to have this done. IMPORTANT The inside of the rearscreen should be wiped gently with a cloth in the direction of the filaments to avoid damaging the heating device. IMPORTANT Cleaning headlight lenses with a dry cloth will damage the headlights with lack of performance as a consequence. Solvents mat the lenses with lack of performance as a consequence. IMPORTANT When washing the front headlights with a water monitor nozzle keep at least 2 cm away from the lenses. IMPORTANT The car should be washed with the engine cold and the key removed from the ignition device. After washing make sure that the various protections (e.g. rubber caps and various covers) have not been damaged or removed. Remove dried on dirt with lightly moistened chamois leather or cloth without pressing too hard. CLEANING SEATS AND FABRIC AND VELVET PARTS Remove liquid or grease stains with a dry absorbent cloth without rubbing. Then wipe with a soft cloth or chamois leather with water and neutral soap. Use a soft brush or vacuum cleaner to remove dust. Velvet is cleaned better if the brush is moistened. If the stain persists, use specific products, carefully following the instructions for use. Rub the seats with a sponge moistened with a solution of water and neutral detergent. IMPORTANT Never use spirit or alcohol-based products. Upholstery of your car has been designed to withstand wear deriving from common use of the car. You are however recommended to avoid strong and/or continuous scratching with clothing accessories such as metallic buckles, studs, Velcro fastenings and the like, since these items cause circumscribed stress of the cover fabric that could lead to yarn breaking, and damage the cover as a consequence. SAFETY DEVICES Periodically check that water is not trapped under the mats (due to water dripping off shoes, umbrellas, etc.) which could cause oxidisation of the sheet metal. LEANING LEATHER SEATS (for versions/markets, where provided) CORRECT USE OF THE CAR INTERIORS DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 247 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 14:11 CAR TECHNICAL IN AN SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 INDEX 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 247 INDEX CAR TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 223-248 Alfa 159 GB 248 3-12-2009 14:11 Pagina 248 INTERIOR PLASTIC PARTS Clean plastic parts with a cloth moistened with water and non-abrasive neutral detergent. To remove grease or hard stains, use appropriate products designed to preserve the appearance of components. IMPORTANT Never use spirit or petroleum to clean the instrument panel or other plastic parts. WARNING Never use flammable products like oil ether or rectified petrol for cleaning car interiors. Electrostatic discharges generated by rubbing during cleaning operations could cause fire. WARNING Do not keep aerosol cans in the car: they might explode. Aerosol cans must never be exposed to a temperature above 50°C. The temperature inside the car exposed to the sun may go well beyond that figure. STEERING WHEEL/ GEAR LEVER KNOB WITH GENUINE LEATHER COVERING (for versions/markets, where provided) These components shall only be cleaned with water and neutral soap. Never use spirit or alcohol-based products. Before using special products for cleaning interiors, read carefully label instructions and indications to make sure they are free from spirit and/or alcoholbased substances. If when cleaning the windscreen with special glass products, some drops fall on the leather covering of the steering wheel/gear lever knob remove them immediately and then clean with water and neutral soap. IMPORTANT Take the utmost care when engaging the steering lock to prevent scratching the leather covering. IDENTIFICATION DATA ........................................ 250 ENGINE CODES - BODYWORK VERSIONS............... 252 ENGINE .......................................................... 253 SAFETY DEVICES T E C H N I C A L S P E C I F I C AT I O N S DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 249 BRAKES ........................................................... 256 STEERING ........................................................ 256 SUSPENSIONS.................................................. 256 WHEELS .......................................................... 257 DIMENSIONS.................................................... 261 PERFORMANCE ................................................. 263 WEIGHTS......................................................... 264 CAPACITIES ...................................................... 266 FLUIDS AND LUBRICANTS ................................... 267 FUEL CONSUMPTION ......................................... 269 CO2 EMISSIONS .............................................. 270 RADIO FREQUENCY REMOTE CONTROL: MINISTERIAL CERTIFICATIONS ............................. 271 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES TRANSMISSION ............................................... 255 CORRECT USE OF THE CAR FUEL FEED/IGNITION ........................................ 255 IN AN EMERGENCY 15:51 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 249-270 Alfa 159 GB 249 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 249-270 Alfa 159 GB 250 3-12-2009 15:51 Pagina 250 IDENTIFICATION DATA You are advised to note the identification codes. The identification data stamped and given on the plates and their position are the following fig. 1: 1 - Identification label fig. 1 A0A0045m 2 - Body label IDENTIFICATION LABEL 3 - Bodywork paint identification label This is to be found in the engine compartment, aside the upper right shockabsorber connection and it bears the following identification data: 4 - Engine label. fig. 2 A0E0013m C. Space available for maximum weights authorised by various national regulations D.Space for version and any supplementary indications to those specified A. Space for details of national homologation E. Space for smoke coefficient (diesel versions only) B. Space for punching the consecutive chassis number F. Space for punching the Manufacturer’s name. 3-12-2009 15:51 Pagina 251 ENGINE MARKING It can be reached by raising cover A-fig. 3 and it includes: ❒ type of vehicle (ZAR 939000); ❒ Manufacturer’s serial number (chassis number). BODYWORK PAINT IDENTIFICATION LABEL This is located in the inner side of the tailgate fig. 4 and it includes: A. Paint manufacturer B. Name of colour C. Colour code. D. Colour code for touching up and respraying. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES This is located on the passenger compartment floor near the front passenger’s seat. A0A0222m IN AN EMERGENCY BODYWORK LABEL fig. 4 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE A0A0175m INDEX fig. 3 CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES Engine marking is stamped on the gearbox side, on the rear left side. DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 249-270 Alfa 159 GB 251 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 249-270 Alfa 159 GB 3-12-2009 INDEX Pagina 252 ENGINE CODES - BODYWORK VERSIONS Versions Engine code Bodywork version 1.8 140 HP 1750 TURBO BENZINA (***) 3.2 JTS 4x2 3.2 JTS 4x4 1.9 JTDM 8v 939A4000 939B1000 939A000 939A000 939A1000 939A7000 (Õ) 939AXL1A 21C / 939BXL1A 22C () 939AXN1B 52 (**) / 939BXN1B 53 () (**) 939AXG1B 44 / 939BXG1B 45 () 939AXG2B 09B / 939BXG2B 16B () 939AXE1B 04C 939AXH1B 06D (Õ) 939BXE1B 14C () 939BXH1B 17D ()(Õ) 939AXE1B 04D () 939BXE1B 14D () () 939AXC1B 01E () 939BXC1B 12G () () 939AXC1B 01F () 939BXC1B 12H () () 939AXF1B 05D () (Õ) 939BXF1B 15F () () (Õ) 939AXP1B 54 (**) 939AXP1B 54B 939BXP1B 55 () (**) 939BXP1B 55B () 939AXP1B 54C () 939BXP1B 55C () () 939AXQ1B 62 () / 939BXQ1B 63 () () 939AXM1B 39B / 939BXM1B 40B () 939AXM2B 35B / 939BXM2B 36B () 1.9 JTDM 16v 939A2000 939A8000 (Õ) 2.0 JTDM (***) 939B3000 2.0 JTDM (***) (Õ) 2.4 JTDM 4x2 2.4 JTDM 4x4 844A2000 939A9000 939A9000 () Sportwagon versions 252 15:51 (Õ) For specific markets (**) Pack TI (***) Euro 5 versions () ECO versions Engine code Cycle Number and layout of cylinders Valves per cylinder 1.8 140 HP 1750 TURBO BENZINA 2.2 JTS (*) 3.2 JTS 939A4000 939B1000 939A5000 939A000 Otto Otto Otto Otto 4 in line 4 in line 4 in line 6 in 60° V 4 4 4 4 Piston bore and stroke mm 80.5 x 88.2 83.0 x 80.5 86 X 94.6 89 X 85.6 Total displacement cm3 1796 1742 2198 3195 Maximum power (EEC) kW HP rpm 103 140 6500 147 200 5000 136 185 6500 191 260 6200 Nm kgm rpm 175 17.8 3800 320 32.6 1400 230 23.4 4500 322 32.8 4500 BOSCH FQR8 LEU2 NGK ILKAR7D6G NGKFR5CP BOSCH HR7MPP152 Unleaded petrol 95 RON (Specification EN228) Unleaded petrol 95 RON (Specification EN228) corresponding ratio Maximum torque (EEC) corresponding ratio Spark plugs Fuel Unleaded petrol Unleaded petrol 95 RON 95 RON (Specification EN228) (Specification EN228) SAFETY DEVICES GENERAL CORRECT USE OF THE CAR ENGINE DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 253 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 15:51 IN AN EMERGENCY 3-12-2009 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 249-270 Alfa 159 GB To change plugs contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. INDEX (*) Selespeed version 253 3-12-2009 1.9 JTDM 8v (*) Engine code 939A1000 939A7000 939A2000 Cycle Number and layout of cylinders Valves per cylinder 1.9 1.9 JTDM 16v JTDM 16v (*) Diesel Diesel Diesel Diesel 4 in line 4 in line 4 in line 4 in line 4 in line 5 in line 5 in line 2 2 4 4 4 4 4 82 x 90,4 83.0 x 90.4 82 X 90.4 82 x 90.4 1910 1956 2387 2387 110 150 4000 100 136 4000 120 (*)/125 163 (*)/170 4000 147 200 4000 154 210 4000 280 28.6 2000 320 32.6 2000 305 31 2000 360 36.7 1750 400 40.8 2000 400 40.8 1500 – – – – – – 82 x 90.4 Total displacement cm3 1910 1910 1910 Maximum power (EEC) kW HP rpm 88 120 4000 85 115 4000 Nm kgm rpm 280 28.6 2000 – IN AN EMERGENCY 82 x 90,4 Fuel (*) For specific markets (**) QTronic gearbox versions 939A8000 939B3000 939A3000 939A9000 844A2000 (*) Diesel 82 x 90.4 Spark plugs 2.4 JTDM 2.4 JTDM 200 HP 210 HP (**) Diesel mm Maximum torque (EEC) 2.0 JTDM Diesel Piston bore and stroke corresponding ratio INDEX Pagina 254 1.9 JTDM 8v corresponding ratio 254 15:51 GENERAL TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 249-270 Alfa 159 GB Diesel fuel Diesel fuel Diesel fuel Diesel fuel Diesel fuel Diesel fuel Diesel fuel for motor for motor for motor for motor for motor for motor for motor vehicles vehicles vehicles vehicles vehicles vehicles vehicles (Specification (Specification (Specification (Specification (Specification (Specification (Specification EN590) EN590) EN590) EN590) EN590) EN590) EN590)) 1750 TURBO BENZINA 2.2 JTS - 3.2 JTS 1.9 JTDM 8V 1.9 JTDM 16v - 2.0 JTDM 2.4 JTDM Multipoint fuel injection Direct injection Direct injection, Common Rail WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES Modifications or repairs to the fuel feed system that are not carried out properly or do not take the system’s technical specifications into account can cause malfunctions leading to the risk of fire. TRANSMISSION 1.8 140 HP 1750 TURBO BENZINA 3.2 JTS 4x2 - 1.9 JTDM 8V 1.9 JTDM 16v 2.4 JTDM 200 HP 2.0 JTDM - 2.4 JTDM 210 HP 2.4 JTDM 210 HP 4x4 3.2 JTS 4x4 Five forward gears + reverse and synchronisers for speeds Six forward gears + reverse and synchronisers for speeds Six forward gears + reverse and synchronisers for speeds Clutch Dry single disk with hydraulic control Dry single disk with hydraulic control Dry single disk with hydraulic control Drive Front Front Four-wheel drive Gearbox IMPORTANT In the event of difficult disengagement, due to significant difference of grip between front and rear axle, do not insist with heavy accelerations: it is actually more effective an attempt of disengagement at medium slow engine rpm, with pauses of a few seconds if several attempts are necessary. IN AN EMERGENCY Fuel feed 1.8 140 HP SAFETY DEVICES FUEL FEED/IGNITION DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 255 CORRECT USE OF THE CAR 15:51 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 249-270 Alfa 159 GB 255 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 249-270 Alfa 159 GB 256 3-12-2009 15:51 Pagina 256 BRAKES 1.8 140 HP - 1750 TURBO BENZINA - 2.2 JTS 1.9 JTDM 8v - 1.9 JTDM 16v - 2.0 JTDM 3.2 JTS - 2.4 JTDM Service brakes: – front – rear Parking brake Disc, self-ventilating Disc Disc, self-ventilating Disc, self-ventilating Controlled by hand lever, it works on rear brakes IMPORTANT Water, ice and antifreeze salt on roads may deposit on the brake discs thus reducing braking efficiency at first braking. STEERING 1.8 140 HP - 1750 TURBO BENZINA - 2.2 JTS - 3.2 JTS 1.9 JTDM 8V - 1.9 JTDM 16v - 2.0 JTDM - 2.4 JTDM Type Turning radius (between pavements) Rack and pinion with hydraulic power steering 11.1 SUSPENSIONS 1.8 140 HP - 1750 TURBO BENZINA - 2.2 JTS - 3.2 JTS - 1.9 JTDM 8V 1.9 JTDM 16v - 2.0 JTDM - 2.4 JTDM Front High quadrilateral system Rear Multi-link system IMPORTANT In the event of discrepancies between the information provided on this “Owner’s Manual” and the “Log book”, consider the specifications shown in the log book only. On cars fitted with four-wheel drive, all four tyres should be the same (brand and track) to prevent damaging the 4WD system. The efficiency of the 4-WD system however, is not jeopardized if tyres with different wear conditions are fitted. Attaining to the prescribed size, to ensure safety of the car in movement, it must be fitted with tyres of the same make and type on all wheels. IMPORTANT Do not use inner tubes with Tubeless tyres. SPACE-SAVER SPARE WHEEL Pressed steel rim. Tubeless tyre. A0E0186m fig. 5 UNDERSTANDING TYRE MARKING fig. 5 Example: 205/55 R 16 91 V 205= Nominal width (S, distance between sidewalls in mm). 55 = Percentage height/width ratio (H/S). R = Radial tyre. 16 = Rim diameter in inches. (Ø). 91 = Load rating (capacity). V = Maximum speed index. SAFETY DEVICES Pressed steel or alloy rims. Tubeless tyres with radial carcass. The homologated tyres are listed in the Log book. 84 = 500 kg 85 = 515 kg 86 = 530 kg 87 = 545 kg 88 = 560 kg 89 = 580 kg 90 = 600 kg 91 = 615 kg 92 = 630 kg 93 = 650 kg 94 = 670 kg 95 = 690 kg 96 = 710 kg 97 = 730 kg 98 = 750 kg 99 = 775 kg 100 = 800 kg 101 = 825 kg 102 = 850 kg 103 = 875 kg 104 = 900 kg 105 = 925 kg 106 = 950 kg CORRECT USE OF THE CAR RIMS AND TYRES 60 = 250 kg 61 = 257 kg 62 = 265 kg 63 = 272 kg 64 = 280 kg 65 = 290 kg 66 = 300 kg 67 = 307 kg 68 = 315 kg 69 = 325 kg 70 = 335 kg 71 = 345 kg 72 = 355 kg 73 = 365 kg 74 = 375 kg 75 = 387 kg 76 = 400 kg 77 = 412 kg 78 = 425 kg 79 = 437 kg 80 = 450 kg 81 = 462 kg 82 = 475 kg 83 = 487 kg WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES Load rating (capacity) WHEELS DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 257 IN AN EMERGENCY 15:51 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 249-270 Alfa 159 GB 257 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 249-270 Alfa 159 GB 258 3-12-2009 15:51 Pagina 258 Maximum speed rating Q = up to 160 km/h. R = up to 170 km/h. S = up to 180 km/h. T = up to 190 km/h. U = up to 200 km/h. H = up to 210 km/h. V = up to 240 km/h. W = up to 270 km/h. Y = up to 300 km/h. Maximum speed rating for snow tyres Q M + S = up to 160 km/h. T M + S = up to 190 km/h. H M + S = up to 210 km/h. UNDERSTANDING RIM MARKING fig. 5 Example: 7 J x 16 H2 ET 43 7 = rim width in inches 1. J = rim drop center outline (side projection where the tyre bead rests) 2. 16 = rim nominal diameter in inches (corresponds to diameter of the tyre to be mounted) (3 = Ø). H2 = “hump” shape and number (relief on the circumference holding the Tubeless tyre bead on the rim). 43 = wheel camber angle (distance between the disc/rim supporting plane and the wheel rim centre line). A0E0788m fig. 6 RIM PROTECTOR TYRES fig. 6 ATTENZIONE If after-sale tyres with rim protector are used (fig. 6) and the car has integral cups fixed (by springs) to the sheet wheel, DO NOT fit wheel cups. The use of unsuitable tyres and wheel cups could cause a sudden pressure loss of the tyre. For versions/markets, where provided TI Versions tyre rim 7Jx16” steel 7Jx16” steel 7,5Jx17” (*) alloy 8Jx19" alloy 205/55 R16 91V 205/55 R16 91V 225/50 R17 98W 235/40 ZR19 96Y (▼) tyre rim 7Jx16” steel 215/55 R16 93V 7Jx16” steel 215/55 R16 93V tyre rim 7Jx16” alloy 215/55 R16 93V 7Jx16” alloy 215/55 R16 93V tyre rim 7,5Jx17” (*) alloy 225/50 R17 98W 7,5Jx17” (*) alloy 225/50 R17 98W tyre rim 8Jx18” alloy 235/45 R18 98W (▼) Optionals Space-saver spare wheel (for versions/markets, where provided) tyre rim SAFETY DEVICES 1750 TURBO BENZINA 3.2 JTS - 2.4 JTDM 200 CV 2.4 JTDM 210 CV CORRECT USE OF THE CAR Standard tyres 1.9 JTDM 8V ECO 1.9 JTDM 8V (**) 2.0 JTDM ECO 2.0 JTDM (**) 8Jx18” alloy 235/45 R18 98W (▼) 4,00B x17" T125/80 R17 (*) Tyres that cannot be fitted with traditional snow chains. Only “spider” type chains can be used. (**) For specific markets IMPORTANT Snow tyres with speed index H or superior are recommended. (▼) Unchainable tyres. When using winter tyres, use 225/50 R17 98 tyres or 235/45 R18 98. Vehicles with TI fittings should not use 16” wheel rims. Also for 3.2 JTS and 2.4 JTDM 210 HP 4x4 version, snow chains shall be fitted on the FRONT axle of the car. Traditional snow chains may not be used on tyres type 225/50 R17” only spider type chains can be used. Tyres 235/45 R18” and 235/40 ZR19” cannot be fitted with snow chains due to interference with the fender. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES 1.8 140 HP 1.9 JTDM 8V 1.9 JTDM 16V 2.0 JTDM DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 259 IN AN EMERGENCY TYRES 15:51 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 249-270 Alfa 159 GB 259 CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 249-270 Alfa 159 GB 3-12-2009 Tyres Tyres Tyres Tyres Tyres 205/55 R16 91V 215/55 R16 93V 225/50 R17 98W 235/45 R18 98W (▼) 235/40 ZR19 96Y (▼) front rear front rear front rear front rear front rear average load bar 2.3 2.3 2.3 2.3 2.5 2.5 2.7 2.5 2.7 2.5 full load 2.6 2.6 2.5 2.5 2.9 2.7 2.9 2.7 3.0 2.8 bar Space-saver spare wheel T125/80 R17 4.2 (▼) Unchainable tyres. When using winter tyres, use 225/50 ZR17 96 tyres or 235/45 R18 98. Vehicles with TI fittings should not use 16” wheel rims. Add +0.3 bar to the prescribed inflation pressure when the tyres are warm. Recheck pressure value with cold tyres. With snow tyres, add +0.2 bar to the inflation pressure value prescribed for standard tyres. Inflate tyres to full load pressures if driving at continuous speed exceeding 160 km/h. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES – camber IN AN EMERGENCY Pagina 260 COLD TYRE INFLATION PRESSURE WHEEL ANGLES TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 15:51 Front wheels – caster – half toe-in (per wheel) – camber Rear wheels – half toe-in (per wheel) All types –35’ ± 18’ max. difference right/left: 24’ 4° 15’ ± 18’ max. difference right/left: 18’ –8’ ± 4’ max. difference right/left: 4’ –40’ ± 18’ max. difference right/left: 24’ 13’ ± 7’ (total toe-in: 26’ ± 7’) TI Versions 4x2 Versions 4x4 Versions –1° 1’± 18’ max. difference right/left: 24’ 4° 15’± 18’ max. difference right/left: 18’ –7’± 4’ max. difference right/left: 4’ –1° 3’± 18’ max. difference right/left: 24’ 11’± 7’ (total toe-in: 22’± 7’) –38’±18’ max. difference right/left: 24’ 4° 15’ ± 18’ max. difference right/left: 18’ –7’ ± 4’ max. difference right/left: 4’ –1° 3’ ± 18’ max. difference right/left: 24’ 11’ ± 7’ (total toe-in: 22’ ± 7’) INDEX VEHICLE GEOMETRY The TI fittings present lower suspensions around of 20 mm with respects to the other versions. 260 Warning: lowered trim car, pay attention when driving on ramps, humps or on particularly rough routes. 3-12-2009 15:51 Pagina 261 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS DIMENSIONS SAFETY DEVICES Dimensions are expressed in mm and refer to the car fitted with standard tyres. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR Min. size variations when optional tyres are fitted. WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES The height refers to the car unladen. BOOT VOLUME A0E0044m A B C D E F G H 4660 1000 2700 960 1422 1417 (■) 1578 1593 (■) 1828 1555 1573 (■) (■) With tyres 215/55 R16” TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY Boot volume .............. 405 dm3 INDEX 249-270 Alfa 159 GB 261 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 249-270 Alfa 159 GB 3-12-2009 15:51 Pagina 262 Dimensions are expressed in mm and refer to the car fitted with standard tyres. Min. size variations when optional tyres are fitted. The height refers to the car unladen. BOOT VOLUME Boot volume .............. 445 dm3 A0E0307m A B C D E F G H 4660 1000 2700 960 1422 1417 (■) 1578 1593 (■) 1828 1555 1573 (■) (■) With tyres 215/55 R16” (*) With roof racks/ski racks (where provided): 1452/1447 (with 215/55 R16" tyres) 262 Acceleration from 0-100 km/h sec. Kilometer with standing start sec. 208 235 250 244 193 197 194 212 218 215 231 227 10.2 7.7 7.1 7.0 10.7 10.7 11.0 9.2 8.8 9.0 8.1 8.3 31.1 28.9 27.0 27.3 32.6 32.8 33.2 30.6 30.2 30.5 28.7 29.0 Top speed km/h Acceleration from 0-100 km/h sec. Kilometer with standing start sec. 206 233 248 242 192 196 193 210 216 213 229 225 10.4 7.9 7.2 7.2 10.9 10.9 11.2 9.4 9.0 9.2 8.3 8.5 31.3 29.2 27.4 27.7 32.9 33.3 33.7 30.9 30.5 30.8 29.0 29.3 (*) For specific markets SPORTWAGON VERSIONS 1.8 140 HP 1750 TURBO BENZINA 3.2 JTS 4x2 3.2 JTS 4x4 1.9 JTDM 8v 1.9 JTDM 8v ECO 1.9 JTDM 8v ECO (*) 1.9 JTDM 16v 2.0 JTDM/2.0 JTDM ECO 2.0 JTDM ECO (*) 2.4 JTDM 4x2 2.4 JTDM 4x4 (*) For specific markets SAFETY DEVICES 1.8 140 HP 1750 TURBO BENZINA 3.2 JTS 4x2 3.2 JTS 4x4 1.9 JTDM 8v 1.9 JTDM 8v ECO 1.9 JTDM 8v ECO (*) 1.9 JTDM 16v 2.0 JTDM/2.0 JTDM ECO 2.0 JTDM ECO (*) 2.4 JTDM 4x2 2.4 JTDM 4x4 Top speed km/h CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SALOON VERSIONS WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES PERFORMANCE DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 263 IN AN EMERGENCY 15:51 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 249-270 Alfa 159 GB 263 3-12-2009 15:51 Pagina 264 1750 TURBO BENZINA 3.2 JTS 4x2 3.2 JTS 4x4 1.9 JTDM 8v 1.9 JTDM 16v 2.0 JTDM Weight empty (including fluids, 90% fuel in the tank and no optional) 1385 1430 1540 1610 1480 1490 1585 1645 Maximum admitted load (*) – front axle – rear axle – total 1100 1050 1935 1100 1050 1980 1220 1050 2090 1220 1050 2160 1150 1050 2030 1130 (Õ)/1150 1050 2040 1220 1050 2135 1220 1050 2195 Payload including driver (**) 550 550 550 550 550 550 550 550 Towable loads 1400 1500 1700 1700 1500 1500 1500 1500 Max. load on ball 60 60 70 70 60 60 60 60 Maximum load on roof 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 INDEX WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES 1.8 140 HP IN AN EMERGENCY WEIGHTS TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 249-270 Alfa 159 GB 264 Weights (kg) Saloon versions 2.4 JTDM 2.4 JTDM 4x2 4x4 (*) Loads not to be exceeded. The driver is responsible for arranging the loads in the boot an/or on the roof so that they comply with these limits. (**) If special equipment is fitted (sunroof, tow hitch etc.) the unladen weight increases, thus reducing the payload as specified in the maximum weight allowed. (Õ) 2.0 JTDM versions Pagina 265 1750 TURBO BENZINA 3.2 JTS 4x2 3.2 JTS 4x4 1.9 JTDM 8v 1.9 JTDM 16v 2.0 JTDM 2.4 JTDM 2.4 JTDM 4x2 4x4 Weight empty (including fluids, 90% fuel in the tank and no optional) 1435 1480 1590 1660 1530 1540 1635 1695 Maximum admitted load (*) – front axle – rear axle – total 1100 1050 1985 1100 1050 2030 1220 1050 2140 1220 1100 2210 1150 1050 2080 1130 (Õ)/1150 1050 2090 1220 1050 2185 1220 1100 2245 Payload including driver (**) 550 550 550 550 550 550 550 550 Towable loads 1400 1500 1800 1800 1500 1500 1500 1500 Max. load on ball 60 60 75 75 60 60 60 60 Maximum load on roof (***) 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 (*) Loads not to be exceeded. The driver is responsible for arranging the loads in the boot an/or on the roof so that they comply with these limits. (**) If special equipment is fitted (sunroof, tow hitch etc.) the unladen weight increases, thus reducing the payload as specified in the maximum weight allowed. (***) Lineaccessori Alfa Romeo roof rack, max capacity: 50 kg. (Õ) 2.0 JTDM versions IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES 1.8 140 HP Weights (kg) Sportwagon versions DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 15:51 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 249-270 Alfa 159 GB 265 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 249-270 Alfa 159 GB 3-12-2009 15:51 Pagina 266 CAPACITIES 1.8 1750 140 HP TURBO INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES BENZINA 266 3.2 JTS 1.9 JTDM 1.9 JTDM 2.0 JTDM 2.4 JTDM 2.4 JTDM 8v 16v 210 HP 4x4 litres 70 ● 70 ● 70 ● 70 ❍ 70 ❍ 70 ❍ 70 ❍ litres 10 ● 10 ● 10 ● 10 ❍ 10 ❍ 10 ❍ 10 ❍ Engine cooling system litres 8.0 6.6 10.3 7.5 7.5 6.1 7.35 Lubrication system engine litres 4.5 ■ 5.0  5.4 ■ 4.6  4.6  4.9  6.4 ❑ Mechanical gearbox/ differential litres 1.6 2.0 2.8 (Õ) 2.3 2.3 2.8 2.8 Windscreen/headlight washer fluid reservoir: litres 6.0 6.0 6.0 6.0 6.0 6.0 6.0 Fuel tank: – including a reserve of Specified fuels and original lubricants ● Unleaded petrol with no less than 95 R.O.N. (EN228 Specification) ❍ Diesel fuel for motor vehicles (EN590 Specification) Mixture of 50% water and PARAFLUUP (▲) ■ SELENIA StAR ❑ SELENIA WR  SELENIA StAR P.E. (1750 TURBO BENZINA versions)  SELENIA WR P.E. TUTELA CAR MATRYX (Õ) TUTELA MULTIAXLE Mixture of water and liquid TUTELA PROFESSIONAL SC 35 (▲) For particularly hard climate conditions, we recommend use of a 60% PARAFLUUP and 40% demineralized water mixture. Pagina 267 Lubricants for petrol engines (1.8 140 HP, 2.2 JTS and 3.2 JTS versions) Fluid and lubricant specifications for correct car operation Original fluids and lubricants Change Synthetic-based oil, grade SAE 5W-40, FIAT 9.55535-H2 qualification SELENIA StAR Contractual Technical Reference N° F216.D05 According to Service Schedule Lubricants for petrol engines (1750 TURBO BENZINA versions) Synthetic-based oil, grade SAE 5W-40, ACEA C3. FIAT 9.55535-S2 qualification. SELENIA StAR P.E. Contractual Technical Reference N° F603.D08 According to Service Schedule Lubricants for diesel engines (2.4 JTDM versions) Synthetic-based oil, grade SAE 5W-40 FIAT 9.55535-N2 qualification. SELENIA WR Contractual Technical Reference N° F515.D06 According to Service Schedule Lubricants for diesel engines (1.9 JTDM 8V, 1.9 JTDM 16V, 2.0 JTDM versions) Synthetic-based oil, grade SAE 5W-30. FIAT 9.55535-S1 qualification. SELENIA WR P.E. Contractual Technical Reference N° F510.D07 According to Service Schedule For diesel engines, in emergency cases where genuine products are not available, lubricants with min. performance ACEA B4 and ACEA C2 are accepted. If this is the case, the best engine performance is not guaranteed. We however recommend replacing the lubricant with those recommended by Alfa Romeo Authorized Services. Use of products with low-quality properties than ACEA A3 and ACEA B4 could cause damages to the engine that are not covered by the warranty. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR Use WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES RECOMMENDED PRODUCTS AND THEIR SPECIFICATIONS SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS FLUIDS AND LUBRICANTS IN AN EMERGENCY 15:51 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 249-270 Alfa 159 GB 267 3-12-2009 Use CORRECT USE OF THE CAR INDEX Pagina 268 Fluid and lubricant specifications for correct car operation Original fluids and lubricants Applications TUTELA CAR MATRYX Mechanical gearbox and differential Synthetic-based oil, grade SAE 75W-90 that passes API GL-5 specifications, ZF-TE ML 18. Qualification FIAT 9.55550-DA3 TUTELA MULTIAXLE Synthetic fluid for hydraulic and electrohydraulic systems. Qualification FIAT 9.55550-AG3. TUTELA GI/R Rear differential and transmission unit (3.2 JTS 4X4 and 2.4 JTDM 4x4 version) Power steering Grease containing Molybdenum bisulphide for high temperature appliances. NLGI 1-2 consistency. Qualification FIAT 9.55580. Grease for homokinetic joints with low friction coefficient. NLGI 0-1 consistency. Qualification FIAT 9.55580. TUTELA ALL STAR CV joints on wheel side TUTELA STAR 700 CV joints on differential side Synthetic fluid for Brake and clutch controls FMVSS n° 116 DOT 4, ISO 4925, SAE J1704, CUNA NC 956-01 Qualification FIAT 9.55597. Protective with antifreeze action, red colour based on inhibited monoethylen glycol and organic formula, that passes CUNA NC 956-16, ASTM D 3306 specifications. Qualification FIAT 9.555523. TUTELA TOP 4 Brake and clutch hydraulic controls PARAFLUUP (●) Radiator antifreeze Additive for diesel fluid Additive for diesel fuel with anti-freeze action, protecting Diesel engines. TUTELA DIESEL ART 50% PARAFLUUP (❏) To be mixed with fuel oil (25 cc per 10 litres) Windscreen/ headlight washer fluid Mixture of alcohol and surfactants CUNA NC 956-11. Qualification FIAT 9.55522. Lubricants and greases for transmission WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES IN AN EMERGENCY TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 268 15:51 Synthetic-based oil, grade SAE 75W-85 that passes API GL 4 specifications. Qualification FIAT 9.55550-MZ1 SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 249-270 Alfa 159 GB Brake fluid Protective agent for radiators Contractual Technical Reference N° F108.F02 Contractual Technical Reference N° F426.E06 Contractual Technical Reference N° F428.H04 Contractual Technical Reference N° F702.G07 Contractual Technical Reference N° F701.C07 Contractual Technical Reference N° F001.A93 proportion: Contractual Technical Reference N° F101.M01 50% water and Contractual Technical Reference N° F601.L06 To be used diluted TUTELA PROFESSIONAL SC 35 or undiluted Contractual Technical Reference N° F201.D02 (●) IMPORTANT Do not top up or mix with fluids having different specifications from those described here. (❏) For particularly hard climate conditions, we recommend use of a 60% PARAFLUUP and 40% demineralized water mixture. FUEL CONSUMPTION ACCORDING TO EUROPEAN DIRECTIVE IN FORCE (litres x 100 km) 1.8 140 HP 1750 TURBO BENZINA 3.2 JTS 4x2 3.2 JTS 4x4 1.9 JTDM 8v 1.9 JTDM 16v 2.0 JTDM 2.4 JTDM 4x2 2.4 JTDM 4x4 (❏) Saloon versions Urban Extra-urban Combined 10.3 () 6.0 () 7.6 () 10.7 (Õ) 6.1 (Õ) 7.8 (Õ) 6.0 () 8.1 () 11.8 () 12.0 (Õ) 6.2 (Õ) 8.3 (Õ) 16.4 () 7.9 () 11.0 () 16.5 (Õ) 7.9 (Õ) 11.0 (Õ) 8.3 () 11.4 () 16.7 () 17.0 (Õ) 8.3 (Õ) 11.5 (Õ) 7.8 ()/6.6 () () 4.8 ()/4.4 () () 5.9 ()/5.2 () () 7.9 (Õ)/6.7 (Õ) () 4.9 (Õ)/4.5 (Õ) () 6.0 (Õ)/5.3 (Õ) () 7.5 () 4.6 () 5.7 () 7.6 (Õ) 4.7 (Õ) 5.8 (Õ) 7.1 ()/6.6 ()() 4.4 ()/4.3 ()() 5.4 ()/5.1 ()() 7.2 (Õ)/6.7 (Õ)() 4.5 (Õ)/4.4 (Õ)() 5.5 (Õ)/5.2 (Õ)() 9.2 () 5.4 () 6.8 () 9.2 (Õ) 5.5 (Õ) 6.9 (Õ) 9.7 () 5.8 () 7.2 () 9.9 (Õ) 5.9 (Õ) 7.4 (Õ) (Õ) Sportwagon versions () ECO versions SAFETY DEVICES – combined consumption: is calculated weighing about 37% of urban cycle consumption and about 63% of extraurban consumption. IMPORTANT The type of route, traffic situations, weather conditions, driving style, general conditions of the car, trim level/ equipment/accessories, load, climate control system, roof rack, other situations that affect air drag may lead to different fuel consumption levels than those measured. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR The fuel consumption figures given in the table below are determined on the basis of the homologation tests set down by specific European Directives. The procedures below are followed for measuring consumption: – urban cycle: cold starting followed by driving that simulates urban use of the car; – extra-urban cycle: frequent accelerating in all gears, simulating extraurban use of the car; the speed varies between 0 and 120 km/h; WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES FUEL CONSUMPTION DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 269 IN AN EMERGENCY 15:51 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 3-12-2009 INDEX 249-270 Alfa 159 GB 269 3-12-2009 15:51 Pagina 270 CO2 EMISSIONS CO2 EMISSIONS ACCORDING TO EUROPEAN DIRECTIVE IN FORCE (g/km) Saloon versions INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES SAFETY DEVICES The CO2 emission levels given in the following tables refer to combined consumption. CORRECT USE OF THE CAR DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 249-270 Alfa 159 GB 270 1.8 1750 140 HP TURBO BENZINA 179 189 3.2 JTS 4X2 3.2 JTS 4X4 1.9 JTDM 8v 1.9 JTDM 16v 2.0 JTDM 2.4 JTDM 4X2 2.4 JTDM 4X4 260 270 157/138 (*) 150 142/136 (*) 179 192 3.2 JTS 4X2 3.2 JTS 4X4 1.9 JTDM 8v 1.9 JTDM 16v 2.0 JTDM 2.4 JTDM 4X2 2.4 JTDM 4X4 262 272 159/140 (*) 153 145/139 (*) 181 194 (*) ECO versions Sportwagon versions 1.8 1750 140 CV TURBO BENZINA 183 (*) ECO versions 194 Pagina 271 RADIO FREQUENCY REMOTE CONTROL: Ministerial Certifications Certification number T939 European Union and Countries applying EC directive NTR939 0523 0523 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 10:55 SAFETY DEVICES 8-04-2009 CORRECT USE OF THE CAR 271-292 Alfa 159 GB – N15278 Brazil ❒ HHHH-AA-FFFF ❒ HHHH-AA-FFFF Bulgaria China CMII ID : 2006DJ0352 ❒ Data unavailable at the time of printing. CMII ID : 2006DJ0351 IN AN EMERGENCY Australia TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE ❒ INDEX ❒ WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES Argentina 271 271-292 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:55 Pagina 272 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Certification number 272 T939 NTR939 Malaysia ❒ Mexico AA 000000 E ❒ Morocco Singapore YYYYXXXX-XXX YYYYXXXX-XXX ❒ AA 000000 E ❒ AGREE PAR L’ANRT MAROC Numéro d’agrément : MR 2395 ANRT 2006 Date d’agrément : 13/01/2006 AGREE PAR L’ANRT MAROC Numéro d’agrément : MR 2394 ANRT 2006 Date d’agrément : 13/01/2006 Complies with IDA Standards DA 104022 Complies with IDA Standards DA 104022 South Africa Taiwan ❒ Data unavailable at the time of printing. TA-2005/701 APPROVED TA-2005/702 APPROVED IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 10:55 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 8-04-2009 INDEX 271-292 Alfa 159 GB Pagina 273 273 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 271-292 Alfa 159 GB 274 8-04-2009 10:55 Pagina 274 8-04-2009 10:55 Pagina 275 A L FA 1 5 9 S P O R T WA G O N REARSCREEN WIPER ......................................... 276 BOOT .............................................................. 277 ROOF RACK/SKI RACK ...................................... 284 PRESETTING FOR MOUNTING THE "UNIVERSAL ISOFIX" CHILD RESTRAINT SYSTEM ... 285 IF AN EXTERIOR LIGHT BURNS OUT ..................... 288 IF AN INTERIOR LIGHT BURNS OUT ..................... 290 IF A FUSE BLOWS ............................................. 292 ALFA 159 SPORTWAGON 271-292 Alfa 159 GB 275 271-292 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:55 Pagina 276 REARSCREEN WIPER OPERATION ALFA 159 SPORTWAGON Rear window wiper activation/deactivation Turning the unstable ring nut A-fig. 1 to position ' ON/OFF will obtain flick wipe of the rear window wiper. To turn it off, turn the ring nut back to position ' ON/OFF. The activation of the rear windshield wiper occurs also with the front windshield wipe on and reverse gear inserted. Rear window "smart" washing Turning the unstable ring nut A-fig. 1 to position & will obtain rear window washing. Keeping the unstable ring nut at position & it will be possible to activate with just one movement both the windscreen wiper and the rear window wiper; the latter comes actually into action automatically when the unstable ring nut is kept at position & for over half a second. 276 fig. 1 A0E0264m fig. 2 A0E0267m The rear window wiper stops working a few strokes after releasing the ring nut; a further stroke after about 6 seconds completes the wiping operation. HANGING THE REARSCREEN WIPER BLADE Never use the wiper to remove ice or snow from the rear window. In these conditions, the wiper is submitted to excessive effort that results in motor protection cutting in and wiper operation inhibition for few seconds as a consequence. Should it be not possible to restore its operation, contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Service. ❒ position the new arm correctly, fully tighten the nut B and then lower the cover A. Proceed as follows: ❒ raise the cover A-fig. 2, slacken the nut B and remove the arm C; 271-292 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:55 Pagina 277 BOOT fig. 3 A0E0268m SPRAY NOZZLE If the jet of fluid is inadequate, firstly check that there is fluid in the reservoir (see "Checking fluid levels" in section "Car maintenance"). Then check that the nozzle holes Afig. 3 are not clogged, if necessary use a needle to clean them. To open the tailgate from the inside if the battery is flat or the electric tailgate lock is failing, proceed as follows: ❒ tilt the rear seats completely (see paragraph "Extending the boot" in section "Dashboard and controls"); fig. 4 A0E0269m fig. 5 A0E0263m ❒ remove the rear head restraints; ❒ take the screwdriver from the tool container and working inside the boot (on the rear part), fit it into seat A-fig. 4 and then operate lever Bfig. 5. ALFA 159 SPORTWAGON TAILGATE EMERGENCY OPENING FROM THE INSIDE 277 271-292 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:55 Pagina 278 EXTENDING THE BOOT The boot can be partially (1/3 or 2/3) or totally extended splitting the rear seat. Proceed as follows: ❒ lower completely the rear seat head restraints; ALFA 159 SPORTWAGON ❒ check that the seat belt is not twisted; 278 ❒ lift seat back lever A-fig. 6 to unlock respectively the left or right section of the backrest and tilt the seat back forward. Lever raising is indicated by a “red band” B. fig. 6 A0E0085m The boot extension to the right makes it possible to carry two passengers on the rear seat left-hand side. The boot extension to the left makes it possible to carry one passenger on the rear seat right-hand side. IMPORTANT ❒ before performing the operation of folding the backrest over, make sure that the rear head restraints are in the “rest” position (completely lowered). The head restraints can be removed to improve the load carrying capacity; ❒ before tilting the backrest, ensure that the rear armrest is not lowered. Otherwise, insert it in its seat (see section “Internal equipment” in chapter “Dashboard and controls”). 271-292 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:55 Pagina 279 To return the rear seat back to its original position Raise the seat backrests and push them back until hearing the locking click of both retainers. Position seat belt buckles upwards. ANCHORING THE LOAD Make sure the backrest is properly secured at both sides (red bands not visible) to prevent it moves forward in the event of sharp braking causing injuries to passengers. Hooks shall also be used to secure the luggage retaining net (for versions/ markets, where provided where applicable, at Alfa Romeo Authorised Services). fig. 8 A0E0270m The boot houses 4 hooks (see fig. 8 and fig. 9) for anchoring ropes in order to guarantee perfect load anchoring. A0E0271m fig. 9 WARNING A heavy load that has not been secured may cause serious harm. WARNING ALFA 159 SPORTWAGON IMPORTANT When the backrest is properly secured, the “red band” Bfig. 6 on levers A shall no longer be visible. The “red band” actually indicates that the backrest is not properly secured. Make sure the head restraints are properly positioned. If you want to carry reserve fuel in a can, follow law regulations, only using a certified can, suitably fastened to the load securing eyelets. Even in this way the risk of fire is increased in the case of an accident. 279 271-292 Alfa 159 GB ALFA 159 SPORTWAGON fig. 10 280 8-04-2009 10:55 Pagina 280 A0E0273m ODDMENT COMPARTMENTS fig. 10 - 11 The boot sides are equipped with two oddment compartments closed by a cover. To open the cover press button A and turn it downwards. fig. 11 A0E0272m CURRENT OUTLET (for versions/markets, where provided) The current outlet is located on the left side of the boot. To use the current outlet, open the lid A-fig. 12. The current outlet only works with the key fitted into the ignition device and can only be used to power accessories having max. 15A intake (180 W). fig. 12 A0E0274m Never use the outlet for accessories with power over the max. specified one. Long power intake can run down the battery and inhibit engine starting. 8-04-2009 fig. 13 10:55 Pagina 281 A0E0281m LUGGAGE NET (for versions/markets, where provided) The left and right sides of the boot are quipped with a luggage retainer net. – fig. 13 - version with side lid (for versions/markets, where provided) fig. 14 A0E0282m fig. 15 A0E0476m fig. 16 A0E0275m Using seats B-fig. 17 to secure the net to the rear side of the boot. To secure the net, fit hooks A-fig. 18 into seats B and press downwards. To release the net, take it out upwards while keeping button C pressed. ALFA 159 SPORTWAGON 271-292 Alfa 159 GB – fig. 14 - version without side lid – fig. 15 - fixing elastic. As optional, for versions/markets where applicable, an additional luggage retainer net can be fitted. Use the seats A-fig. 16 located in the front part of the boot to hook the net as shown in fig. 19. 281 271-292 Alfa 159 GB ALFA 159 SPORTWAGON fig. 17 10:55 Pagina 282 A0E0308m fig. 20 A0E0278m fig. 21 A0E0279m fig. 22 A0E0280m LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT COVER The luggage compartment cover A-fig. 20 can be rolled up and removed. To roll it up remove the two rear pins B-fig. 21 from their housings. fig. 18 fig. 19 282 8-04-2009 A0E0276m A0E0277m IMPORTANT Hold the cover by handle C-fig. 20 and guide it during rolling up. IMPORTANT To remove the net roll it up and check whether also the passenger's compartment separation net (for versions/markets, where provided) is rolled up (see next paragraph), then pull up lever D-fig. 23. Raise the net and take it out from the boot. To refit the net, proceed as follows: ❒ fit the net into the proper seat on the left side (side without lever); ❒ keep the lever D-fig. 22 up and fit the net into the proper seat on the right side; ❒ release lever D. 271-292 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:55 Pagina 283 Do not put objects on the cover which may damage it. The objects put on the cover may be thrown forwards and injure passengers should you brake sharply or in the event of an accident. Your are recommended to use the passenger's compartment separation net. fig. 23 A0E0283m fig. 24 A0E0287m fig. 25 A0E0288m PASSENGER'S COMPARTMENT UPPER SEPARATION NET (for versions/markets, where provided) In addition to the luggage compartment cover, certain versions are also fitted with a passenger's compartment upper separation net fig. 23. The net for separating the passenger's compartment from the boot is contained into a special bar. ALFA 159 SPORTWAGON WARNING To extend it, take it out of the reel by taking tongue A-fig. 24 and secure ends B-fig. 25 into the two housings C-fig. 26 (one per side) located on the roof of the car. 283 271-292 Alfa 159 GB ALFA 159 SPORTWAGON fig. 26 8-04-2009 10:55 Pagina 284 A0E0284m To roll up the net, release ends Bfig. 25 from housings C-fig. 26 and guide it during rolling. fig. 27 A0E0291m Passenger's compartment separating net removal/refitting To remove the net press button Dfig. 27 as shown in the figure, move the separating net releasing it from its seat, on both left and right side. make the net slide as shown in the figure, removing the pins from their seats. To refit the net reverse the removal operations described previously. 284 fig. 28 A0E0305m SOUND SYSTEM CD Changer (for versions/markets, where provided) O certain versions, behind the right boot lid, is fitted a CD Changer for 10 discs (see fig. 28). Amplifier (for versions/markets, where provided) Versions equipped with Bose Hi-Fi system also have an amplifier behind the left boot lid. 271-292 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:55 Pagina 285 ROOF RACK/ SKI RACK (for versions/markets, where provided) A0E0285m FUEL CAP EMERGENCY OPENING In the event of a failure, to open the fuel cap proceed as follows: ❒ open the fuse box lid A-fig. 29 on the right side of the boot as shown by the arrow; ❒ pull the string B set aside the use box. IMPORTANT Never exceed the max. permissible loads (see section "Technical Specifications"). fig. 30 A0E0286m ALFA 159 SPORTWAGON fig. 29 The car can be fitted with two longitudinal bars fig. 30 that can be used, by adding special accessories to carry various objects (e.g.: skis, windsurf, etc.) 285 271-292 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:56 Pagina 286 ALFA 159 SPORTWAGON PRESETTING FOR MOUNTING THE "UNIVERSAL ISOFIX" CHILD RESTRAINT SYSTEM 286 This car is preset for mounting the Universal Isofix child restraint system, a new European standardised system for carrying children safely. fig. 31 shows an example of child restraint system. The Universal Isofix child's seat covers weight group 1. Because of the different attachment system, the child seat must be secured by the specific bottom metal rings A-fig. 32, located in the squab upholstery, in the position marked by isofix flags (accessible by opening the zips on the covers) to the specific ring A-fig. 33 located behind the rear seat squab level with the child seat. fig. 31 A0E0241m fig. 32 A0E0174m fig. 33 A0E0477m 8-04-2009 10:56 Pagina 287 To use fastener A-fig. 33, proceed as follows: ❒ tilt the rear set backrest (see paragraph "Extending the boot" in this section); ❒ pull up fastener A and then secure the belt to the fastener. It is possible to mount both the traditional restraint system and the "Universal Isofix" one. Remember that in case of Universal Isofix child's seats, you can only use all those seats approved with the ECE R44/03 writing "Universal Isofix". At Lineaccessori Alfa Romeo you can find the "Universal Isofix" "Duo Plus" child's seat. For any further detail on installation and/or use, refer to the “Instructions Manual” that must be provided by the child restraint system's Manufacturer. WARNING Mount the child restraint system only with the car stationary. The Universal Isofix child restraint system is properly anchored to the mounting brackets when clicks are heard. In any case, keep to the installation instructions that must be provided by the child restraint system's Manufacturer. ALFA 159 SPORTWAGON 271-292 Alfa 159 GB 287 271-292 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:56 Pagina 288 IF AN EXTERIOR LIGHT BURNS OUT For the type of bulb and power rating, see paragraph “When needing to change a bulb" in section "In an emergency". ALFA 159 SPORTWAGON IMPORTANT Before changing a bulb, read carefully the instructions given in section "In an emergency". fig. 35 A0E0292m C: reversing light bulb on passenger side or right side; Reversing light/ rear fog lights C: rear fog light bulb on driver side or left side; To replace the bulbs proceed as follows: ❒ remove cover A-fig. 35 working with a screwdriver in the point indicated by the arrow; fig. 36 A0E0293m IMPORTANT To release the inspection lid, protect the screwdriver tip with a cloth to prevent scratching. ❒ remove the bulb holder unit by pressing the retaining tabs B-fig. 36; 288 A0E0294m ❒ remove and replace the burnt-out bulb by pressing it slightly and turning it counterclockwise fig. 37: REAR LIGHT UNITS ❒ open the tailgate; fig. 37 ❒ refit the bulb holder unit securing it properly using the retaining tabs Bfig. 36; ❒ close cover A-fig. 35. 271-292 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:56 Pagina 289 Taillight bulb on tailgate To replace the bulbs proceed as follows: ❒ open the tailgate; ❒ remove the bulb holder unit by pressing the retaining tabs B-fig. 36; fig. 38 A0E0295m ❒ remove and replace the burnt-out bulb by pressing it slightly and turning it counterclockwise fig. 37: Direction indicators/ Taillights/Brake lights D: taillight bulb on right/left headlight To replace the bulbs proceed as follows: ❒ refit the bulb holder unit securing it properly using the retaining tabs Bfig. 36; ❒ open the tailgate; ❒ close cover A-fig. 35. fig. 39 A0E0296m fig. 40 A0E0297m ❒ on certain versions, open the side lid; ❒ remove the protection cover by operating device A-fig. 38; ❒ remove the bulb holder unit by pressing the retaining tabs B-fig. 39; ❒ remove and replace the burnt-out bulb by pressing it slightly and turning it counterclockwise fig. 40: E: taillight/brake light bulb; ALFA 159 SPORTWAGON ❒ remove the cover A-fig. 35 working in the point shown by the arrow; ❒ refit the bulb holder unit securing it properly using the retaining tabs Bfig. 39; ❒ refit the protection cover. F: direction indicator bulb 289 271-292 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:56 Pagina 290 IF AN INTERIOR LIGHT BURNS OUT For the type of bulb and power rating, see paragraph “When needing to change a bulb" in section "In an emergency". ALFA 159 SPORTWAGON fig. 41 290 A0E0298m ADDITIONAL BRAKE LIGHT (THIRD STOP) The additional brake light is made up of LEDs and it is built into the rear spoiler fig. 41. Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services to have the third brake light replaced. IMPORTANT Before changing a bulb, read carefully the instructions given in section "In an emergency". fig. 42 A0E0487m BOOT LIGHT To change the bulb, proceed as follows: ❒ open the tailgate; ❒ remove the light unit A-fig. 42 levering in the point shown by the arrow; fig. 43 8-04-2009 10:56 Pagina 291 A0E0488m ❒ replace the bulb B-fig. 43 releasing it from the side contacts making sure that the new bulb is correctly clamped between the contacts; ❒ refit the light unit inserting first one side and then the other one until hearing the locking click. fig. 44 A0E0301m TAILGATE LIGHT To change the bulb, proceed as follows: ❒ open the tailgate; ❒ remove the light unit A-fig. 44 working in the point shown by the arrow; fig. 45 A0E0302m ❒ replace the bulb B-fig. 45 releasing it from the side contacts making sure that the new bulb is correctly clamped between the contacts; ❒ refit the light unit inserting first one side and then the other one until hearing the locking click. ALFA 159 SPORTWAGON 271-292 Alfa 159 GB 291 271-292 Alfa 159 GB 8-04-2009 10:56 Pagina 292 IF A FUSE BLOWS The fuse specific for the Sportwagon version is located in the fuse box at the right side of the boot (see “In an emergency” chapter). IMPORTANT Before changing a bulb, read carefully the instructions given in section "In an emergency". ALFA 159 SPORTWAGON To open the fuse box, proceed as follows: ❒ use handle B to open the right lid (for versions/markets, where provided) A-fig. 46; COMPONENT Socket 292 A0E0303m fig. 46 A0E0304m fig. 47 ❒ open the fuse box lid C-fig. 47 working in the point shown by the arrow. FUSE AMPERE F55 15 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 293 INTRODUCTION ......................................................... Tips ........................................................................ - Road safety ............................................................ - Reception conditions ................................................ - Care and maintenance ............................................. - CD ........................................................................ Technical specifications .............................................. HI-FI Bose audio system ............................................. 295 295 295 295 295 296 297 298 QUICK REFERENCE GUIDE ........................................... Controls on steering wheel ........................................ Introduction ............................................................. - Tuner section .......................................................... - CD section ............................................................. - CD MP3 section ...................................................... - Audio section .......................................................... - Media Player section................................................. 299 302 303 303 303 303 303 303 FUNCTIONS AND SETTINGS ........................................ Switching on the car radio ......................................... Switching off the car radio ......................................... Selecting the tuner function ........................................ Selecting CD/CD Changer functions .............................. 304 304 304 304 304 Audio source memory function .................................... Volume setting ......................................................... Mute/Pause function ................................................ Audio settings .......................................................... Tone setting ............................................................. Balance setting ......................................................... Fader setting ............................................................ Loudness function ..................................................... Menu....................................................................... Telephone setup ........................................................ Anti-theft protection.................................................... 304 304 305 305 305 305 306 306 307 313 313 RADIO (Tuner) .......................................................... Introduction ............................................................. Frequency band selection ........................................... Preset buttons .......................................................... Storing the last station listened to ................................ Automatic tuning ...................................................... Manual tuning .......................................................... AutoSTore function .................................................... Emergency alarm reception ........................................ EON function ............................................................ Stereo stations ......................................................... 314 314 314 314 314 315 315 315 316 316 316 SOUND SYSTEM SOUND SYSTEM 293 SOUND SYSTEM 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 294 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 294 CD PLAYER ............................................................... Introduction ............................................................. Selecting the CD player ............................................. Loading/ejecting a CD ............................................... Error messages ......................................................... Display information ................................................... Track selection .......................................................... Fast forward/backward track selection ........................ Pause function ......................................................... 317 317 317 317 318 318 318 318 318 MP3 CD PLAYER ....................................................... Introduction ............................................................. MP3 mode .............................................................. Selecting MP3 sessions with hybrid discs ....................... Display information ................................................... Select next/previous folder ........................................ Structure of the folders ............................................... 319 319 319 320 320 320 320 CD CHANGER (CDC) ................................................. Introduction ............................................................. CD Changer selection ................................................. Error messages ......................................................... CD selection ............................................................. 321 321 321 321 321 TROUBLESHOOTING ................................................. 322 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 295 INTRODUCTION The car radio is installed in an ergonomically convenient position for the driver and the passenger; the graphics on the front panel help to quickly identify the controls and makes them easier to use. A CD Changer is available from Lineaccessori Alfa. The instructions for use are provided below. We recommend that you read them carefully. The instructions also refer to how to operate the CD Changer (if present) using the radio. Refer to the specific manual for instructions on how to use of the CD Changer. TIPS Road safety Learn how to use all different radio functions (e.g. how to save stations) before beginning to drive. Reception conditions Reception conditions change constantly while driving. Reception may be disturbed by mountains, buildings or bridges, or when you are far away from the broadcasting station. WARNING The volume may be increased when receiving traffic reports. WARNING Excessively loud volume can be a risk for driver and other people on the road. The volume must therefore always be adjusted so that you can still hear noise from the surroundings (e.g. horns, ambulance sirens, police sirens, etc.). Care and maintenance SOUND SYSTEM The car radio is equipped with a CD player (radio and CD player) or a CD-MP3 player (radio and CD-MP3) and was designed to combine with the specific features of the passenger compartment. It has a customised design that integrates the style of the dashboard. The size of the car radio is compatible with the car and as it cannot be adapted to any other vehicle, it is fixed. The radio is designed for a long operational life and does not require particular maintenance. Contact Alfa Romeo Authorized Services in case of faults. Clean the cover with a soft antistatic cloth only. Cleaning and polishing products may damage the surface. 295 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 296 CD Remember that dirt, scratches or distortions on the CD could cause skipping while it is playing and poor sound quality. Follow these guidelines for optimum playback: ❒ only use branded CDs: ❒ after listening to the CDs, put them back in their boxes to avoid them being marked or scratched, which could cause them to skip during playing; ❒ never expose CDs to direct sunlight, high temperatures or moisture for extended periods of time, which could cause them to become distorted; SOUND SYSTEM ❒ do not stick labels on the CD surface or write on the recorded surface with pencil or pen. 296 ❒ clean each CD carefully to remove fingerprints or dust using a soft cloth. Hold CDs by the outside and clean them from the middle outwards; ❒ never use chemicals (e.g. antistatic products or thinners or sprays) for cleaning as they could damage the surface of the CDs; To remove a CD from its container, press down in the middle and lift up the disc, holding it carefully around the outside. Always take the CD by holding it around its outside circumference. Never touch the surface. To remove fingerprints and dust, use a soft cloth starting from the centre of the CD outwards. Never use CDs that are very scratched, cracked, distorted, etc. Their use could cause damage the player or make it malfunction. The use of original CDs is required for the best quality audio playback. Correct operation is not guaranteed when CD-R/RW media are used that were not correctly burned and/or with a maximum capacity above 650 Mb. WARNING Do not use commercially available protective sheets for CDs or discs with stabilisers as these could get stuck in the internal mechanism and damage the disc. 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 297 WARNING If a copy-protected CD is used, it may take a few seconds before the system will start to play it. In addition, since many new and different protection methods are continuously being introduced, it is not possible to guarantee that the CD player will be able to play any protected CD. Information regarding copy protection is often stated in fine or difficult to read print on the cover of the CD itself, or indicated by phrases such as, for example, “COPY CONTROL”, “COPY PROTECTED”, “THIS CD CANNOT BE PLAYED ON A PC/MAC”, or identified by symbols such as for example: In addition, protected disks often do not have the audio disk identifying symbol on the disk (or on the case) itself: TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS Car radio Maximum power: 4x30 W Speakers The system includes: WARNING The CD player can read most of the compression systems currently on the market (e.g.: LAME, BLADE, XING, FRAUNHOFER) but as these systems are continually evolving, playback of all compression formats is not guaranteed. WARNING If a multisession disc is loaded, only the first session will be played. – 2 tweeter speakers, max. power 30 W each, positioned on the ends of the dashboard; – 2 mid-woofer speakers, diameter 165 mm, max. power 30 W each, positioned in the front doors; – 2 tweeter speakers, max. power 30 W each, positioned in the rear doors; – 2 mid-woofer speakers, diameter 165 mm, max. power 30 W each, positioned in rear doors. SOUND SYSTEM 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 297 SOUND SYSTEM 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 298 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 298 HI-FI BOSE AUDIO SYSTEM (for versions/markets, where provided) Technical information The BOSE HI-FI audio system was carefully designed to provide the best acoustic performance and reproduce sound like a live concert in all areas of the passenger compartment. – 2 tweeter speakers, max. power 50 W each, positioned on the ends of the dashboard; The system faithfully reproduces crystalline high tones and provides full and rich bass tones that make the loudness function superfluous. The full sound range is reproduced throughout the entire passenger compartment so that the occupants are enveloped with the feeling of space experienced when listening to live music. Components are patented and make use of the most sophisticated technology whilst at the same time being easy to use by even the most inexperienced people. The system consists of: – 1 mid-tweeter (Centerfill) speaker, diameter 80 mm, max. power 50 W, positioned in middle of dashboard; – 1 sub-woofer (Saloon versions), diameter 250 mm, max. power 200 W, positioned on rear window shelf; – 2 mid-woofer speakers, diameter 165 mm, max. power 90 W each, positioned in front doors, designed for optimal mediumto-low frequencies; – 1 bass-box reflex (Sportwagon versions), diameter 130 mm, max. power 200 W, positioned in boot; – 2 rear tweeter speakers, max. power 50 W each, positioned in the rear doors; – audio power amplifier, 6 independent channels, positioned on rear window shelf for controlling all speakers in the car. – 2 mid-woofer speakers, diameter 165 mm, max. power 90 W each, positioned in rear doors, designed for optimal medium-tolow frequencies; 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 299 SOUND SYSTEM QUICK REFERENCE GUIDE A0F0531m Button GENERAL FUNCTIONS Mode ON/OFF On Brief press on knob Off Long press on knob Volume adjustment Turn knob leftwards/rightwards 299 SOUND SYSTEM 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 300 Button GENERAL FUNCTIONS Mode FMAS AM CD FM1, FM2, FM Autostore radio source selection MW, MW1, MW2 radio source selection Repeated brief press on button Radio CD/CD-Changer/Media Player source selection (with Blue&MeTM only) Repeated brief press on button MUTE Volume on/off (MUTE/PAUSE) Brief press on button AUDIO Audio settings: low tones (BASS), high tones (TREBLE), left/right balance (BALANCE), front/rear balance (FADER) Activate menu: brief press on button Select setting type: press buttons N or O Adjust settings: press buttons ÷ or ˜ MENU Advanced functions settings Activate menu: brief press on button Select setting type: press buttons N or O Adjust settings: press buttons ÷ or ˜ Button TUNER FUNCTIONS Mode Search radio station: • Automatic search • Manual search Automatic search: press buttons ÷ or ˜ (hold pressed to fast forward) Manual search: press buttons N or O (hold pressed to fast forward) N ÷ ˜ O 1 2 3 4 5 6 Store current radio station Recall stored station 300 Repeated brief press on button Long press on buttons for memory preset 1 to 6 Brief press on buttons for memory preset 1 to 6 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 301 Button CD FUNCTIONS Mode ı Eject CD Brief press on button Play previous/next track Brief press on buttons ÷ or ˜ CD track fast forward/backward Long press on buttons ÷ or ˜ N O Play previous/next disc (for CD-Changer) Brief press on buttons N or O Play previous/next folder (for CD-MP3) Brief press on buttons N or O ▲▼ Select previous/next folder/artist/genre/album according to active selection mode Brief press on button ÷ ˜ ÷ ˜ Play previous/next track Brief press on button Button Media Player FUNCTIONS (with Blue&MeTM only) Mode ▲▼ Select folder/artist/genre/previous/next album according to the active selection mode Brief press on button ÷ ˜ Play previous/next track SOUND SYSTEM 293-318 Alfa 159 GB Brief press on button 301 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 302 CONTROLS ON STEERING WHEEL (for versions/markets, where provided) SOUND SYSTEM A0E0532m 302 Button FUNCTION Mode ^ AudioMute on/off (Radio mode) or Pause (Media Player mode - with Blue&MeTM only) Brief press on button Volume up Press button Volume down Press button SRC Select radio frequency range (FM1, FM2, FMT, FMA, MW) or audio source: Radio - CD - MP3 - CD Changer or Media Player (with Blue&MeTM only) Press button N Radio: recall pre-selected stations (from 1 to 6) MP3: select next folder CD Changer: select next CD in CD Changer Press button O Radio: recall pre-selected stations (from 6 to 1) MP3: select previous folder CD Changer: select previous CD in CD Changer Press button ÷ Radio: autosearch previous station CD player: select previous track CD Changer: select previous track Press button ˜ Radio: autosearch next station CD player: select next track CD Changer: select next track Press button + – 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 303 INTRODUCTION CD section CD MP3 section The device offers the following functions: ❒ Direct disc select; ❒ MP3-Info function (ID3-TAG); Tuner section ❒ Track select (forward/backward); ❒ Select folder (previous/next); ❒ Fast track search (forward/backward); ❒ Select track (forward/backward); ❒ CD Display function: disc name/time elapsed since the start of the track; ❒ Fast track search (forward/backward); ❒ PLL tuning in frequency bands FM/AM/ MW; ❒ RDS (Radio Data System) with TA (traffic information) - TP (traffic programmes) EON (Enhanced Other Network) - REG (regional programmes) functions; ❒ AF: alternative frequency search selection in RDS mode; ❒ emergency alarm set up; ❒ automatic/manual station tuning; ❒ FM Multipath detector; ❒ manual storing of 30 stations: 18 in FM band (6 in FM1, 6 in FM2, 6 in FMT), 12 in MW band (6 in MW1, 6 in MW2); ❒ automatic storing (AUTOSTORE function) of 6 stations in the dedicated FM band; ❒ SPEED VOLUME function (excluding versions with Bose HI-FI system): speed-dependent automatic volume adjustment; ❒ automatic Stereo/Mono selection. ❒ Play audio CD, CD-R and CD-RW. ❒ MP3 Display function: name of folder, ID3-TAG information, time elapsed since start of track, file name; ❒ Play audio or data CD, CD-R and CD-RW. Multimedia CDs include data tracks in addition to the audio tracks. Playing this type of CD could cause hissing at a volume that could jeopardise road safety as well as damage the output stages and the speakers. Audio section ❒ Mute/Pause function; ❒ Soft Mute function; ❒ Loudness function (excluding versions with Bose HI-FI system); SOUND SYSTEM 293-318 Alfa 159 GB ❒ 7 band graphic equalizer (excluding versions with Bose HI-FI system); ❒ Separate bass/treble adjustment; ❒ Right/left channel balancing. Media Player section (with Blue&MeTM only) See description in the Blue&MeTM supplement for Media Player operations. 303 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 304 FUNCTIONS AND SETTINGS SWITCHING ON THE CAR RADIO SELECTING THE TUNER FUNCTION AUDIO SOURCE MEMORY FUNCTION The car radio comes on when the ON/OFF button/knob is briefly pressed. Pressing the FMAS button quickly and repeatedly to cyclically select the following audio sources: If another function (e.g. the radio) is selected whilst listening to a CD, playback is interrupted and is resumed from the same point when returning to the CD source. SOUND SYSTEM When the car radio is turned on the volume is limited to 5 if the value was higher than this when the radio was last used. When the radio is switched on with the key off, it switches off automatically after about 20 minutes. After the radio has switched itself off automatically it can be turned on for a further 20 minutes by pressing the ON/OFF button/knob. SWITCHING OFF THE CAR RADIO Keep the ON/OFF button/knob pressed. ❒ TUNER (“FM1”, “FM2”, “FMT”); Press the AM button quickly and repeatedly to cyclically select the following audio sources: ❒ TUNER (“MW1”, “MW2”). SELECTING CD/CD CHANGER FUNCTIONS Press the CD button briefly and repeatedly to cyclically select the following audio sources: ❒ CD (only if a CD is inserted); ❒ CHANGER (CD Changer - only if the CD Changer is connected). 304 If another function is selected whilst listening to the radio, the last station selected is tuned into when returning to the Radio source. VOLUME SETTING Turn the ON/OFF button/knob to adjust the volume. If the volume level is changed during the transmission of traffic news, the new setting will only be maintained until the update is over. 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 305 MUTE/PAUSE FUNCTION (zeroing the volume) Press the MUTE button briefly to activate the Mute function. The volume will gradually decrease and the words “RADIO Mute” will appear on the display (in tuner mode) or “PAUSE” (in CD or CD-Changer mode). Press the MUTE button again to deactivate the Mute function. The volume will gradually increase until it reaches the level set previously. When the volume is changed using the dedicated controls, the Mute function is deactivated and the volume is adjusted to the new selected level. Mute will be ignored when there is an incoming traffic alert (if the TA function is activated) or if an emergency alarm is received. The function will be reactivated when the alert is over. AUDIO SETTINGS The audio menu functions depend on the activated function: AM/FM/CD/CDC/Media Player (with Blue&MeTM only). Press the AUDIO button briefly to change the Audio functions. After the AUDIO button is first pressed, the display will show the bass level value for the source activated at that time (e.g. in FM mode the display will show “FM Bass + 2”). To scroll through the Menu functions use button N or O. To change the setting of the selected function, use the ÷ or ˜ buttons. The current status of the function selected will be shown on the display. TONE SETTING (bass/treble) Proceed as follows: ❒ Use button N or O to set the “Bass” or “Treble” in the AUDIO menu; ❒ press the button ÷ or ˜ to increase/decrease the bass or treble settings. By pressing the buttons briefly, the levels will change progressively. Hold pressed to adjust the levels faster. The functions managed by the Menu are: BALANCE SETTING ❒ BASS (bass adjustment); Proceed as follows: ❒ TREBLE (treble adjustment); ❒ Use the N or O button to set the “Balance” in the AUDIO menu; ❒ BALANCE (right/left balance adjustment); ❒ FADER (front/rear balance adjustment); ❒ LOUDNESS (excluding versions with Bose HI-FI system) (LOUDNESS function on/off); ❒ EQUALIZER (excluding versions with Bose HI-FI system) (activation and selection of factory equalizer settings); ❒ USER EQUALIZER (excluding versions with Bose HI-FI) (customised equalizer settings). ❒ press the ÷ button to turn up the sound from the right speakers or the ˜ button to turn up the sound from the left speakers. SOUND SYSTEM 293-318 Alfa 159 GB By pressing the buttons briefly, the levels will change progressively. By pressing them for longer, the levels will change quickly. Select the “÷ or ˜” value to set the right and left audio outputs at the same value. 305 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 306 FADER SETTING Proceed as follows: ❒ Use the N or Obutton to set the “Fader” in the AUDIO menu; ❒ press the ÷ button to turn up the sound coming from the rear speakers or the ˜ button to turn up the sound coming from the front speakers. SOUND SYSTEM By pressing the buttons briefly, the levels will change progressively. Hold pressed to adjust the levels faster. Select the “÷ or ˜” value to set the same level for the front and rear audio outputs. LOUDNESS FUNCTION (excluding versions with Bose HI-FI system) The Loudness function improves the volume of the sound whilst listening at low volumes, increasing the bass and treble. To turn the function on/off, select “Loudness” in the the AUDIO menu using the N or O button. The function status (on or off) is shown on the display for a few seconds by the words “Loudness On” or “Loudness Off”. PRESET/USER*/ CLASSIC/ ROCK/JAZZ functions (equalizer on/off) (excluding versions with Bose HI-FI system) The built-in equalizer can be activated/deactivated. When the equalizer function is off, the audio settings can only be changed by adjusting the bass and treble settings, whereas when the function is on, the acoustic curves can be adjusted. To turn the equalizer off, select the “EQ Preset” function using the ÷ or ˜ buttons. 306 To turn the equalizer on, use the ÷ or ˜ buttons to select one of the settings: ❒ “FM/AM/CD...EQ User” (adjustment of 7 equalizer bands that can be changed by the user); ❒ “Classic” (optimal equalizer presetting for classical music); ❒ “Rock” (optimal equalizer presetting for rock and pop music); ❒ “Jazz” (optimal equalizer presetting for jazz music); “EQ” will appear on the display when one of the equaliser presets is active. 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 307 *USER EQ SETTINGS function (equalizer settings only if the USER settings function is selected) (excluding versions with Bose HI-FI system) To set a personalized equalizer adjustment, point to USER using button N or O and press button O for a while. A graph with 7 bars will appear on the display, where each bar represents a frequency. Select the bar to adjust using the ÷ or ˜ buttons; the bar selected will start flashing and can be adjusted using the N or O buttons. Press the AUDIO button again to store the setting. The display will show the source activated at the time followed by the word User. If the mode is, for example, FM, then the display will show “FM EQ User”. MENU The functions managed by the Menu are: MENU button functions ❒ AF SWITCHING (ON/OFF) Press the MENU button briefly to activate the Menu function. The display will show the first menu item that can be adjusted (AF) (“AF Switching On” on the display). To scroll through the Menu functions use button N or O. To change the setting of the selected function, use the ÷ or ˜ buttons. The current status of the function selected will be shown on the display. ❒ TRAFFIC INFORMATION (ON/OFF) ❒ REGIONAL MODE regional programmes (ON/OFF) ❒ MP3 DISPLAY (CD MP3 display setting) ❒ SPEED VOLUME (excluding versions with Bose HI-FI system) (volume setting according to speed) ❒ RADIO ON VOLUME (radio volume maximum limit on/off) ❒ EXTERNAL AUDIO (telephone volume) ❒ RADIO OFF (off mode) ❒ SYSTEM RESET. SOUND SYSTEM 293-318 Alfa 159 GB Press the MENU button again to exit the Menu function. IMPORTANT AF SWITCHING, TRAFFIC INFORMATION and REGIONAL MODE adjustments are only possible in FM mode. 307 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 308 AF SWITCHING function (alternative frequency search) The radio can operate in two different modes in the RDS mode: SOUND SYSTEM ❒ “AF Switching On” - search for alternative frequencies activated (the letters “AF” appear on the display); 308 With the function on, the radio automatically tunes into the station with the strongest signal broadcasting the same programme. In this way when driving you can continue listening to the same station without having to change the frequency when you change areas. ❒ “AF Switching Off” - search for alternative frequencies not activated. Obviously, it must be possible to receive the station that you are listening to in the area you are driving through. Proceed as follows to switch the function on/off: “AF” will light up in the display when the AF function is on. ❒ press the MENU button and select “AF Switching On”; If the AF function has been activated and the radio is not able to receive the tuned station, the radio activates the automatic search, during which “FM Search” appears on the display (for versions/markets, where provided). ❒ briefly press the ÷/˜ buttons to turn the function on/off. With the AF function deactivated, the remaining RDS functions, such as the display of the station name, still remain active. The AF function can only be activated on FM bands. 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 309 TRAFFIC INFORMATION function (traffic announcements) Some stations on the FM band (FM1, FM2 and FMA) can transmit information about traffic conditions. The letters “TA” will appear in the display in this case. Proceed as follows to switch the TA function on/off: ❒ press the MENU button and select “Traffic Info”; ❒ briefly press the ÷/˜ buttons to turn the function on/off. If the TA function is activated, “TA” will light up on the display. IMPORTANT If the TA function is activated with an audio source other than Tuner (Radio) (CD, MP3, Telephone or Mute/Pause), the radio can carry out an automatic search and therefore the frequency tuned into may be different from the one set previously when selecting the Tuner (Radio) source again. With the TA function: ❒ search only for RDS stations that transmit on the FM band, which are enabled to transmit traffic information; The volume at which the traffic news is transmitted depends on the listening volume: ❒ listening volume below 5: traffic news volume 5 (fixed value); ❒ receive traffic information even if the CD player/CD Changer function is on; ❒ listening volume above 5: traffic news volume equal to listening volume +1. ❒ receive traffic information at a minimum preset volume even with the radio volume off. If the volume is changed during a traffic update, the level will not be shown on the display; the new level will only be maintained during the update. IMPORTANT In some countries there are radio stations that do not broadcast traffic information even with the TA function activated (“TA” on the display). If the radio is tuned to a station in the AM band, when TA is activated it will tune to the last selected station in the FM1 band. While traffic information is being received, “TRAFFIC INFORMATION” will appear on the display. The TA function can be interrupted by pressing any button on the car radio. SOUND SYSTEM 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 309 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 310 REGIONAL MODE function (reception of regional broadcasts) Some national broadcasters will transmit regional programmes at certain times of the day (that vary from region to region). This function makes it possible to tune into local (regional) broadcasters automatically (see EON function paragraph). SOUND SYSTEM If you want the radio to automatically tune into the regional stations being broadcast on the network selected, the function must be activated. IMPORTANT If the AF and REG functions are on at the same time, once a border between two regions is crossed, the radio may not switch correctly to a valid alternative frequency. MP3 DISPLAY function (display of MP3 Compact Disc information) This function is used to select the information shown by the display when listening to a CD containing MP3 tracks. The function can only be selected if a CD MP3 is inserted: in this case “MP3 Display” will appear on the display. To change the function, use the ÷ or ˜ buttons. There are six available settings: To turn the function on/off, use the ÷ or ˜ buttons. ❒ “Title” (if ID3-TAG is available) The current status of the function will appear on the display: ❒ “Album” (if ID3-TAG is available) ❒ “Regional Mode: On” - function on. ❒ “Regional Mode: Off” - function off. 310 If the function is deactivated and you have tuned into a regional station working in a given area and you enter a different area, then the regional station received in the new area will be broadcast. ❒ “Author” (if ID3-TAG is available) ❒ “Folder” name ❒ “File” name 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 311 SPEED VOLUME function (volume setting according to speed) (excluding versions with Bose HI-FI system) This function automatically adapts the volume level to the speed of the car, turning up the volume when the speed increases to maintain the ratio with the noise level inside the passenger compartment. To turn the function on/off, use the ÷ or ˜ buttons. The current status of the function will appear on the display: ❒ Off: function off ❒ Low: function on (low setting) ❒ High: function on (high setting). RADIO ON VOLUME function (radio volume maximum limit activation/deactivation) This function is used to turn the maximum volume limit on/off when turning the radio on. The display shows the function status: ❒ “On volume limit: on” - when the radio is switched on the volume level will be: – the maximum volume if the volume level is equal to or higher than the maximum value; – the same as before it was switched off if the volume level is between the minimum and maximum values; – minimum volume if the volume level is equal to or lower than the minimum. NOTES ❒ The menu can only be used to turn the function on/off and not to set the minimum or maximum volume. ❒ If the “TA” or “TEL” functions or an outside audio source are activated when the radio is turned on, the radio will come on at the volume set for these sources. When the outside audio source is deactivated, the volume can be adjusted between the minimum and maximum levels. ❒ If the battery charge is low, it will not be possible to adjust the volume between the minimum and maximum levels. SOUND SYSTEM 293-318 Alfa 159 GB ❒ “On volume limit: off” - the radio will come on at the volume level it was at before switching off. The volume may be between 0 and 40. Use the ÷ / ˜ buttons to change the setting. 311 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 312 EXTERNAL AUDIO function (telephone volume adjustment) RADIO OFF function (on and off mode) Turn the ON/OFF button/knob or press the ÷/˜ buttons to adjust (settings from 1 to 40) or mute (OFF setting) the volume of the telephone and the Blue&MeTM (except the Media Player function). This function is used to select the mode for switching off the radio between two different procedures. To activate the function, use the ÷ or ˜ buttons. The display shows the current function status: ❒ “Extern audio: Off” - function off. SOUND SYSTEM ❒ “Extern volume: 23” - function on with volume setting 23. 312 The selected mode will appear on the display: ❒ “Radio off: 00 min”: the radio is turned off by the ignition key automatically as soon as the key is extracted; ❒ “Radio off: 20 min”: the radio turns off independently of the ignition key; it remains on for a maximum period of 20 minutes after the key has been extracted. IMPORTANT If the radio is turned off automatically after the ignition key is extracted (immediately or with a delay of 20 minutes), it will come on again automatically when the key is inserted in the switch again. On the contrary, if the radio is turned off by pushing the ON/OFF button, it will remain off when the key is inserted in the ignition switch. SYSTEM RESET function This function is used to restore all settings to their preset factory values. The options are: ❒ NO: no restore intervention; ❒ YES: the default parameters are restored. During this operation, the message “Resetting” will appear on the display. At the end of the operation, the source does not change and the previous situation will be displayed. 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 313 TELEPHONE SETUP ANTI-THEFT PROTECTION If a hands-free kit is installed on the car, when there is an incoming phone call the car radio audio will be connected to the telephone output. The incoming telephone sound is always at a fixed volume, but it can be adjusted during the conversation using the ON/OFF button/knob. The radio is equipped with an anti-theft protection system based on the exchange of information between the car radio and the electronic control unit (Body Computer) on the vehicle. The fixed telephone audio volume can be adjusted using the External audio function in the Menu. The word PHONE will appear on the display when the audio is muted for the phone call. This system guarantees maximum security and avoids having to enter the secret code every time the radio power supply is disconnected. If the outcome of the check is positive, the radio will start to work, whilst if the codes compared are not the same or if the electronic control unit (Body Computer) is replaced, the equipment will notify the user of the need to enter the secret code following the procedure in the paragraph below. Entering the secret code When the radio is switched on, if the secret code is requested, the display will show the word “Code” for about 2 seconds followed by four dashes “- - - -”. The code is made up of four digits from 1 to 6, each corresponding to one of the dashes. To enter the first digit, press the corresponding button of the preset stations (from 1 to 6). Enter the other code numbers in the same way. If the four digits are not entered within 20 seconds, the message “Enter code - - -” will appear again on the display for 2 seconds, followed by four dashes “- - - -”. This event is not considered an incorrect entering of the code. After entering the fourth digit (within 20 seconds), the car radio will start to work. If an incorrect code is entered, the radio will emit a sound and the display will show “Radio blocked/wait” to notify the user of the need to enter the correct code. Each time the user enters an incorrect code, the waiting time will gradually increase (1 min, 2 min, 4 min, 8 min, 16 min, 30 min, 1 h, 2 h, 4 h, 8 h, 16 h, 24 h) up to a maximum of 24 hours. The waiting time will be shown on the display by “Radio blocked/wait”. After the message disappears, the code entering procedure may be started again. SOUND SYSTEM 293-318 Alfa 159 GB Code Card This document certifies ownership of the car radio. The Code Card contains the model of the radio, the serial number and the secret code. IMPORTANT Keep the Code Card somewhere safe so that the authorities can be supplied with the relevant information if the radio is stolen. 313 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 314 RADIO (TUNER) INTRODUCTION When the radio is turned on the last function selected before it was switched off is activated: Radio, CD, CD MP3 or Media Player (solo con Blue&MeTM). SOUND SYSTEM To select the Radio function whilst listening to another audio source, press the FMAS or AM buttons briefly, depending on the desired band. Once the Radio mode has been activated, the display will show the name (only RDS stations) and the frequency of the selected radio station, the frequency band selected (ex. FM1) and the preset button number (ex. P1). FREQUENCY BAND SELECTION With the Radio mode activated, press the FMAS or AM button briefly and repeatedly to select the desired reception band. Each time the button is pressed the following bands are selected cyclically: ❒ Pressing the FMAS button: “FM1”, “FM2”, “FMA”; ❒ Pressing the AM button: “MW1” and “MW2”. Each band is identified by the respective wording on the display. The last station selected on the respective frequency band will be tuned into. The FM band is divided into sections: FM1, FM2 and FMA; the FMA reception band is reserved for stations stored automatically using the Autostore function. 314 PRESET BUTTONS The buttons numbered from 1 to 6 can used to set the following presettings: ❒ 18 in the FM band FM (6 in FM1, 6 in FM2, 6 in FMT or “FMA” on some versions); ❒ 12 in the MW band (6 in MW1, 6 in MW2). To listen to a preset station, select the desired frequency band and then briefly press the corresponding preset button (from 1 to 6). By pressing the preset button for more than 2 seconds, the station tuned into will be stored. The storing phase is confirmed by an acoustic signal. STORING THE LAST STATION LISTENED TO The radio automatically stores the last station that was selected for each reception band, which is then tuned into when the radio is turned on or when the reception band is changed. 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 315 AUTOMATIC TUNING Briefly press the ÷ or ˜ button to start the automatic tuning search for the next station that can be received in the selected direction. If the button ÷ or ˜ is pressed down longer, the fast search starts. When the button is released, the tuning will stop at the next station that can be received. If the TA function (traffic information) is on, the tuner will only search for stations that broadcast traffic updates. MANUAL TUNING This is used to manually search for stations in the preselected band. Select the desired frequency band and then press the N or O buttons briefly and repeatedly to start the search in the desired direction. If the N or O button is pressed longer, the fast search will start and then stop when the button is released. AUTOSTORE FUNCTION (automatic station storing) To activate the Autostore function, keep the FMAS button pressed until the acoustic confirmation signal. With this function, the radio automatically stores the 6 stations with the strongest signal in a decreasing order on the FMA frequency band. During the automatic storing process, “Autostore” will appear flashing on the display. To interrupt the Autostore function, press the FMAS button again: the radio will again tune into the station listened to before the function was activated. When the Autostore scan is concluded, the radio will automatically tune into the first preset station on the FMA band (preset 1). The stations that have a strong signal at that moment are then automatically stored in the preselected band in the buttons numbered 1 to 6. When the Autostore function is activated in the MW1 o MW2 band, the FMA band is automatically selected and the scan is started. IMPORTANT Sometimes Autostore cannot find six stations with a strong signal. In this case, the strongest stations will be duplicated in the free preset buttons. IMPORTANT When the Autostore function is activated, the stations that were previously stored on the FMA band are deleted. SOUND SYSTEM 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 315 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 316 EMERGENCY ALARM RECEPTION EON FUNCTION (Enhanced Other Network) The radio can receive emergency alerts in RDS mode in exceptional circumstances or when dangerous situations are threatened (earthquakes, floods, etc.) if these are being transmitted by the broadcaster tuned into. In some countries, there are circuits that group multiple broadcasters that transmit traffic information together. In this case, the programme on the station that is being listened to will be temporarily interrupted to: SOUND SYSTEM This function is activated automatically and cannot be turned off. 316 The word ALARM will be shown in the display during the transmission of an emergency announcement. The volume of the radio will change during this announcement in the same way as during a traffic bulletin. ❒ receive traffic information (only with the TA function on); ❒ listen to regional transmissions each time they are transmitted by one of the broadcasters in the same circuit. STEREO STATIONS If the incoming signal is weak, the reproduction is automatically switched from Stereo to Mono. 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 317 C D P L AY E R LOADING/EJECTING A CD This chapter describes the variants regarding the operation of the CD player: as far as the operation of the radio is concerned, refer to the description in the “Functions and settings” chapter. To load the CD, insert it gently into the slot to activate the motorised loading system, which will position it correctly. SELECTING THE CD PLAYER To activate the CD player built-into the equipment, proceed as follows: ❒ load a CD with the equipment switched on: the first track will start to play; or ❒ if a CD has already been loaded, turn on the car radio and then briefly press the CD button to select the “CD” operating mode: the last track listened to will start to play. The CD can be loaded with the radio switched off and the ignition key in the MARon position: in this case the radio will remain off. When the car radio is turned on, the last source listened to prior to switching off will be activated. When a CD is loaded the display will show “CD-IN” and the words “CD Reading”. They will remain displayed for the entire time required for the radio to read the CD tracks. When this time has elapsed the radio will automatically start to play the first track. Press the ˚ button, with the device turned on, to activate the CD motorised ejecting system. After ejection, the last audio source listened to before playing the CD will be heard. If the CD is not removed from the car radio, it will automatically be reloaded about 20 seconds later and the Tuner mode will be tuned into (Radio). The CD cannot be ejected if the car radio is off. If the ejected CD is loaded without having removed it completely from the slot, the radio will not switch to the CD source. SOUND SYSTEM INTRODUCTION It is advisable to use original CDs to ensure optimum playback. If CD-R/RWs are used, we recommend using good quality disc burnt at the slowest speed possible. 317 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 318 ERROR MESSAGES DISPLAY INFORMATION If the CD cannot be read (for example a CDROM was loaded or a CD was loaded upside down or there is a playback error), the message “CD Disc error” will appear on the display for approximately 2 seconds. When the CD player is operating, the following information will appear on the display that has the following meaning: SOUND SYSTEM The CD will then be ejected and the audio source activated prior to the CD mode selection will be heard. With an external audio source activated (TA, ALARM or Phone), the CD that cannot be read will not be ejected until these functions have ended. At the end, with the CD mode activated, the display will show the words “CD Disc error” for a few seconds and then the CD will be ejected. “CD Track 5”: indicates the CD track number; “03:42”: indicates the time elapsed since the start of the track (if the respective Menu function is activated). TRACK SELECTION (forward/backward) Briefly press the ÷ button to play the previous CD track and the ˜ button to play the next track. The tracks are selected cyclically: the first track is selected after the last track and vice versa. If the track has been played for more than 3 seconds, pressing the ÷ button will cause the track to be started again from the beginning. In this case, if you want to play the previous track, press the button twice consecutively. 318 FAST FORWARD/BACKWARD TRACK SELECTION Keep the ˜ button pressed down to fast forward the selected track and keep the ÷ button pressed down to play the track fast backward. The fast forward/backward function will stop once the button is released. PAUSE FUNCTION To pause the CD player, press the MUTE button. The words “CD Pause” will appear on the display. To resume listening to the track, press the MUTE button again. If another audio source is selected, the pause function is turned off. 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 319 M P 3 C D P L AY E R MP3 MODE This chapter describes the operation of the CD MP3 player variants only. Refer to the description in the “Functions and Settings“ chapter as far as the operation of the radio is concerned. In addition to playing normal audio CDs, the car radio can also play CD-ROMs on which MP3 format compressed audio files are recorded. The radio works according to the methods described previously (“CD player”) when an audio CD is inserted. NOTE MPEG Layer-3 audio decoding technology licensed from Fraunhofer IIS and Thomson multimedia. The use of good quality disc burnt at the slowest possible speed is recommended for optimum quality. The files on the MP3 CD are in folders, with sequential lists of all the folders containing MP3 tracks (folders and sub-folders are all displayed on the same level) and folders that do not contain MP3 tracks cannot be selected. The operating conditions and specifications for playing MP3 files are as follows: ❒ the CD-ROMs used must be burnt in compliance with the ISO9660 Specification; ❒ the music files must have an “.mp3” extension: files with a different extension cannot be played; ❒ the following sampling frequencies can be played: 44.1 kHz, stereo (96 to 320 kbit/s) - 22.05 kHz, mono or stereo (32 to 80 kbit/s); ❒ tracks with variable bit-rates can be played. SOUND SYSTEM INTRODUCTION IMPORTANT The names of tracks must not contain the following characters: spaces, ‘ (apostrophes), (and) (open and close brackets). When a CD MP3 is being burnt, make sure that the file names do not contain these characters; otherwise, the car radio will not be able to play those tracks. 319 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 320 SELECTING MP3 SESSIONS WITH HYBRID DISCS SOUND SYSTEM If a hybrid disc is inserted (Mixed Mode, Enhanced, CD-Extra) also containing MP3 files, the radio automatically starts playing the audio session. It is possible to move to the MP3 session whilst playing by keeping the CD button pressed for more than 2 seconds. IMPORTANT When the function is activated the radio may take a few seconds to start playback. Whilst checking the disc the display will show “CD Reading”: if no MP3 files are detected, the radio will resume playing the audio session from the point where it was interrupted. DISPLAY INFORMATION SELECT NEXT/PREVIOUS FOLDER ID3-tag information displaying Press the N button to select the next folder or the O button to select the previous folder. The name of the selected folder will be shown on the display. In addition to the information relating to the time elapsed, the name of the folder and the name of the file, the car radio can display ID3-TAG information relating to the track title, artist and author. The name of the MP3 folder shown on the display corresponds to the name with which the folder was stored on the CD, followed by an asterisk. Example of a complete MP3 folder name: BEST OF *. If you wish to display ID3-TAG information (Title, Artist, Album) and this information has not been recorded for the track played, the information will be replaced by information relating to the name of the file. The folders are selected cyclically: the first folder is selected after the last folder and vice versa. If no other folder/track is selected during the next two seconds, the first track contained in the new folder will be played. If the last track contained in the currently selected folder is played, the next folder will be played. STRUCTURE OF THE FOLDERS The radio with MP3 player: ❒ only recognises the folders that effectively contain MP3 format files ❒ if the MP3 files on a CD-ROM are structured in “sub-folders”, their structure is compressed to a single level structure where the “sub-folders” are taken to the level of the main folders. 320 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 321 To install and connect a Lineaccessori CD Changer contact only a Alfa Romeo Dealership. INTRODUCTION This chapter describes the operation of the CD Changer player variants only (for versions/markets, where provided); refer to the description in the “Functions and Settings” chapter as far as the operation of the radio is concerned. CD CHANGER SELECTION Turn the radio on and briefly and repeatedly press the CD button until the “CD Changer” function is selected. ERROR MESSAGES CD SELECTION Error messages are shown in the following cases: Press the N button to select the next CD or the O button to select the previous CD. ❒ no CD is inserted in the CD Changer: the words “NO CD” will appear in the display until the listening source is changed; If there is no disc present in the CD changer in the selected position, the words “NO CD” will appear briefly on the display. The next disc will then automatically be played. ❒ the CD selected cannot be read (the CD is not in the position selected or the CD has been incorrectly loaded) the number of the CD selected followed by the words “CD error” will appear on the display. The next CD is then selected; if there are no other CDs or these cannot be read either, the display will show the words “NO CD” until the listening source is changed; SOUND SYSTEM CD CHANGER (CDC) ❒ CD reading error: the words “CDC error” will appear on the display. The next CD is then selected; if there are no other CDs in the CD Changer (after the last CD the search begins again from the first) or these also cannot be read, the display will show the words “NO CD” until the listening source is changed; ❒ a CD-ROM is inserted: the next available CD will be selected. 321 293-318 Alfa 159 GB 18-06-2010 14:11 Pagina 322 TROUBLESHOOTING GENERAL SECTION CD PLAYER MP3 FILE READING Low volume The CD does not play The Fader function should be adjusted to “F” (front) values to prevent the reduction of radio output power and the cancelling of the volume if the Fader level adjustment is R+9. The CD is dirty. Clean the CD. The CD is scratched. Try and use another CD. Skips tracks whilst playing MP3 files. SOUND SYSTEM Source cannot be selected 322 Nothing has been loaded. Load the CD or MP3 CD to be played. The CD cannot be loaded A CD is already loaded. Press ˚ and remove the CD. The CD is scratched or dirty. Clean the CD, referring to what is described in the paragraph “CD” in the chapter “Introduction”. The time of the MP3 tracks is not correctly displayed In some cases (due to the recording mode) the duration of the MP3 tracks may be displayed incorrectly. – use of the car under heavy – checking the charge ............ 237 conditions .......................... 227 by the owner ........................ 116 – jump starting ..................... 182 – service Schedule ................. 225 Additional heater ..................... 69 – recharging ......................... 219 – scheduled service ................ 224 Air bags ........................... 141-145 – replacing ........................... 238 Carrying children safely ............. 135 Air/pollen filter ........................ 237 – useful advice for Accessories purchased – child restraint systems ......... 138 Air vents ................................. 54 lengthening the life ............. 239 – passenger’s seat compliance .. 138 Alarm ..................................... 17 Bodywork (cleaning) ................ 244 Alfa Romeo CODE system .......... 10 Bonnet ................................... 105 Alfa 159 Sportwagon ....... 275 Boot ............................... 101-277 – presetting for mounting the “Universal Isofix” child restraint system ........... 140-285 – light replacement ................ 208 Armrest – central .............................. 82 – rear ........................... 83-84 Ashtray .................................. 87 ASR system ............................ 112 Brakes ................................... 256 Bulb (replacement) .................. 196 – general instructions ............. 196 – types of bulbs .................... 197 Ceiling lights – front ................................. 78 – rear .................................. 80 Checking fluid levels ................. 228 Child lock device ...................... 97 Cigar lighter ............................ 85 At the filling station .................. 125 Capacities .............................. 266 Climate control system .............. 53 Automatic headlight sensor ........ 71 Car inactivity ........................... 164 – automatic two-/three-zone .. 58 Automatic two/three-zone Car maintenance ................ 223 – manual ............................. 55 – periodical checks ................ 227 CO2 emissions ......................... 270 climate control system ............ 58 SAFETY DEVICES Battery CORRECT USE OF THE CAR ABS system ............................ 108 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES INDEX DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 323 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:36 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 21-06-2010 INDEX 323-336 Alfa 159 GB 323 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE IN AN EMERGENCY WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES CORRECT USE OF THE CAR SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 323-336 Alfa 159 GB 21-06-2010 10:36 Pagina 324 CODE card .............................. 12 – marking ............................ 251 Containing running costs ........... 157 – technical data .................... 253 Controls ................................. 81 INDEX Fuel – consumption ...................... 269 Correct use of the car ........ 149 – consumption ...................... 232 – fuel cut-off switch ............... 81 Courtesy mirror light – level check ........................ 231 – fuel gauge ......................... 22 Fuel cut-off and power supply – bulb replacement ................ 206 – specifications ..................... 266 Cruise Control .......................... 76 Engine starting ........................ 150 switches ............................... 81 Environment protection ............. 127 Fuel feed ................................ 255 EOBD system .......................... 115 Fuel filler cap .......................... 126 External lights ......................... 70 Fuses (replacement) .......... 209-292 Eyeglasses holder .................... 87 Gearbox (use) ........................ 156 – bulb replacement ................ 201 Fix&Go automatic (device) ....... 190 Glass/can holder ..................... 87 – control .............................. 70 Flashing the headlights ............. 70 Glove compartment .................. 85 Dashboard and controls .... 6 Dashboard buttons ................... 72 Dimensions ............................. 261 Dipped beam headlights Fluid level checks ..................... 230 Direction indicators Glove compartment light – bulb replacement ................ 207 200-201-204 Fluids and lubricants ................. 267 – control .............................. 70 Follow me home (device) ......... 71 Handbrake ............................. 155 Front ceiling lights Hazard lights ........................... 72 – bulb replacement Doors ..................................... 96 Electronic key .......................... 12 Engine – identification code ............... 252 324 Engine oil – control .............................. 72 – bulb replacement ................ 205 Head restraints ................. – control .............................. 78 Headlight washer Front fog lights – bulb replacement ................ 202 48-49 – control .............................. 73 – fluid level .......................... 232 – control .............................. 72 Parking sensors ....................... 118 – headlight adjustment abroad 107 – headlight aiming device ....... 106 Jacking the car ........................ 220 Performance ........................... 263 – front fog light adjustment ..... 107 Labels Power windows ....................... 99 Hill Holder system .................... 111 – identification data ............... 250 Pretensioners .......................... 132 Homelink ............................... 89 – bodywork paint .................. 251 Protecting the environment ........ 127 Identification data .................... 250 Level checks ........................... 230 If an exterior light burns out .. 196-288 Main beam headlights – bulb replacement ................ 199 Ignition device ......................... 19 – control .............................. 70 In an emergency ................ 181 Manual climate control system ... 55 Inactivity of the car .................. 164 Inertial fuel cut-off switch .......... 80 Installation of electric/ electronic devices ................... 117 Instrument panel ..................... 7-8 Instruments ............................ 21 Puddle light – bulb replacement ................ 208 If an interior light burns out .. 205-290 MSR system ........................... 114 Multifunction display ................ 25 Number plate light .................. 204 Quick tyre repair kit Fix&Go automatic .................. 190 Radio frequency remote control: ministerial certifications ........... 271 Radio transmitters and cellular telephones ........... 117 Rain sensor ............................. 74 Oddments compartments .......... 88 SAFETY DEVICES (child's seat) .................. 140-286 Parking lights CORRECT USE OF THE CAR – adjusting headlight beam ..... 106 Isofix universal WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES Headlights .............................. 65 DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 325 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:36 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 21-06-2010 Rear ceiling lights Interior fittings ......................... 83 Paint ..................................... 246 – bulb replacement ................ 205 Interiors ................................. 247 Parking .................................. 155 – control .............................. 80 INDEX 323-336 Alfa 159 GB 325 SAFETY DEVICES DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS 323-336 Alfa 159 GB 21-06-2010 10:36 Pagina 326 Rear fog lights Ski tunnel ............................... 84 – changing ........................... 183 – control .............................. 72 Smart washing ........................ 74 – inflation pressures ............... 260 Rearview mirrors ...................... 50 Snow chains ........................... 163 Reconfigurable multifunction – snow tyres ........................ 162 Sound system ......................... 293 – Rim Protector ..................... 258 CORRECT USE OF THE CAR WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES Right hand drive version .. 297 IN AN EMERGENCY Rev counter ............................ 21 INDEX TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE Tyres – bulb replacement ................ 202 display ................................. 30 Reverse light – bulb replacement ................ 202 Rim Protector .......................... 258 Rims Steering ................................. 256 Steering lock ........................... 21 Steering wheel (adjustment) ..... 49 Sun curtains ............................ 88 – standard tyres .................... 259 – understanding tyre marking .. 257 VDC system ........................... 110 Sun visors ............................... 88 Sunroof .................................. 93 Warning lights Suspensions ............................ 256 and messages ................... 165 Roof rack/ski rack ............ 106-284 Symbols ................................. 10 Weights ................................. 264 Rubber hoses .......................... 242 Technical Specifications ...... 249 – understanding rim marking ... 258 Safe lock device ...................... 14 Third brake light ...................... 204 Safety devices .................... 129 Top speeds .............................. 263 S.B.R. system ......................... 131 Towing the car ......................... 221 Seat belts ............................... 130 Towing trailers Seats ..................................... 45 Side/taillights – bulb replacement ......... 200-203 326 – control .............................. 70 Wheel geometry ...................... 260 Wheel rims – understanding rim marking ... 258 Wheels – changing ........................... 183 – installing the tow hook ........ 159 – technical data .................... 257 T.P.M.S. system ....................... 122 Wheels and tyres ..................... 240 Transmission ........................... 255 Windows (cleaning) ................. 246 Windscreen wiper – blades .............................. 242 – control .............................. 73 – nozzle .............................. 243 SAFETY DEVICES – fluid level .......................... 232 CORRECT USE OF THE CAR – control .............................. 75 WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES Windscreen washer DASHBOARD AND CONTROLS Pagina 327 IN AN EMERGENCY 10:36 TECHNICAL CAR SPECIFICATIONS MAINTENANCE 21-06-2010 INDEX 323-336 Alfa 159 GB 327 323-336 Alfa 159 GB 21-06-2010 10:36 Pagina 328 PROVISIONS FOR THE PROCESSING OF A VEHICLE AT THE END OF ITS LIFE-CYCLE For years now Alfa Romeo has been developing its global commitment towards the safeguarding and protection of the Environment through the continuous improvement of its production processes and the making of increasingly more “eco friendly” products. With a view to guaranteeing the best possible service to clients in full observance of environmental standards and in response to the obligations imposed by European Directive 2000/53/EC on end-of-life vehicles, Alfa Romeo offers its clients the possibility to hand in their vehicle* at the end of its life span without additional costs. The European Directive, in fact, provides for the take-back of the vehicle without the last holder or owner of the same incurring expenses due to the fact that the market value of the vehicle is zero or negative. In particular, in almost all of the countries of the European Union, up until 1st January 2007, take-back of the vehicle free of charge only applies to vehicles registered from 1 July 2002 on, while, from 2007 on, take-back will be carried out free of charge, independently of the year of registration, provided that the vehicle still contains all its essential component parts (especially engine and body) and is free from additional waste materials. Our contracted network of authorised treatment facilities has been carefully selected in order to provide a quality service to our customers by de-polluting and recycling “End of Life Vehicles” to approved environmental standards. To find out the location of your nearest authorised treatment facility, offering free of charge take-back, simply contact one of our dealers or refer to the Alfa Romeo web site or call the toll free number 00800 2532 0000. * Passenger transportation vehicles to seat a max. of nine persons, having a total admissible weight of 3.5 t 323-336 Alfa 159 GB 21-06-2010 10:36 Pagina 329 RIGHT HAND DRIVE VERSION DASHBOARD fig. 1 1. Adjustable swivel side air vents - 2. Front side window demisting/defrosting vents - 3. Passenger’s air bag - 4. Fuel level gauge/engine coolant temperature gauge/engine oil temperature gauge (petrol versions) or turbocharger pressure gauge (diesel versions) - 5. Adjustable swivel centre air vents - 6. Upper central vent - 7. External lights control lever 8. Driver’s air bag and horn - 9. Instrument panel - 10. Windscreen wiper control lever - 11. Front side window demisting/defrosting vents - 12. Adjustable swivel side air vents - 13. Switches for external lights, trip meter reset and headlamp aiming device. - 14. Dashboard fusebox lid - 15. Bonnet opening lever - 16. Sound system controls on the steering wheel (where provided) - 17. Driver’s knees air bag - 18. Cruise Control lever (where provided) - 19. Ignition device - 20. Engine START/STOP button - 21. Heating/ventilation/climate controls - 22. Sound system (where provided) - 23. Glove box - 24. Passenger’s knees air bag (where provided) 329 323-336 Alfa 159 GB 21-06-2010 10:36 Pagina 330 INSTRUMENT PANEL A. Speedometer (speed indicator) B. Warning lights - C. Rev counter D. Multifunction display RIGHT HAND DRIVE VERSION h c m Warning lights on diesel versions only On diesel versions the rev counter end scale value is at 6000 rpm. NOTE 1750 TURBO BENZINA versions have a rev counter with different graphic fig. 2 - Versions with multifunction display A0E0309m A. Speedometer (speed indicator) B. Warning lights - C. Rev counter D. Reconfigurable multifunction display c m Warning lights on diesel versions only On diesel versions the rev counter end scale value is at 6000 rpm. NOTE 1750 TURBO BENZINA versions have a rev counter with different graphic fig. 3 - Versions with reconfigurable multifunction display 330 A0E0310m 323-336 Alfa 159 GB 21-06-2010 10:36 Pagina 331 NOTES 323-336 Alfa 159 GB 21-06-2010 10:36 Pagina 332 323-336 Alfa 159 GB 21-06-2010 10:36 Pagina 333 323-336 Alfa 159 GB 21-06-2010 10:37 Pagina 334 Pagine_ 323-336 Alfa 159 GB 21-06-2010 10:37 Pagina 335 Oil change? The experts recommend Selenia The engine of your car is factory filled with Selenia. This is an engine oil range which satisfies the most advanced international specifications. Its superior technical characteristics allow Selenia to guarantee the highest performance and protection of your engine. The Selenia range includes a number of technologically advanced products: SELENIA SPORT Fully synthetic lubricant capable of meeting the needs of high performance engines. Studied to protect the engine also in high thermal stress conditions, it prevents deposits on the turbine to achieve the utmost performance in total safety. SELENIA StAR PURE ENERGY Synthetic lubricant designed for petrol engines that need products with a low ash content. It maximises the characteristics of engines with high specific power, protects the parts mostly subjected to stress and helps to keep modern catalysts clean. SELENIA WR PURE ENERGY Fully synthetic lubricant that can meet the requirements of the latest diesel engines. Low ash content to protect the particulate filter from the residual products of combustion. High Fuel Economy System that allows considerable fuel saving. It reduces the danger of dirtying the turbine to ensure the protection of increasingly high performance diesel engines SELENIA RACING This lubricant has been developed as a result of Selenia’s extensive experience in track and rally competitions, it maximises engine performance in all kinds of competition use. Pagine_ITA.indd 4 The range also includes K Pure Energy, Selenia Digitech, Selenia Multipower, Selenia 20K, Selenia 20K AR. For further information on Selenia products visit the web site www.selenia.com 18-05-2005 11:54:19 323-336 Alfa 159 GB 21-06-2010 10:37 Pagina 336 COLD TYRE INFLATION PRESSURE Tyres Tyres Tyres Tyres Tyres 205/55 R16 91V 215/55 R16 93V 225/50 R17 98W 235/45 R18 98W (▼) 235/40 ZR19 96Y (▼) front rear front rear front rear front rear front rear average load bar 2.3 2.3 2.3 2.3 2.5 2.5 2.7 2.5 2.7 2.5 full load 2.6 2.6 2.5 2.5 2.9 2.7 2.9 2.7 3.0 2.8 bar Space-saver spare wheel T125/80 R17 4.2 (▼) Unchainable tyres. When using winter tyres, use 225/50 R17 98 tyres or 235/45 R18 98. Vehicles with TI fittings should not use 16” wheel rims. Add +0.3 bar to the prescribed inflation pressure when the tyres are warm. Recheck pressure value with cold tyres. With snow tyres, add +0.2 bar to the inflation pressure value prescribed for standard tyres. Inflate tyres to full load pressures if driving at continuous speed exceeding 160 km/h. ENGINE OIL REPLEACEMENT (litres) Lubrication system engine 1.8 140 HP 1750 TURBO BENZINA 3.2 JTS 1.9 JTDM 8v 1.9 JTDM 16v 2.0 JTDM 2.4 JTDM 4.5 5.0 5.4 4.6 4.9 6.4 Do not discard used oil in the environment. REFUELLING (litres) 1.8 140 HP - 1750 TURBO BENZINA - 1.9 JTDM 8v - 1.9 JTDM 16v - 2.0 JTDM - 2.4 JTDM - 3.2 JTS Fuel tank capacity 70 Reserve 10 For cars with petrol engine, only use unleaded petrol with over 95 R.O.N. (Specification EN228). For cars with diesel engine only use Diesel fuel for motor vehicles (Specification EN590). CUSTOMER SERVICES TECHNICAL SERVICES - SERVICE ENGINEERING Largo Senatore G. Agnelli, 5 - 10040 Volvera - Torino (Italia) Fiat Group Automobiles S.p.A. Publication no. 60438278 - 1 Edition - 06/2010 All rights reserved. Reproduction, even in part is prohibited without written permission from Fiat Group Automobiles S.p.A. SERVICE Cop Alfa Giulietta GB:Alfa 159 cop. LUM GB 21-01-2010 9:07 Pagina 1 ENGLISH OWNER HANDBOOK Alfa Services